EP1988097A1 - Zusammensetzungen und Verfahren zur Behandlung und Diagnose von Prostatakrebs - Google Patents

Zusammensetzungen und Verfahren zur Behandlung und Diagnose von Prostatakrebs Download PDF

Info

Publication number
EP1988097A1
EP1988097A1 EP08011769A EP08011769A EP1988097A1 EP 1988097 A1 EP1988097 A1 EP 1988097A1 EP 08011769 A EP08011769 A EP 08011769A EP 08011769 A EP08011769 A EP 08011769A EP 1988097 A1 EP1988097 A1 EP 1988097A1
Authority
EP
European Patent Office
Prior art keywords
seq
cdna sequence
sequence
polypeptide
determined cdna
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Withdrawn
Application number
EP08011769A
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Inventor
designation of the inventor has not yet been filed The
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Corixa Corp
Original Assignee
Corixa Corp
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority claimed from US09/895,814 external-priority patent/US20020193296A1/en
Priority claimed from US10/012,896 external-priority patent/US6943236B2/en
Application filed by Corixa Corp filed Critical Corixa Corp
Publication of EP1988097A1 publication Critical patent/EP1988097A1/de
Withdrawn legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K16/00Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies
    • C07K16/18Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans
    • C07K16/28Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants
    • C07K16/30Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants from tumour cells
    • C07K16/3069Reproductive system, e.g. ovaria, uterus, testes, prostate
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/461Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the cell type used
    • A61K39/4611T-cells, e.g. tumor infiltrating lymphocytes [TIL], lymphokine-activated killer cells [LAK] or regulatory T cells [Treg]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/463Cellular immunotherapy characterised by recombinant expression
    • A61K39/4632T-cell receptors [TCR]; antibody T-cell receptor constructs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/46Cellular immunotherapy
    • A61K39/464Cellular immunotherapy characterised by the antigen targeted or presented
    • A61K39/4643Vertebrate antigens
    • A61K39/4644Cancer antigens
    • A61K39/464493Prostate associated antigens e.g. Prostate stem cell antigen [PSCA]; Prostate carcinoma tumor antigen [PCTA]; Prostatic acid phosphatase [PAP]; Prostate-specific G-protein-coupled receptor [PSGR]
    • A61K39/464494Prostate specific antigen [PSA]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/08Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the prostate
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/04Immunostimulants
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K14/00Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K14/435Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
    • C07K14/46Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans from vertebrates
    • C07K14/47Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans from vertebrates from mammals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K2039/505Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies comprising antibodies
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2317/00Immunoglobulins specific features
    • C07K2317/30Immunoglobulins specific features characterized by aspects of specificity or valency
    • C07K2317/34Identification of a linear epitope shorter than 20 amino acid residues or of a conformational epitope defined by amino acid residues
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2319/00Fusion polypeptide

Definitions

  • the present invention relates generally to therapy and diagnosis of cancer, such as prostate cancer.
  • the invention is more specifically related to polypeptides, comprising at least a portion of a prostate-specific protein, and to polynucleotides encoding such polypeptides.
  • polypeptides and polynucleotides are useful in pharmaceutical compositions, e.g., vaccines, and other compositions for the diagnosis and treatment of prostate cancer.
  • Cancer is a significant health problem throughout the world. Although advances have been made in detection and therapy of cancer, no vaccine or other universally successful method for prevention or treatment is currently available. Current therapies, which are generally based on a combination of chemotherapy or surgery and radiation, continue to prove inadequate in many patients.
  • Prostate cancer is the most common form of cancer among males, with an estimated incidence of 30% in men over the age of 50. Overwhelming clinical evidence shows that human prostate cancer has the propensity to metastasize to bone, and the disease appears to progress inevitably from androgen dependent to androgen refractory status, leading to increased patient mortality. This prevalent disease is currently the second leading cause of cancer death among men in the U.S.
  • prostate cancer remains difficult to treat. Commonly, treatment is based on surgery and/or radiation therapy, but these methods are ineffective in a significant percentage of cases.
  • PSA prostate specific proteins - prostate specific antigen
  • PAP prostatic acid phosphatase
  • the present invention provides polynucleotide compositions comprising a sequence selected from the group consisting of:
  • the polynucleotide compositions of the invention are expressed in at least about 20%, more preferably in at least about 30%, and most preferably in at least about 50% of prostate tissue samples tested, at a level that is at least about 2-fold, preferably at least about 5-fold, and most preferably at least about 10-fold higher than that for other normal tissues.
  • the present invention in another aspect, provides polypeptide compositions comprising an amino acid sequence that is encoded by a polynucleotide sequence described above.
  • the present invention further provides polypeptide compositions comprising an amino acid sequence selected from the group consisting of sequences recited in SEQ ID NO: 112-114, 172, 176, 178, 327, 329, 331, 336, 339, 376-380, 383, 477-483, 496, 504, 505, 519, 520, 522, 525, 527, 532, 534, 537-551, 553-568, 573-586, 588-590, 592, 706-708, 775, 776, 778, 780, 781, 811, 814, 818, 826, 827, 853, 855, 858, 860-862, 866-877, 879, 883-893, 895, 897, 898, 909-915, 920-928, 932-934, 940, 941, 943, 946, 947, 949-966, 968, 977-990, 992, 1003, 1005, 1008, 1009, 1011, 1012, 1020,
  • the polypeptides and/or polynucleotides of the present invention are immunogenic, i.e., they are capable of eliciting an immune response, particularly a humoral and/or cellular immune response, as further described herein.
  • the present invention further provides fragments, variants and/or derivatives of the disclosed polypeptide and/or polynucleotide sequences, wherein the fragments, variants and/or derivatives preferably have a level of immunogenic activity of at least about 50%, preferably at least about 70% and more preferably at least about 90% of the level of immunogenic activity of a polypeptide sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 112-114, 172, 176, 178, 327, 329, 331, 336, 339, 376-380, 383, 477-483, 496, 504, 505, 519, 520, 522, 525, 527, 532, 534, 537-551, 553-568, 573-586, 588-590, 592, 706-708, 775, 776, 778, 780, 781, 811, 814, 818, 826, 827, 853, 855, 858 or 860-862, 866-877, 879, 883-893, 895, 897, 8
  • the present invention further provides polynucleotides that encode a polypeptide described above, expression vectors comprising such polynucleotides and host cells transformed or transfected with such expression vectors.
  • compositions comprising a polypeptide or polynucleotide as described above and a physiologically acceptable carrier.
  • compositions for prophylactic or therapeutic applications.
  • Such compositions generally comprise an immunogenic polypeptide or polynucleotide of the invention and an immunostimulant, such as an adjuvant, together with a physiologically acceptable carrier.
  • the present invention further provides pharmaceutical compositions that comprise: (a) an antibody or antigen-binding fragment thereof that specifically binds to a polypeptide of the present invention, or a fragment thereof; and (b) a physiologically acceptable carrier.
  • compositions comprising: (a) an antigen presenting cell that expresses a polypeptide as described above and (b) a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or excipient.
  • antigen presenting cells include dendritic cells, macrophages, monocytes, fibroblasts and B cells.
  • compositions comprise: (a) an antigen presenting cell that expresses a polypeptide as described above and (b) an immunostimulant.
  • the present invention further provides, in other aspects, fusion proteins that comprise at least one polypeptide as described above, as well as polynucleotides encoding such fusion proteins, typically in the form of pharmaceutical compositions, e.g., vaccine compositions, comprising a physiologically acceptable carrier and/or an immunostimulant.
  • the fusions proteins may comprise multiple immunogenic polypeptides or portions/variants thereof, as described herein, and may further comprise one or more polypeptide segments for facilitating and/or enhancing the expression, purification and/or immunogenicity of the polypeptide(s).
  • the present invention provides methods for stimulating an immune response in a patient, preferably a T cell response in a human patient, comprising administering a pharmaceutical composition described herein.
  • a patient may be afflicted with prostate cancer, in which case the methods provide treatment for the disease, or a patient considered to be at risk for such a disease may be treated prophylactically.
  • the present invention provides methods for inhibiting the development of a cancer in a patient, comprising administering to a patient a pharmaceutical composition as recited above.
  • the patient may be afflicted with prostate cancer, in which case the methods provide treatment for the disease, or a patient considered to be at risk for such a disease may be treated prophylactically.
  • the present invention further provides, within other aspects, methods for removing tumor cells from a biological sample, comprising contacting a biological sample with T cells that specifically react with a polypeptide of the present invention, wherein the step of contacting is performed under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the removal of cells expressing the polypeptide from the sample.
  • methods for inhibiting the development of a cancer in a patient, comprising administering to a patient a biological sample treated as described above.
  • Methods are further provided, within other aspects, for stimulating and/or expanding T cells specific for a polypeptide of the present invention, comprising contacting T cells with one or more of: (i) a polypeptide as described above; (ii) a polynucleotide encoding such a polypeptide; and (iii) an antigen presenting cell that expresses such a polypeptide; under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the stimulation and/or expansion of T cells.
  • Isolated T cell populations comprising T cells prepared as described above are also provided.
  • the present invention provides methods for inhibiting the development of a cancer in a patient, comprising administering to a patient an effective amount of a T cell population as described above.
  • the present invention further provides methods for inhibiting the development of a cancer in a patient, comprising the steps of: (a) incubating CD4 + and/or CD8 + T cells isolated from a patient with one or more of: (i) a polypeptide comprising at least an immunogenic portion of polypeptide disclosed herein; (ii) a polynucleotide encoding such a polypeptide; and (iii) an antigen-presenting cell that expressed such a polypeptide; and (b) administering to the patient an effective amount of the proliferated T cells, thereby inhibiting the development of a cancer in the patient.
  • Proliferated cells may, but need not, be cloned prior to administration to the patient.
  • the present invention provides methods for determining the presence or absence of a cancer, preferably a prostate cancer, in a patient comprising: (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient with a binding agent that binds to a polypeptide as recited above; (b) detecting in the sample an amount of polypeptide that binds to the binding agent; and (c) comparing the amount of polypeptide with a predetermined cut-off value, and therefrom determining the presence or absence of a cancer in the patient.
  • the binding agent is an antibody, more preferably a monoclonal antibody.
  • the present invention also provides, within other aspects, methods for monitoring the progression of a cancer in a patient.
  • Such methods comprise the steps of: (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient at a first point in time with a binding agent that binds to a polypeptide as recited above; (b) detecting in the sample an amount of polypeptide that binds to the binding agent; (c) repeating steps (a) and (b) using a biological sample obtained from the patient at a subsequent point in time; and (d) comparing the amount of polypeptide detected in step (c) with the amount detected in step (b), and therefrom monitoring the progression of the cancer in the patient.
  • the present invention further provides, within other aspects, methods for determining the presence or absence of a cancer in a patient, comprising the steps of: (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient with an oligonucleotide that hybridizes to a polynucleotide of the present invention; (b) detecting in the sample a level of a polynucleotide, preferably mRNA, that hybridizes to the oligonucleotide; and (c) comparing the level of polynucleotide that hybridizes to the oligonucleotide with a predetermined cut-off value, and therefrom determining the presence or absence of a cancer in the patient.
  • the amount of mRNA is detected via polymerase chain reaction using, for example, at least one oligonucleotide primer that hybridizes to a polynucleotide of the present invention, or a complement of such a polynucleotide.
  • the amount of mRNA is detected using a hybridization technique, employing an oligonucleotide probe that hybridizes to an inventive polynucleotide, or a complement of such a polynucleotide.
  • methods for monitoring the progression of a cancer in a patient, comprising the steps of: (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient with an oligonucleotide that hybridizes to a polynucleotide of the present invention; (b) detecting in the sample an amount of a polynucleotide that hybridizes to the oligonucleotide; (c) repeating steps (a) and (b) using a biological sample obtained from the patient at a subsequent point in time; and (d) comparing the amount of polynucleotide detected in step (c) with the amount detected in step (b), and therefrom monitoring the progression of the cancer in the patient.
  • the present invention provides antibodies, such as monoclonal antibodies, that bind to a polypeptide as described above, as well as diagnostic kits comprising such antibodies. Diagnostic kits comprising one or more oligonucleotide probes or primers as described above are also provided.
  • Figure 1 illustrates the ability of T cells to kill fibroblasts expressing the representative prostate-specific polypeptide P502S, as compared to control fibroblasts. The percentage lysis is shown as a series of effector:target ratios, as indicated.
  • Figures 2A and 2B illustrate the ability of T cells to recognize cells expressing the representative prostate-specific polypeptide P502S. In each case, the number of ⁇ -interferon spots is shown for different numbers of responders.
  • Figure 2A data is presented for fibroblasts pulsed with the P2S-12 peptide, as compared to fibroblasts pulsed with a control E75 peptide.
  • Figure 2B data is presented for fibroblasts expressing P502S, as compared to fibroblasts expressing HER-2/ neu .
  • Figure 3 represents a peptide competition binding assay showing that the P1S#10 peptide, derived from P501S, binds HLA-A2.
  • Peptide P1S#10 inhibits HLA-A2 restricted presentation of fluM58 peptide to CTL clone D150M58 in TNF release bioassay.
  • D150M58 CTL is specific for the HLA-A2 binding influenza matrix peptide fluM58.
  • Figure 4 illustrates the ability of T cell lines generated from P1S#10 immunized mice to specifically lyse P1S#10-pulsed Jurkat A2Kb targets and P501 S-transduced Jurkat A2Kb targets, as compared to EGFP-transduced Jurkat A2Kb.
  • the percent lysis is shown as a series of effector to target ratios, as indicated.
  • Figure 5 illustrates the ability of a T cell clone to recognize and specifically lyse Jurkat A2Kb cells expressing the representative prostate-specific polypeptide P501 S, thereby demonstrating that the P 1S#10 peptide may be a naturally processed epitope of the P501 S polypeptide.
  • Figures 6A and 6B are graphs illustrating the specificity of a CD8 + cell line (3A-1) for a representative prostate-specific antigen (P501 S).
  • Figure 6A shows the results of a 51 Cr release assay. The percent specific lysis is shown as a series of effector:target ratios, as indicated.
  • Figure 6B shows the production of interferon-gamma by 3A-1 cells stimulated with autologous B-LCL transduced with P501S, at varying effector:target rations as indicated.
  • Figure 7 is a Western blot showing the expression of P501 S in baculovirus.
  • Figure 8 illustrates the results of epitope mapping studies on P501 S.
  • Figure 9 is a schematic representation of the P501 S protein showing the location of transmembrane domains and predicted intracellular and extracellular domains.
  • Figure 10 is a genomic map showing the location of the prostate genes P775P, P704P, B305D, P712P and P774P within the Cat Eye Syndrome region of chromosome 22q11.2
  • Figure 11 shows the results of an ELISA assay to determine the specificity of rabbit polyclonal antisera raised against P501 S.
  • compositions of the present invention are directed generally to compositions and their use in the therapy and diagnosis of cancer, particularly prostate cancer.
  • illustrative compositions of the present invention include, but are not restricted to, polypeptides, particularly immunogenic polypeptides, polynucleotides encoding such polypeptides, antibodies and other binding agents, antigen presenting cells (APCs) and immune system cells (e.g., T cells).
  • APCs antigen presenting cells
  • T cells immune system cells
  • polypeptide is used in its conventional meaning, i.e., as a sequence of amino acids.
  • the polypeptides are not limited to a specific length of the product; thus, peptides, oligopeptides, and proteins are included within the definition of polypeptide, and such terms may be used interchangeably herein unless specifically indicated otherwise.
  • This term also does not refer to or exclude post-expression modifications of the polypeptide, for example, glycosylations, acetylations, phosphorylations and the like, as well as other modifications known in the art, both naturally occurring and non-naturally occurring.
  • a polypeptide may be an entire protein, or a subsequence thereof.
  • polypeptides of interest in the context of this invention are amino acid subsequences comprising epitopes, i.e. , antigenic determinants substantially responsible for the immunogenic properties of a polypeptide and being capable of evoking an immune response.
  • polypeptides of the present invention comprise those encoded by a polynucleotide sequence set forth in any one of SEQ ID NO: 1-111, 115-171, 173-175, 177, 179-305, 307-315, 326, 328, 330, 332-335, 340-375, 381, 382 and 384-476, 524, 526, 530, 531, 533, 535, 536, 552, 569-572, 587, 591, 593-606, 618-705, 709-774, 777, 789, 817, 823, 824, 878, 880-882, 894, 896, 907, 908, 916-919, 929-931, 938, 939, 942, 944, 945, 948, 967, 969-976, 991, 993-1002, 1004, 1006, 1007, 1010, 1013-1019, 1021, and 1023-1027 or a sequence that hybridizes under moderately string
  • polypeptides of the invention comprise amino acid sequences as set forth in any one of SEQ ID NO: 112-114, 172, 176, 178, 327, 329, 331, 336, 339, 376-380, 383, 477-483, 496, 504, 505, 519, 520, 522, 525, 527, 532, 534, 537-551, 553-568, 573-586, 588-590, 592, 706-708, 775, 776, 778, 780, 781, 811, 814, 818, 826, 827, 853, 855, 858, 860-862, 866-877, 879, 883-893, 895, 897, 898, 909-915, 920-928, 932-934, 940, 941, 943, 946, 947, 949-966, 968, 977-990, 992, 1003, 1005, 1008, 1009, 1011, and 1012, 1020, 1022, 10
  • polypeptides of the present invention are sometimes herein referred to as prostate-specific proteins or prostate-specific polypeptides, as an indication that their identification has been based at least in part upon their increased levels of expression in prostate tissue samples.
  • a "prostate-specific polypeptide” or “prostate-specific protein” refers generally to a polypeptide sequence of the present invention, or a polynucleotide sequence encoding such a polypeptide, that is expressed in a substantial proportion of prostate tissue samples, for example preferably greater than about 20%, more preferably greater than about 30%, and most preferably greater than about 50% or more of prostate tissue samples tested, at a level that is at least two fold, and preferably at least five fold, greater than the level of expression in other normal tissues, as determined using a representative assay provided herein.
  • a prostate-specific polypeptide sequence of the invention, based upon its increased level of expression in tumor cells, has particular utility both as a diagnostic marker as well as a therapeutic target, as further described below.
  • the polypeptides of the invention are immunogenic, i.e., they react detectably within an immunoassay (such as an ELISA or T-cell stimulation assay) with antisera and/or T-cells from a patient with prostate cancer.
  • an immunoassay such as an ELISA or T-cell stimulation assay
  • Screening for immunogenic activity can be performed using techniques well known to the skilled artisan. For example, such screens can be performed using methods such as those described in Harlow and Lane, Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988 .
  • a polypeptide may be immobilized on a solid support and contacted with patient sera to allow binding of antibodies within the sera to the immobilized polypeptide. Unbound sera may then be removed and bound antibodies detected using, for example, 125 I-labeled Protein A.
  • immunogenic portions of the polypeptides disclosed herein are also encompassed by the present invention.
  • An "immunogenic portion,” as used herein, is a fragment of an immunogenic polypeptide of the invention that itself is immunologically reactive (i.e., specifically binds) with the B-cells and/or T-cell surface antigen receptors that recognize the polypeptide.
  • Immunogenic portions may generally be identified using well known techniques, such as those summarized in Paul, Fundamental Immunology, 3rd ed., 243-247 (Raven Press, 1993 ) and references cited therein. Such techniques include screening polypeptides for the ability to react with antigen-specific antibodies, antisera and/or T-cell lines or clones.
  • antisera and antibodies are "antigen-specific” if they specifically bind to an antigen (i.e., they react with the protein in an ELISA or other immunoassay, and do not react detectably with unrelated proteins).
  • antisera and antibodies may be prepared as described herein, and using well-known techniques.
  • an immunogenic portion of a polypeptide of the present invention is a portion that reacts with antisera and/or T-cells at a level that is not substantially less than the reactivity of the full-length polypeptide (e.g., in an ELISA and/or T-cell reactivity assay).
  • the level of immunogenic activity of the immunogenic portion is at least about 50%, preferably at least about 70% and most preferably greater than about 90% of the immunogenicity for the full-length polypeptide.
  • preferred immunogenic portions will be identified that have a level of immunogenic activity greater than that of the corresponding full-length polypeptide, e.g., having greater than about 100% or 150% or more immunogenic activity.
  • illustrative immunogenic portions may include peptides in which an N-terminal leader sequence and/or transmembrane domain has been deleted.
  • Other illustrative immunogenic portions will contain a small N- and/or C-terminal deletion (e.g., 1-30 amino acids, preferably 5-15 amino acids), relative to the mature protein.
  • a polypeptide composition of the invention may also comprise one or more polypeptides that are immunologically reactive with T cells and/or antibodies generated against a polypeptide of the invention, particularly a polypeptide having an amino acid sequence disclosed herein, or to an immunogenic fragment or variant thereof.
  • polypeptides comprise one or more polypeptides that are capable of eliciting T cells and/or antibodies that are immunologically reactive with one or more polypeptides described herein, or one or more polypeptides encoded by contiguous nucleic acid sequences contained in the polynucleotide sequences disclosed herein, or immunogenic fragments or variants thereof, or to one or more nucleic acid sequences which hybridize to one or more of these sequences under conditions of moderate to high stringency.
  • the present invention in another aspect, provides polypeptide fragments comprising at least about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 50, or 100 contiguous amino acids, or more, including all intermediate lengths, of a polypeptide composition set forth herein, such as those set forth in SEQ ID NO: 112-114, 172, 176, 178, 327, 329, 331, 336, 339, 376-380, 383, 477-483, 496, 504, 505, 519, 520, 522, 525, 527, 532, 534, 537-551, 553-568, 573-586, 588-590, 592, 706-708, 775, 776, 778, 780, 781, 811, 814, 818, 826, 827, 853, 855, 858, 860-862, 866-877, 879, 883-893, 895, 897, 898, 909-915, 920-928, 932-934, 940, 941, 943, 946, 947, 949
  • the present invention provides variants of the polypeptide compositions described herein.
  • Polypeptide variants generally encompassed by the present invention will typically exhibit at least about 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% or more identity (determined as described below), along its length, to a polypeptide sequence set forth herein.
  • polypeptide fragments and variants provided by the present invention are immunologically reactive with an antibody and/or T-cell that reacts with a full-length polypeptide specifically set forth herein.
  • polypeptide fragments and variants provided by the present invention exhibit a level of immunogenic activity of at least about 50%, preferably at least about 70%, and most preferably at least about 90% or more of that exhibited by a full-length polypeptide sequence specifically set forth herein.
  • a polypeptide "variant,” as the term is used herein, is a polypeptide that typically differs from a polypeptide specifically disclosed herein in one or more substitutions, deletions, additions and/or insertions. Such variants may be naturally occurring or may be synthetically generated, for example, by modifying one or more of the above polypeptide sequences of the invention and evaluating their immunogenic activity as described herein using any of a number of techniques well known in the art.
  • certain illustrative variants of the polypeptides of the invention include those in which one or more portions, such as an N-terminal leader sequence or transmembrane domain, have been removed.
  • Other illustrative variants include variants in which a small portion (e.g., 1-30 amino acids, preferably 5-15 amino acids) has been removed from the N- and/or C-terminal of the mature protein.
  • a variant will contain conservative substitutions.
  • a "conservative substitution” is one in which an amino acid is substituted for another amino acid that has similar properties, such that one skilled in the art of peptide chemistry would expect the secondary structure and hydropathic nature of the polypeptide to be substantially unchanged.
  • modifications may be made in the structure of the polynucleotides and polypeptides of the present invention and still obtain a functional molecule that encodes a variant or derivative polypeptide with desirable characteristics, e.g., with immunogenic characteristics.
  • amino acids may be substituted for other amino acids in a protein structure without appreciable loss of interactive binding capacity with structures such as, for example, antigen-binding regions of antibodies or binding sites on substrate molecules. Since it is the interactive capacity and nature of a protein that defines that protein's biological functional activity, certain amino acid sequence substitutions can be made in a protein sequence, and, of course, its underlying DNA coding sequence, and nevertheless obtain a protein with like properties. It is thus contemplated that various changes may be made in the peptide sequences of the disclosed compositions, or corresponding DNA sequences which encode said peptides without appreciable loss of their biological utility or activity.
  • the hydropathic index of amino acids may be considered.
  • the importance of the hydropathic amino acid index in conferring interactive biologic function on a protein is generally understood in the art (Kyte and Doolittle, 1982, incorporated herein by reference). It is accepted that the relative hydropathic character of the amino acid contributes to the secondary structure of the resultant protein, which in turn defines the interaction of the protein with other molecules, for example, enzymes, substrates, receptors, DNA, antibodies, antigens, and the like.
  • Each amino acid has been assigned a hydropathic index on the basis of its hydrophobicity and charge characteristics (Kyte and Doolittle, 1982).
  • hydrophilicity values have been assigned to amino acid residues: arginine (+3.0); lysine (+3.0); aspartate (+3.0 ⁇ 1); glutamate (+3.0 ⁇ 1); serine (+0.3); asparagine (+0.2); glutamine (+0.2); glycine (0); threonine (-0.4); proline (-0.5 ⁇ 1); alanine (-0.5); histidine (-0.5); cysteine (-1.0); methionine (-1.3); valine (-1.5); leucine (-1.8); isoleucine (-1.8); tyrosine (-2.3); phenylalanine (-2.5); tryptophan (-3.4).
  • an amino acid can be substituted for another having a similar hydrophilicity value and still obtain a biologically equivalent, and in particular, an immunologically equivalent protein.
  • substitution of amino acids whose hydrophilicity values are within ⁇ 2 is preferred, those within ⁇ 1 are particularly preferred, and those within ⁇ 0.5 are even more particularly preferred.
  • amino acid substitutions are generally therefore based on the relative similarity of the amino acid side-chain substituents, for example, their hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity, charge, size, and the like.
  • Exemplary substitutions that take various of the foregoing characteristics into consideration are well known to those of skill in the art and include: arginine and lysine; glutamate and aspartate; serine and threonine; glutamine and asparagine; and valine, leucine and isoleucine.
  • any polynucleotide may be further modified to increase stability in vivo. Possible modifications include, but are not limited to, the addition of flanking sequences at the 5' and/or 3' ends; the use of phosphorothioate or 2' O-methyl rather than phosphodiesterase linkages in the backbone; and/or the inclusion of nontraditional bases such as inosine, queosine and wybutosine, as well as acetyl- methyl-, thio- and other modified forms of adenine, cytidine, guanine, thymine and uridine.
  • Amino acid substitutions may further be made on the basis of similarity in polarity, charge, solubility, hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity and/or the amphipathic nature of the residues.
  • negatively charged amino acids include aspartic acid and glutamic acid
  • positively charged amino acids include lysine and arginine
  • amino acids with uncharged polar head groups having similar hydrophilicity values include leucine, isoleucine and valine; glycine and alanine; asparagine and glutamine; and serine, threonine, phenylalanine and tyrosine.
  • variant polypeptides differ from a native sequence by substitution, deletion or addition of five amino acids or fewer.
  • Variants may also (or alternatively) be modified by, for example, the deletion or addition of amino acids that have minimal influence on the immunogenicity, secondary structure and hydropathic nature of the polypeptide.
  • polypeptides may comprise a signal (or leader) sequence at the N-terminal end of the protein, which co-translationally or posttranslationally directs transfer of the protein.
  • the polypeptide may also be conjugated to a linker or other sequence for ease of synthesis, purification or identification of the polypeptide (e.g., poly-His), or to enhance binding of the polypeptide to a solid support.
  • a polypeptide may be conjugated to an immunoglobulin Fc region.
  • two sequences are said to be “identical” if the sequence of amino acids in the two sequences is the same when aligned for maximum correspondence, as described below. Comparisons between two sequences are typically performed by comparing the sequences over a comparison window to identify and compare local regions of sequence similarity.
  • a “comparison window” as used herein refers to a segment of at least about 20 contiguous positions, usually 30 to about 75, 40 to about 50, in which a sequence may be compared to a reference sequence of the same number of contiguous positions after the two sequences are optimally aligned.
  • Optimal alignment of sequences for comparison may be conducted using the Megalign program in the Lasergene suite of bioinformatics software (DNASTAR, Inc., Madison, WI), using default parameters.
  • This program embodies several alignment schemes described in the following references: Dayhoff, M.O. (1978) A model of evolutionary change in proteins - Matrices for detecting distant relationships. In Dayhoff, M.O. (ed.) Atlas of Protein Sequence and Structure, National Biomedical Research Foundation, Washington DC Vol. 5, Suppl. 3, pp. 345-358 ; Hein J. (1990) Unified Approach to Alignment and Phylogenes pp. 626-645 Methods in Enzymology vol.
  • optimal alignment of sequences for comparison may be conducted by the local identity algorithm of Smith and Waterman (1981) Add. APL. Math 2:482 , by the identity alignment algorithm of Needleman and Wunsch (1970) J. Mol. Biol. 48:443 , by the search for similarity methods of Pearson and Lipman (1988) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 85: 2444 , by computerized implementations of these algorithms (GAP, BESTFIT, BLAST, FASTA, and TFASTA in the Wisconsin Genetics Software Package, Genetics Computer Group (GCG), 575 Science Dr., Madison, WI), or by inspection.
  • BLAST and BLAST 2.0 are described in Altschul et al. (1977) Nucl. Acids Res. 25:3389-3402 and Altschul et al. (1990) J. Mol. Biol. 215:403-410 , respectively.
  • BLAST and BLAST 2.0 can be used, for example with the parameters described herein, to determine percent sequence identity for the polynucleotides and polypeptides of the invention.
  • Software for performing BLAST analyses is publicly available through the National Center for Biotechnology Information.
  • a scoring matrix can be used to calculate the cumulative score.
  • Extension of the word hits in each direction are halted when: the cumulative alignment score falls off by the quantity X from its maximum achieved value; the cumulative score goes to zero or below, due to the accumulation of one or more negative-scoring residue alignments; or the end of either sequence is reached.
  • the BLAST algorithm parameters W, T and X determine the sensitivity and speed of the alignment.
  • the "percentage of sequence identity” is determined by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over a window of comparison of at least 20 positions, wherein the portion of the polypeptide sequence in the comparison window may comprise additions or deletions ( i.e., gaps) of 20 percent or less, usually 5 to 15 percent, or 10 to 12 percent, as compared to the reference sequences (which does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences.
  • the percentage is calculated by determining the number of positions at which the identical amino acid residue occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the reference sequence ( i.e., the window size) and multiplying the results by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
  • a polypeptide may be a fusion polypeptide that comprises multiple polypeptides as described herein, or that comprises at least one polypeptide as described herein and an unrelated sequence, such as a known tumor protein.
  • a fusion partner may, for example, assist in providing T helper epitopes (an immunological fusion partner), preferably T helper epitopes recognized by humans, or may assist in expressing the protein (an expression enhancer) at higher yields than the native recombinant protein.
  • Certain preferred fusion partners are both immunological and expression enhancing fusion partners.
  • Other fusion partners may be selected so as to increase the solubility of the polypeptide or to enable the polypeptide to be targeted to desired intracellular compartments.
  • Still further fusion partners include affinity tags, which facilitate purification of the polypeptide.
  • Fusion polypeptides may generally be prepared using standard techniques, including chemical conjugation.
  • a fusion polypeptide is expressed as a recombinant polypeptide, allowing the production of increased levels, relative to a non-fused polypeptide, in an expression system.
  • DNA sequences encoding the polypeptide components may be assembled separately, and ligated into an appropriate expression vector.
  • the 3' end of the DNA sequence encoding one polypeptide component is ligated, with or without a peptide linker, to the 5' end of a DNA sequence encoding the second polypeptide component so that the reading frames of the sequences are in phase. This permits translation into a single fusion polypeptide that retains the biological activity of both component polypeptides.
  • a peptide linker sequence may be employed to separate the first and second polypeptide components by a distance sufficient to ensure that each polypeptide folds into its secondary and tertiary structures.
  • Such a peptide linker sequence is incorporated into the fusion polypeptide using standard techniques well known in the art.
  • Suitable peptide linker sequences may be chosen based on the following factors: (1) their ability to adopt a flexible extended conformation; (2) their inability to adopt a secondary structure that could interact with functional epitopes on the first and second polypeptides; and (3) the lack of hydrophobic or charged residues that might react with the polypeptide functional epitopes.
  • Preferred peptide linker sequences contain Gly, Asn and Ser residues.
  • linker sequences which may be usefully employed as linkers include those disclosed in Maratea et al., Gene 40:39-46, 1985 ; Murphy et al., Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 83:8258-8262, 1986 ; U.S. Patent No. 4,935,233 and U.S. Patent No. 4,751,180 .
  • the linker sequence may generally be from 1 to about 50 amino acids in length. Linker sequences are not required when the first and second polypeptides have non-essential N-terminal amino acid regions that can be used to separate the functional domains and prevent steric interference.
  • the ligated DNA sequences are operably linked to suitable transcriptional or translational regulatory elements.
  • the regulatory elements responsible for expression of DNA are located only 5' to the DNA sequence encoding the first polypeptides.
  • stop codons required to end translation and transcription termination signals are only present 3' to the DNA sequence encoding the second polypeptide.
  • the fusion polypeptide can comprise a polypeptide as described herein together with an unrelated immunogenic protein, such as an immunogenic protein capable of eliciting a recall response.
  • an immunogenic protein capable of eliciting a recall response.
  • immunogenic proteins include tetanus, tuberculosis and hepatitis proteins (see, for example, Stoute et al. New Engl. J. Med., 336:86-91, 1997 ).
  • the immunological fusion partner is derived from a Mycobacterium sp., such as a Mycobacterium tuberculosis- derived Ra12 fragment.
  • a Mycobacterium sp. such as a Mycobacterium tuberculosis- derived Ra12 fragment.
  • Ra12 compositions and methods for their use in enhancing the expression and/or immunogenicity of heterologous polynucleotide/polypeptide sequences is described in U.S. Patent Application 60/158,585 , the disclosure of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • Ra12 refers to a polynucleotide region that is a subsequence of a Mycobacterium tuberculosis MTB32A nucleic acid.
  • MTB32A is a serine protease of 32 KD molecular weight encoded by a gene in virulent and avirulent strains of M. tuberculosis.
  • the nucleotide sequence and amino acid sequence of MTB32A have been described (for example, U.S. Patent Application 60/158,585 ; see also, Skeiky et al., Infection and Immun. (1999) 67:3998-4007 , incorporated herein by reference).
  • C-terminal fragments of the MTB32A coding sequence express at high levels and remain as a soluble polypeptides throughout the purification process.
  • Ra12 may enhance the immunogenicity of heterologous immunogenic polypeptides with which it is fused.
  • Ra12 fusion polypeptide comprises a 14 KD C-terminal fragment corresponding to amino acid residues 192 to 323 of MTB32A.
  • Other preferred Ra12 polynucleotides generally comprise at least about 15 consecutive nucleotides, at least about 30 nucleotides, at least about 60 nucleotides, at least about 100 nucleotides, at least about 200 nucleotides, or at least about 300 nucleotides that encode a portion of a Ra12 polypeptide.
  • Ra12 polynucleotides may comprise a native sequence ( i.e., an endogenous sequence that encodes a Ra12 polypeptide or a portion thereof) or may comprise a variant of such a sequence.
  • Ra12 polynucleotide variants may contain one or more substitutions, additions, deletions and/or insertions such that the biological activity of the encoded fusion polypeptide is not substantially diminished, relative to a fusion polypeptide comprising a native Ra12 polypeptide.
  • Variants preferably exhibit at least about 70% identity, more preferably at least about 80% identity and most preferably at least about 90% identity to a polynucleotide sequence that encodes a native Ra12 polypeptide or a portion thereof.
  • an immunological fusion partner is derived from protein D, a surface protein of the gram-negative bacterium Haemophilus influenza B ( WO 91/18926 ).
  • a protein D derivative comprises approximately the first third of the protein (e.g., the first N-terminal 100-110 amino acids), and a protein D derivative may be lipidated.
  • the first 109 residues of a Lipoprotein D fusion partner is included on the N-terminus to provide the polypeptide with additional exogenous T-cell epitopes and to increase the expression level in E. coli (thus functioning as an expression enhancer).
  • the lipid tail ensures optimal presentation of the antigen to antigen presenting cells.
  • Other fusion partners include the non-structural protein from influenzae virus, NS1 (hemaglutinin). Typically, the N-terminal 81 amino acids are used, although different fragments that include T-helper epitopes may be used.
  • the immunological fusion partner is the protein known as LYTA, or a portion thereof (preferably a C-terminal portion).
  • LYTA is derived from Streptococcus pneumoniae, which synthesizes an N-acetyl-L-alanine amidase known as amidase LYTA (encoded by the LytA gene; Gene 43:265-292, 1986 ).
  • LYTA is an autolysin that specifically degrades certain bonds in the peptidoglycan backbone.
  • the C-terminal domain of the LYTA protein is responsible for the affinity to the choline or to some choline analogues such as DEAE. This property has been exploited for the development of E.
  • coli C-LYTA expressing plasmids useful for expression of fusion proteins. Purification of hybrid proteins containing the C-LYTA fragment at the amino terminus has been described (see Biotechnology 10:795-798, 1992 ). Within a preferred embodiment, a repeat portion of LYTA may be incorporated into a fusion polypeptide. A repeat portion is found in the C-terminal region starting at residue 178. A particularly preferred repeat portion incorporates residues 188-305.
  • Yet another illustrative embodiment involves fusion polypeptides, and the polynucleotides encoding them, wherein the fusion partner comprises a targeting signal capable of directing a polypeptide to the endosomal/lysosomal compartment, as described in U.S. Patent No. 5,633,234 .
  • An immunogenic polypeptide of the invention when fused with this targeting signal, will associate more efficiently with MHC class II molecules and thereby provide enhanced in vivo stimulation of CD4 + T-cells specific for the polypeptide.
  • Polypeptides of the invention are prepared using any of a variety of well known synthetic and/or recombinant techniques, the latter of which are further described below. Polypeptides, portions and other variants generally less than about 150 amino acids can be generated by synthetic means, using techniques well known to those of ordinary skill in the art. In one illustrative example, such polypeptides are synthesized using any of the commercially available solid-phase techniques, such as the Merrifield solid-phase synthesis method, where amino acids are sequentially added to a growing amino acid chain. See Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 85:2149-2146, 1963 . Equipment for automated synthesis of polypeptides is commercially available from suppliers such as Perkin Elmer/Applied BioSystems Division (Foster City, CA), and may be operated according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • polypeptide compositions including fusion polypeptides of the invention are isolated.
  • An "isolated" polypeptide is one that is removed from its original environment.
  • a naturally-occurring protein or polypeptide is isolated if it is separated from some or all of the coexisting materials in the natural system.
  • polypeptides are also purified, e.g., are at least about 90% pure, more preferably at least about 95% pure and most preferably at least about 99% pure.
  • the present invention provides polynucleotide compositions.
  • DNA and “polynucleotide” are used essentially interchangeably herein to refer to a DNA molecule that has been isolated free of total genomic DNA of a particular species.
  • isolated means that a polynucleotide is substantially away from other coding sequences, and that the DNA molecule does not contain large portions of unrelated coding DNA, such as large chromosomal fragments or other functional genes or polypeptide coding regions. Of course, this refers to the DNA molecule as originally isolated, and does not exclude genes or coding regions later added to the segment by the hand of man.
  • polynucleotide compositions of this invention can include genomic sequences, extra-genomic and plasmid-encoded sequences and smaller engineered gene segments that express, or may be adapted to express, proteins, polypeptides, peptides and the like. Such segments may be naturally isolated, or modified synthetically by the hand of man.
  • polynucleotides of the invention may be single-stranded (coding or antisense) or double-stranded, and may be DNA (genomic, cDNA or synthetic) or RNA molecules.
  • RNA molecules may include HnRNA molecules, which contain introns and correspond to a DNA molecule in a one-to-one manner, and mRNA molecules, which do not contain introns. Additional coding or non-coding sequences may, but need not, be present within a polynucleotide of the present invention, and a polynucleotide may, but need not, be linked to other molecules and/or support materials.
  • Polynucleotides may comprise a native sequence (i.e ., an endogenous sequence that encodes a polypeptide/protein of the invention or a portion thereof) or may comprise a sequence that encodes a variant or derivative, preferably an immunogenic variant or derivative, of such a sequence.
  • polynucleotide compositions comprise some or all of a polynucleotide sequence set forth in any one of SEQ ID NO: 1-111, 115-171, 173-175, 177, 179-305, 307-315, 326, 328, 330, 332-335, 340-375, 381, 382 and 384-476, 524, 526, 530, 531, 533, 535, 536, 552, 569-572, 587, 591, 593-606, 618-705, 709-774, 777, 789, 817, 823, 824, 878, 880-882, 894, 896, 907, 908, 916-919, 929-931, 938, 939, 942, 944, 945, 948, 967, 969-976, 991, 993-1002, 1004, 1006, 1007, 1010, 1013-1019, 1021, and 1023-1027, complements of
  • the present invention provides polynucleotide variants having substantial identity to the sequences disclosed herein in SEQ ID NO: 1-111, 115-171, 173-175, 177, 179-305, 307-315, 326, 328, 330, 332-335, 340-375, 381, 382 and 384-476, 524, 526, 530, 531, 533, 535, 536, 552, 569-572, 587, 591, 593-606, 618-705, 709-774, 777, 789, 817, 823, 824, 878, 880-882, 894, 896, 907, 908, 916-919, 929-931, 938, 939, 942, 944, 945, 948, 967, 969-976, 991, 993-1002, 1004, 1006, 1007, 1010, 1013-1019, 1021, and 1023-1027 for example those comprising at least 70% sequence identity, preferably at least 75%,
  • polynucleotide variants will contain one or more substitutions, additions, deletions and/or insertions, preferably such that the immunogenicity of the polypeptide encoded by the variant polynucleotide is not substantially diminished relative to a polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide sequence specifically set forth herein).
  • variants should also be understood to encompasses homologous genes of xenogenic origin.
  • the present invention provides polynucleotide fragments comprising various lengths of contiguous stretches of sequence identical to, or complementary to, one or more of the sequences disclosed herein.
  • polynucleotides are provided by this invention that comprise at least about 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 75, 100, 150, 200, 300, 400, 500 or 1000 or more contiguous nucleotides of one or more of the sequences disclosed herein as well as all intermediate lengths there between.
  • intermediate lengths means any length between the quoted values, such as 16, 17, 18, 19, etc.; 21, 22, 23, etc.; 30, 31, 32, etc.; 50, 51, 52, 53, etc.; 100, 101, 102, 103, etc.; 150, 151, 152, 153, etc .; including all integers through 200-500; 500-1,000, and the like.
  • polynucleotide compositions are provided that are capable of hybridizing under moderate to high stringency conditions to a polynucleotide sequence provided herein, or a fragment thereof, or a complementary sequence thereof.
  • Hybridization techniques are well known in the art of molecular biology.
  • suitable moderately stringent conditions for testing the hybridization of a polynucleotide of this invention with other polynucleotides include prewashing in a solution of 5 X SSC, 0.5% SDS, 1.0 mM EDTA (pH 8.0); hybridizing at 50°C-60°C, 5 X SSC, overnight; followed by washing twice at 65°C for 20 minutes with each of 2X, 0.5X and 0.2X SSC containing 0.1% SDS.
  • suitable highly stringent hybridization conditions include those described above, with the exception that the temperature of hybridization is increased, e.g., to 60-65°C or 65-70°C.
  • polynucleotides described above e.g., polynucleotide variants, fragments and hybridizing sequences, encode polypeptides that are immunologically cross-reactive with a polypeptide sequence specifically set forth herein.
  • such polynucleotides encode polypeptides that have a level of immunogenic activity of at least about 50%, preferably at least about 70%, and more preferably at least about 90% of that for a polypeptide sequence specifically set forth herein.
  • polynucleotides of the present invention may be combined with other DNA sequences, such as promoters, polyadenylation signals, additional restriction enzyme sites, multiple cloning sites, other coding segments, and the like, such that their overall length may vary considerably. It is therefore contemplated that a nucleic acid fragment of almost any length may be employed, with the total length preferably being limited by the ease of preparation and use in the intended recombinant DNA protocol.
  • illustrative polynucleotide segments with total lengths of about 10,000, about 5000, about 3000, about 2,000, about 1,000, about 500, about 200, about 100, about 50 base pairs in length, and the like, (including all intermediate lengths) are contemplated to be useful in many implementations of this invention.
  • two sequences are said to be “identical” if the sequence of nucleotides in the two sequences is the same when aligned for maximum correspondence, as described below. Comparisons between two sequences are typically performed by comparing the sequences over a comparison window to identify and compare local regions of sequence similarity.
  • a “comparison window” as used herein refers to a segment of at least about 20 contiguous positions, usually 30 to about 75, preferably 40 to about 50, in which a sequence may be compared to a reference sequence of the same number of contiguous positions after the two sequences are optimally aligned.
  • Optimal alignment of sequences for comparison may be conducted using the Megalign program in the Lasergene suite of bioinformatics software (DNASTAR, Inc., Madison, WI), using default parameters.
  • This program embodies several alignment schemes described in the following references: Dayhoff, M.O. (1978) A model of evolutionary change in proteins - Matrices for detecting distant relationships. In Dayhoff, M.O. (ed.) Atlas of Protein Sequence and Structure, National Biomedical Research Foundation, Washington DC Vol. 5, Suppl. 3, pp. 345-358 ; Hein J. (1990) Unified Approach to Alignment and Phylogenes pp. 626-645 Methods in Enzymology vol.
  • optimal alignment of sequences for comparison may be conducted by the local identity algorithm of Smith and Waterman (1981) Add. APL. Math 2:482 , by the identity alignment algorithm of Needleman and Wunsch (1970) J. Mol. Biol. 48:443 , by the search for similarity methods of Pearson and Lipman (1988) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 85: 2444 , by computerized implementations of these algorithms (GAP, BESTFIT, BLAST, FASTA, and TFASTA in the Wisconsin Genetics Software Package, Genetics Computer Group (GCG), 575 Science Dr., Madison, WI), or by inspection.
  • BLAST and BLAST 2.0 are described in Altschul et al. (1977) Nucl. Acids Res. 25:3389-3402 and Altschul et al. (1990) J. Mol. Biol. 215:403-410 , respectively.
  • BLAST and BLAST 2.0 can be used, for example with the parameters described herein, to determine percent sequence identity for the polynucleotides of the invention.
  • Software for performing BLAST analyses is publicly available through the National Center for Biotechnology Information.
  • cumulative scores can be calculated using, for nucleotide sequences, the parameters M (reward score for a pair of matching residues; always >0) and N (penalty score for mismatching residues; always ⁇ 0). Extension of the word hits in each direction are halted when: the cumulative alignment score falls off by the quantity X from its maximum achieved value; the cumulative score goes to zero or below, due to the accumulation of one or more negative-scoring residue alignments; or the end of either sequence is reached.
  • the BLAST algorithm parameters W, T and X determine the sensitivity and speed of the alignment.
  • the "percentage of sequence identity” is determined by comparing two optimally aligned sequences over a window of comparison of at least 20 positions, wherein the portion of the polynucleotide sequence in the comparison window may comprise additions or deletions ( i.e ., gaps) of 20 percent or less, usually 5 to 15 percent, or 10 to 12 percent, as compared to the reference sequences (which does not comprise additions or deletions) for optimal alignment of the two sequences.
  • additions or deletions i.e ., gaps
  • the percentage is calculated by determining the number of positions at which the identical nucleic acid bases occurs in both sequences to yield the number of matched positions, dividing the number of matched positions by the total number of positions in the reference sequence ( i.e ., the window size) and multiplying the results by 100 to yield the percentage of sequence identity.
  • nucleotide sequences that encode a polypeptide as described herein. Some of these polynucleotides bear minimal homology to the nucleotide sequence of any native gene. Nonetheless, polynucleotides that vary due to differences in codon usage are specifically contemplated by the present invention. Further, alleles of the genes comprising the polynucleotide sequences provided herein are within the scope of the present invention. Alleles are endogenous genes that are altered as a result of one or more mutations, such as deletions, additions and/or substitutions of nucleotides. The resulting mRNA and protein may, but need not, have an altered structure or function. Alleles may be identified using standard techniques (such as hybridization, amplification and/or database sequence comparison).
  • a mutagenesis approach such as site-specific mutagenesis, is employed for the preparation of immunogenic variants and/or derivatives of the polypeptides described herein.
  • site-specific mutagenesis By this approach, specific modifications in a polypeptide sequence can be made through mutagenesis of the underlying polynucleotides that encode them.
  • Site-specific mutagenesis allows the production of mutants through the use of specific oligonucleotide sequences which encode the DNA sequence of the desired mutation, as well as a sufficient number of adjacent nucleotides, to provide a primer sequence of sufficient size and sequence complexity to form a stable duplex on both sides of the deletion junction being traversed. Mutations may be employed in a selected polynucleotide sequence to improve, alter, decrease, modify, or otherwise change the properties of the polynucleotide itself, and/or alter the properties, activity, composition, stability, or primary sequence of the encoded polypeptide.
  • the inventors contemplate the mutagenesis of the disclosed polynucleotide sequences to alter one or more properties of the encoded polypeptide, such as the immunogenicity of a polypeptide vaccine.
  • the techniques of site-specific mutagenesis are well-known in the art, and are widely used to create variants of both polypeptides and polynucleotides.
  • site-specific mutagenesis is often used to alter a specific portion of a DNA molecule.
  • a primer comprising typically about 14 to about 25 nucleotides or so in length is employed, with about 5 to about 10 residues on both sides of the junction of the sequence being altered.
  • site-specific mutagenesis techniques have often employed a phage vector that exists in both a single stranded and double stranded form.
  • Typical vectors useful in site-directed mutagenesis include vectors such as the M13 phage. These phage are readily commercially-available and their use is generally well-known to those skilled in the art.
  • Double-stranded plasmids are also routinely employed in site directed mutagenesis that eliminates the step of transferring the gene of interest from a plasmid to a phage.
  • site-directed mutagenesis in accordance herewith is performed by first obtaining a single-stranded vector or melting apart of two strands of a double-stranded vector that includes within its sequence a DNA sequence that encodes the desired peptide.
  • An oligonucleotide primer bearing the desired mutated sequence is prepared, generally synthetically. This primer is then annealed with the single-stranded vector, and subjected to DNA polymerizing enzymes such as E . coli polymerase I Klenow fragment, in order to complete the synthesis of the mutation-bearing strand.
  • E . coli polymerase I Klenow fragment DNA polymerizing enzymes
  • a heteroduplex is formed wherein one strand encodes the original non-mutated sequence and the second strand bears the desired mutation.
  • This heteroduplex vector is then used to transform appropriate cells, such as E. coli cells, and clones are selected which include recombinant vectors bearing the mutated sequence arrangement.
  • sequence variants of the selected peptide-encoding DNA segments using site-directed mutagenesis provides a means of producing potentially useful species and is not meant to be limiting as there are other ways in which sequence variants of peptides and the DNA sequences encoding them may be obtained.
  • recombinant vectors encoding the desired peptide sequence may be treated with mutagenic agents, such as hydroxylamine, to obtain sequence variants.
  • mutagenic agents such as hydroxylamine
  • oligonucleotide directed mutagenesis procedure refers to template-dependent processes and vector-mediated propagation which result in an increase in the concentration of a specific nucleic acid molecule relative to its initial concentration, or in an increase in the concentration of a detectable signal, such as amplification.
  • oligonucleotide directed mutagenesis procedure is intended to refer to a process that involves the template-dependent extension of a primer molecule.
  • template dependent process refers to nucleic acid synthesis of an RNA or a DNA molecule wherein the sequence of the newly synthesized strand of nucleic acid is dictated by the well-known rules of complementary base pairing (see, for example, Watson, 1987).
  • vector mediated methodologies involve the introduction of the nucleic acid fragment into a DNA or RNA vector, the clonal amplification of the vector, and the recovery of the amplified nucleic acid fragment. Examples of such methodologies are provided. by U. S. Patent No. 4,237,224 , specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • recursive sequence recombination as described in U.S. Patent No. 5,837,458 , may be employed.
  • iterative cycles of recombination and screening or selection are performed to "evolve" individual polynucleotide variants of the invention having, for example, enhanced immunogenic activity.
  • the polynucleotide sequences provided herein can be advantageously used as probes or primers for nucleic acid hybridization.
  • nucleic acid segments that comprise a sequence region of at least about 15 contiguous nucleotides that has the same sequence as, or is complementary to, a 15 nucleotide long contiguous sequence disclosed herein will find particular utility. Longer contiguous identical or complementary sequences, e.g., those of about 20, 30, 40, 50, 100, 200, 500, 1000 (including all intermediate lengths) and even up to full length sequences will also be of use in certain embodiments.
  • nucleic acid probes to specifically hybridize to a sequence of interest will enable them to be of use in detecting the presence of complementary sequences in a given sample.
  • sequence information for the preparation of mutant species primers, or primers for use in preparing other genetic constructions.
  • Polynucleotide molecules having sequence regions consisting of contiguous nucleotide stretches of 10-14, 15-20, 30, 50, or even of 100-200 nucleotides or so (including intermediate lengths as well), identical or complementary to a polynucleotide sequence disclosed herein, are particularly contemplated as hybridization probes for use in, e.g., Southern and Northern blotting. This would allow a gene product, or fragment thereof, to be analyzed, both in diverse cell types and also in various bacterial cells. The total size of fragment, as well as the size of the complementary stretch(es), will ultimately depend on the intended use or application of the particular nucleic acid segment.
  • hybridization probe of about 15-25 nucleotides in length allows the formation of a duplex molecule that is both stable and selective.
  • Molecules having contiguous complementary sequences over stretches greater than 15 bases in length are generally preferred, though, in order to increase stability and selectivity of the hybrid, and thereby improve the quality and degree of specific hybrid molecules obtained.
  • Hybridization probes may be selected from any portion of any of the sequences disclosed herein. All that is required is to review the sequences set forth herein, or to any continuous portion of the sequences, from about 15-25 nucleotides in length up to and including the full length sequence, that one wishes to utilize as a probe or primer.
  • the choice of probe and primer sequences may be governed by various factors. For example, one may wish to employ primers from towards the termini of the total sequence.
  • Small polynucleotide segments or fragments may be readily prepared by, for example, directly synthesizing the fragment by chemical means, as is commonly practiced using an automated oligonucleotide synthesizer. Also, fragments may be obtained by application of nucleic acid reproduction technology, such as the PCR TM technology of U. S. Patent 4,683,202 (incorporated herein by reference), by introducing selected sequences into recombinant vectors for recombinant production, and by other recombinant DNA techniques generally known to those of skill in the art of molecular biology.
  • nucleic acid reproduction technology such as the PCR TM technology of U. S. Patent 4,683,202 (incorporated herein by reference)
  • the nucleotide sequences of the invention may be used for their ability to selectively form duplex molecules with complementary stretches of the entire gene or gene fragments of interest.
  • relatively stringent conditions e.g., one will select relatively low salt and/or high temperature conditions, such as provided by a salt concentration of from about 0.02 M to about 0.15 M salt at temperatures of from about 50°C to about 70°C.
  • Such selective conditions tolerate little, if any, mismatch between the probe and the template or target strand, and would be particularly suitable for isolating related sequences.
  • polynucleotide compositions comprising antisense oligonucleotides are provided.
  • Antisense oligonucleotides have been demonstrated to be effective and targeted inhibitors of protein synthesis, and, consequently, provide a therapeutic approach by which a disease can be treated by inhibiting the synthesis of proteins that contribute to the disease.
  • the efficacy of antisense oligonucleotides for inhibiting protein synthesis is well established. For example, the synthesis of polygalactauronase and the muscarine type 2 acetylcholine receptor are inhibited by antisense oligonucleotides directed to their respective mRNA sequences ( U. S. Patent 5,739,119 and U. S.
  • Patent 5,759,829 Further, examples of antisense inhibition have been demonstrated with the nuclear protein cyclin, the multiple drug resistance gene (MDG1), ICAM-1, E-selectin, STK-1, striatal GABA A receptor and human EGF ( Jaskulski et al., Science. 1988 Jun 10;240(4858):1544-6 ; Vasanthakumar and Ahmed, Cancer Commun. 1989;1(4):225-32 ; Peris et al., Brain Res Mol Brain Res. 1998 Jun 15;57(2):310-20 ; U. S. Patent 5,801,154 ; U.S. Patent 5,789,573 ; U. S. Patent 5,718,709 and U.S. Patent 5,610,288 ).
  • MDG1 multiple drug resistance gene
  • Antisense constructs have also been described that inhibit and can be used to treat a variety of abnormal cellular proliferations, e.g. cancer ( U. S. Patent 5,747,470 ; U. S. Patent 5,591,317 and U. S. Patent 5,783,683 ).
  • the present invention provides oligonucleotide sequences that comprise all, or a portion of, any sequence that is capable of specifically binding to polynucleotide sequence described herein, or a complement thereof.
  • the antisense oligonucleotides comprise DNA or derivatives thereof.
  • the oligonucleotides comprise RNA or derivatives thereof.
  • the oligonucleotides are modified DNAs comprising a phosphorothioated modified backbone.
  • the oligonucleotide sequences comprise peptide nucleic acids or derivatives thereof.
  • compositions comprise a sequence region that is complementary, and more preferably substantially-complementary, and even more preferably, completely complementary to one or more portions of polynucleotides disclosed herein.
  • Selection of antisense compositions specific for a given gene sequence is based upon analysis of the chosen target sequence and determination of secondary structure, T m , binding energy, and relative stability.
  • Antisense compositions may be selected based upon their relative inability to form dimers, hairpins, or other secondary structures that would reduce or prohibit specific binding to the target mRNA in a host cell.
  • Highly preferred target regions of the mRNA are those which are at or near the AUG translation initiation codon, and those sequences which are substantially complementary to 5' regions of the mRNA.
  • MPG short peptide vector
  • the use of an antisense delivery method employing a short peptide vector, termed MPG (27 residues), is also contemplated.
  • the MPG peptide contains a hydrophobic domain derived from the fusion sequence of HIV gp41 and a hydrophilic domain from the nuclear localization sequence of SV40 T-antigen ( Morris et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 1997 Jul 15;25(14):2730-6 ). It has been demonstrated that several molecules of the MPG peptide coat the antisense oligonucleotides and can be delivered into cultured mammalian cells in less than 1 hour with relatively high efficiency (90%). Further, the interaction with MPG strongly increases both the stability of the oligonucleotide to nuclease and the ability to cross the plasma membrane.
  • the polynucleotide compositions described herein are used in the design and preparation of ribozyme molecules for inhibiting expression of the tumor polypeptides and proteins of the present invention in tumor cells.
  • Ribozymes are RNA-protein complexes that cleave nucleic acids in a site-specific fashion. Ribozymes have specific catalytic domains that possess endonuclease activity ( Kim and Cech, Proc Nat'l Acad Sci U S A. 1987 Dec;84(24):8788-92 ; Forster and Symons, Cell. 1987 Apr 24;49(2):211-20 ).
  • ribozymes accelerate phosphoester transfer reactions with a high degree of specificity, often cleaving only one of several phosphoesters in an oligonucleotide substrate ( Cech et al., Cell. 1981 Dec;27(3 Pt 2):487-96 ; Michel and Westhof, J Mol Biol. 1990 Dec 5;216(3):585-610 ; Reinhold-Hurek and Shub, Nature. 1992 May 14;357(6374):173-6 ).
  • This specificity has been attributed to the requirement that the substrate bind via specific base-pairing interactions to the internal guide sequence ("IGS") of the ribozyme prior to chemical reaction.
  • IGS internal guide sequence
  • enzymatic nucleic acids act by first binding to a target RNA. Such binding occurs through the target binding portion of a enzymatic nucleic acid which is held in close proximity to an enzymatic portion of the molecule that acts to cleave the target RNA. Thus, the enzymatic nucleic acid first recognizes and then binds a target RNA through complementary base-pairing, and once bound to the correct site, acts enzymatically to cut the target RNA.
  • RNA Strategic cleavage of such a target RNA will destroy its ability to direct synthesis of an encoded protein. After an enzymatic nucleic acid has bound and cleaved its RNA target, it is released from that RNA to search for another target and can repeatedly bind and cleave new targets.
  • ribozyme The enzymatic nature of a ribozyme is advantageous over many technologies, such as antisense technology (where a nucleic acid molecule simply binds to a nucleic acid target to block its translation) since the concentration of ribozyme necessary to affect a therapeutic treatment is lower than that of an antisense oligonucleotide.
  • This advantage reflects the ability of the ribozyme to act enzymatically.
  • a single ribozyme molecule is able to cleave many molecules of target RNA.
  • the ribozyme is a highly specific inhibitor, with the specificity of inhibition depending not only on the base pairing mechanism of binding to the target RNA, but also on the mechanism of target RNA cleavage.
  • the enzymatic nucleic acid molecule may be formed in a hammerhead, hairpin, a hepatitis ⁇ virus, group I intron or RNaseP RNA (in association with an RNA guide sequence) or Neurospora VS RNA motif.
  • hammerhead motifs are described by Rossi et al. Nucleic Acids Res. 1992 Sep 11;20(17):4559-65 .
  • hairpin motifs are described by Hampel et al. (Eur. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. EP 0360257 ), Hampel and Tritz, Biochemistry 1989 Jun 13;28(12):4929-33 ; Hampel et al., Nucleic Acids Res.
  • Ribozymes may be designed as described in Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 93/23569 and Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 94/02595 , each specifically incorporated herein by reference) and synthesized to be tested in vitro and in vivo, as described. Such ribozymes can also be optimized for delivery. While specific examples are provided, those in the art will recognize that equivalent RNA targets in other species can be utilized when necessary.
  • Ribozyme activity can be optimized by altering the length of the ribozyme binding arms, or chemically synthesizing ribozymes with modifications that prevent their degradation by serum ribonucleases (see e.g., Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 92/07065 ; Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 93/15187 ; Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 91/03162 ; Eur. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. 92110298.4 ; U. S. Patent 5,334,711 ; and Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 94/13688 , which describe various chemical modifications that can be made to the sugar moieties of enzymatic RNA molecules), modifications which enhance their efficacy in cells, and removal of stem II bases to shorten RNA synthesis times and reduce chemical requirements.
  • Ribozymes may be administered to cells by a variety of methods known to those familiar to the art, including, but not restricted to, encapsulation in liposomes, by iontophoresis, or by incorporation into other vehicles, such as hydrogels, cyclodextrins, biodegradable nanocapsules, and bioadhesive microspheres.
  • ribozymes may be directly delivered ex vivo to cells or tissues with or without the aforementioned vehicles.
  • the RNA/vehicle combination may be locally delivered by direct inhalation, by direct injection or by use of a catheter, infusion pump or stent.
  • routes of delivery include, but are not limited to, intravascular, intramuscular, subcutaneous or joint injection, aerosol inhalation, oral (tablet or pill form), topical, systemic, ocular, intraperitoneal and/or intrathecal delivery. More detailed descriptions of ribozyme delivery and administration are provided in Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 94/02595 and Int. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 93/23569 , each specifically incorporated herein by reference.
  • RNA polymerase I RNA polymerase I
  • RNA polymerase II RNA polymerase II
  • RNA polymerase III RNA polymerase III
  • Transcripts from pol II or pol III promoters will be expressed at high levels in all cells; the levels of a given pol II promoter in a given cell type will depend on the nature of the gene regulatory sequences (enhancers, silencers, etc.) present nearby.
  • Prokaryotic RNA polymerase promoters may also be used, providing that the prokaryotic RNA polymerase enzyme is expressed in the appropriate cells Ribozymes expressed from such promoters have been shown to function in mammalian cells.
  • Such transcription units can be incorporated into a variety of vectors for introduction into mammalian cells, including but not restricted to, plasmid DNA vectors, viral DNA vectors (such as adenovirus or adeno-associated vectors), or viral RNA vectors (such as retroviral, semliki forest virus, Sindbis virus vectors).
  • PNAs peptide nucleic acids compositions.
  • PNA is a DNA mimic in which the nucleobases are attached to a pseudopeptide backbone ( Good and Nielsen, Antisense Nucleic Acid Drug Dev. 1997 7(4) 431-37 ).
  • PNA is able to be utilized in a number methods that traditionally have used RNA or DNA. Often PNA sequences perform better in techniques than the corresponding RNA or DNA sequences and have utilities that are not inherent to RNA or DNA.
  • a review of PNA including methods of making, characteristics of, and methods of using, is provided by Corey (Trends Biotechnol 1997 Jun;15(6):224-9 ).
  • PNAs have 2-aminoethyl-glycine linkages replacing the normal phosphodiester backbone of DNA ( Nielsen et al., Science 1991 Dec 6;254(5037):1497-500 ; Hanvey et al., Science. 1992 Nov 27;258(5087):1481-5 ; Hyrup and Nielsen, Bioorg Med Chem. 1996 Jan;4(1):5-23 ).
  • PNAs are neutral molecules; secondly, PNAs are achiral, which avoids the need to develop a stereoselective synthesis; and thirdly, PNA synthesis uses standard Boc or Fmoc protocols for solid-phase peptide synthesis, although other methods, including a modified Merrifield method, have been used.
  • PNA monomers or ready-made oligomers are commercially available from PerSeptive Biosystems (Framingham, MA).
  • PNA syntheses by either Boc or Fmoc protocols are straightforward using manual or automated protocols ( Norton et al., Bioorg Med Chem. 1995 Apr;3(4):437-45 ).
  • the manual protocol lends itself to the production of chemically modified PNAs or the simultaneous synthesis of families of closely related PNAs.
  • PNAs can incorporate any combination of nucleotide bases
  • the presence of adjacent purines can lead to deletions of one or more residues in the product.
  • Modifications of PNAs for a given application may be accomplished by coupling amino acids during solid-phase synthesis or by attaching compounds that contain a carboxylic acid group to the exposed N-terminal amine.
  • PNAs can be modified after synthesis by coupling to an introduced lysine or cysteine. The ease with which PNAs can be modified facilitates optimization for better solubility or for specific functional requirements.
  • the identity of PNAs and their derivatives can be confirmed by mass spectrometry.
  • Several studies have made and utilized modifications of PNAs (for example, Norton et al., Bioorg Med Chem. 1995 Apr;3(4):437-45 ; Petersen et al., J Pept Sci.
  • U.S. Patent No. 5,700,922 discusses PNA-DNA-PNA chimeric molecules and their uses in diagnostics, modulating protein in organisms, and treatment of conditions susceptible to therapeutics.
  • PNAs include use in DNA strand invasion, antisense inhibition, mutational analysis, enhancers of transcription, nucleic acid purification, isolation of transcriptionally active genes, blocking of transcription factor binding, genome cleavage, biosensors, in situ hybridization, and the like.
  • Polynucleotide compositions of the present invention may be identified, prepared and/or manipulated using any of a variety of well established techniques (see generally, Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, Cold Spring Harbor, NY, 1989 , and other like references).
  • a polynucleotide may be identified, as described in more detail below, by screening a microarray of cDNAs for tumor-associated expression (i.e., expression that is at least two fold greater in a tumor than in normal tissue, as determined using a representative assay provided herein). Such screens may be performed, for example, using the microarray technology of Affymetrix, Inc.
  • polynucleotides may be amplified from cDNA prepared from cells expressing the proteins described herein, such as tumor cells.
  • PCR TM polymerase chain reaction
  • the primers will bind to the target and the polymerase will cause the primers to be extended along the target sequence by adding on nucleotides.
  • the extended primers will dissociate from the target to form reaction products, excess primers will bind to the target and to the reaction product and the process is repeated.
  • reverse transcription and PCR TM amplification procedure may be performed in order to quantify the amount of mRNA amplified.
  • Polymerase chain reaction methodologies are well known in the art.
  • LCR ligase chain reaction
  • SDA Strand Displacement Amplification
  • RCR Repair Chain Reaction
  • nucleic acid amplification procedures include transcription-based amplification systems (TAS) (PCT Intl. Pat. Appl. Publ. No. WO 88/10315 ), including nucleic acid sequence based amplification (NASBA) and 3SR.
  • TAS transcription-based amplification systems
  • NASBA nucleic acid sequence based amplification
  • 3SR nucleic acid sequence based amplification
  • ssRNA single-stranded RNA
  • dsDNA double-stranded DNA
  • WO 89/06700 describes a nucleic acid sequence amplification scheme based on the hybridization of a promoter/primer sequence to a target single-stranded DNA ("ssDNA”) followed by transcription of many RNA copies of the sequence.
  • Other amplification methods such as “RACE” (Frohman, 1990), and “one-sided PCR” (Ohara, 1989) are also well-known to those of skill in the art.
  • An amplified portion of a polynucleotide of the present invention may be used to isolate a full length gene from a suitable library (e.g., a tumor cDNA library) using well known techniques.
  • a library cDNA or genomic
  • a library is screened using one or more polynucleotide probes or primers suitable for amplification.
  • a library is size-selected to include larger molecules. Random primed libraries may also be preferred for identifying 5' and upstream regions of genes. Genomic libraries are preferred for obtaining introns and extending 5' sequences.
  • a partial sequence may be labeled (e.g., by nick-translation or end-labeling with 32 P) using well known techniques.
  • a bacterial or bacteriophage library is then generally screened by hybridizing filters containing denatured bacterial colonies (or lawns containing phage plaques) with the labeled probe (see Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, Cold Spring Harbor, NY, 1989 ). Hybridizing colonies or plaques are selected and expanded, and the DNA is isolated for further analysis.
  • cDNA clones may be analyzed to determine the amount of additional sequence by, for example, PCR using a primer from the partial sequence and a primer from the vector.
  • Restriction maps and partial sequences may be generated to identify one or more overlapping clones.
  • the complete sequence may then be determined using standard techniques, which may involve generating a series of deletion clones.
  • the resulting overlapping sequences can then assembled into a single contiguous sequence.
  • a full length cDNA molecule can be generated by ligating suitable fragments, using well known techniques.
  • amplification techniques can be useful for obtaining a full length coding sequence from a partial cDNA sequence.
  • One such amplification technique is inverse PCR (see Triglia et al., Nucl. Acids Res. 16:8186, 1988 ), which uses restriction enzymes to generate a fragment in the known region of the gene. The fragment is then circularized by intramolecular ligation and used as a template for PCR with divergent primers derived from the known region.
  • sequences adjacent to a partial sequence may be retrieved by amplification with a primer to a linker sequence and a primer specific to a known region.
  • the amplified sequences are typically subjected to a second round of amplification with the same linker primer and a second primer specific to the known region.
  • a variation on this procedure, which employs two primers that initiate extension in opposite directions from the known sequence, is described in WO 96/38591 .
  • Another such technique is known as "rapid amplification of cDNA ends" or RACE. This technique involves the use of an internal primer and an external primer, which hybridizes to a polyA region or vector sequence, to identify sequences that are 5' and 3' of a known sequence. Additional techniques include capture PCR ( Lagerstrom et al., PCR Methods Applic. 1:111-19, 1991 ) and walking PCR ( Parker et al., Nucl. Acids. Res. 19:3055-60, 1991 ). Other methods employing amplification may also be employed to obtain a full length cDNA sequence.
  • EST expressed sequence tag
  • Searches for overlapping ESTs may generally be performed using well known programs (e.g., NCBI BLAST searches), and such ESTs may be used to generate a contiguous full length sequence.
  • Full length DNA sequences may also be obtained by analysis of genomic fragments.
  • polynucleotide sequences or fragments thereof which encode polypeptides of the invention, or fusion proteins or functional equivalents thereof may be used in recombinant DNA molecules to direct expression of a polypeptide in appropriate host cells. Due to the inherent degeneracy of the genetic code, other DNA sequences that encode substantially the same or a functionally equivalent amino acid sequence may be produced and these sequences may be used to clone and express a given polypeptide.
  • codons preferred by a particular prokaryotic or eukaryotic host can be selected to increase the rate of protein expression or to produce a recombinant RNA transcript having desirable properties, such as a half-life which is longer than that of a transcript generated from the naturally occurring sequence.
  • polynucleotide sequences of the present invention can be engineered using methods generally known in the art in order to alter polypeptide encoding sequences for a variety of reasons, including but not limited to, alterations which modify the cloning, processing, and/or expression of the gene product.
  • DNA shuffling by random fragmentation and PCR reassembly of gene fragments and synthetic oligonucleotides may be used to engineer the nucleotide sequences.
  • site-directed mutagenesis may be used to insert new restriction sites, alter glycosylation patterns, change codon preference, produce splice variants, or introduce mutations, and so forth.
  • natural, modified, or recombinant nucleic acid sequences may be ligated to a heterologous sequence to encode a fusion protein.
  • a heterologous sequence to encode a fusion protein.
  • a fusion protein may also be engineered to contain a cleavage site located between the polypeptide-encoding sequence and the heterologous protein sequence, so that the polypeptide may be cleaved and purified away from the heterologous moiety.
  • Sequences encoding a desired polypeptide may be synthesized, in whole or in part, using chemical methods well known in the art (see Caruthers, M. H. et al. (1980) Nucl. Acids Res. Symp. Ser. 215-223 , Horn, T. et al. (1980) Nucl. Acids Res. Symp. Ser. 225-232 ).
  • the protein itself may be produced using chemical methods to synthesize the amino acid sequence of a polypeptide, or a portion thereof.
  • peptide synthesis can be performed using various solid-phase techniques ( Roberge, J. Y. et al. (1995) Science 269:202-204 ) and automated synthesis may be achieved, for example, using the ABI 431A Peptide Synthesizer (Perkin Elmer, Palo Alto, CA).
  • a newly synthesized peptide may be substantially purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (e.g., Creighton, T. (1983) Proteins, Structures and Molecular Principles, WH Freeman and Co., New York, N.Y .) or other comparable techniques available in the art.
  • the composition of the synthetic peptides may be confirmed by amino acid analysis or sequencing (e.g., the Edman degradation procedure). Additionally, the amino acid sequence of a polypeptide, or any part thereof, may be altered during direct synthesis and/or combined using chemical methods with sequences from other proteins, or any part thereof, to produce a variant polypeptide.
  • the nucleotide sequences encoding the polypeptide, or functional equivalents may be inserted into appropriate expression vector, i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence.
  • appropriate expression vector i.e., a vector which contains the necessary elements for the transcription and translation of the inserted coding sequence.
  • Methods which are well known to those skilled in the art may be used to construct expression vectors containing sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest and appropriate transcriptional and translational control elements. These methods include in vitro recombinant DNA techniques, synthetic techniques, and in vivo genetic recombination. Such techniques are described, for example, in Sambrook, J. et al.
  • a variety of expression vector/host systems may be utilized to contain and express polynucleotide sequences. These include, but are not limited to, microorganisms such as bacteria transformed with recombinant bacteriophage, plasmid, or cosmid DNA expression vectors; yeast transformed with yeast expression vectors; insect cell systems infected with virus expression vectors (e.g., baculovirus); plant cell systems transformed with virus expression vectors (e.g., cauliflower mosaic virus, CaMV; tobacco mosaic virus, TMV) or with bacterial expression vectors (e.g., Ti or pBR322 plasmids); or animal cell systems.
  • microorganisms such as bacteria transformed with recombinant bacteriophage, plasmid, or cosmid DNA expression vectors
  • yeast transformed with yeast expression vectors insect cell systems infected with virus expression vectors (e.g., baculovirus)
  • plant cell systems transformed with virus expression vectors e.g., cauliflower mosaic virus, CaMV; tobacco mosaic
  • control elements or "regulatory sequences" present in an expression vector are those non-translated regions of the vector--enhancers, promoters, 5' and 3' untranslated regions--which interact with host cellular proteins to carry out transcription and translation. Such elements may vary in their strength and specificity. Depending on the vector system and host utilized, any number of suitable transcription and translation elements, including constitutive and inducible promoters, may be used. For example, when cloning in bacterial systems, inducible promoters such as the hybrid lacZ promoter of the PBLUESCRIPT phagemid (Stratagene, La Jolla, Calif.) or PSPORT1 plasmid (Gibco BRL, Gaithersburg, MD) and the like may be used.
  • inducible promoters such as the hybrid lacZ promoter of the PBLUESCRIPT phagemid (Stratagene, La Jolla, Calif.) or PSPORT1 plasmid (Gibco BRL, Gaithersburg, MD) and the
  • promoters from mammalian genes or from mammalian viruses are generally preferred. If it is necessary to generate a cell line that contains multiple copies of the sequence encoding a polypeptide, vectors based on SV40 or EBV may be advantageously used with an appropriate selectable marker.
  • any of a number of expression vectors may be selected depending upon the use intended for the expressed polypeptide.
  • vectors which direct high level expression of fusion proteins that are readily purified may be used.
  • Such vectors include, but are not limited to, the multifunctional E . coli cloning and expression vectors such as BLUESCRIPT (Stratagene), in which the sequence encoding the polypeptide of interest may be ligated into the vector in frame with sequences for the amino-terminal Met and the subsequent 7 residues of .beta.-galactosidase so that a hybrid protein is produced; pIN vectors ( Van Heeke, G. and S. M.
  • pGEX Vectors may also be used to express foreign polypeptides as fusion proteins with glutathione S-transferase (GST).
  • GST glutathione S-transferase
  • fusion proteins are soluble and can easily be purified from lysed cells by adsorption to glutathione-agarose beads followed by elution in the presence of free glutathione.
  • Proteins made in such systems may be designed to include heparin, thrombin, or factor XA protease cleavage sites so that the cloned polypeptide of interest can be released from the GST moiety at will.
  • yeast Saccharomyces cerevisiae
  • a number of vectors containing constitutive or inducible promoters such as alpha factor, alcohol oxidase, and PGH may be used.
  • constitutive or inducible promoters such as alpha factor, alcohol oxidase, and PGH.
  • sequences encoding polypeptides may be driven by any of a number of promoters.
  • viral promoters such as the 35S and 19S promoters of CaMV may be used alone or in combination with the omega leader sequence from TMV ( Takamatsu, N. (1987) EMBO J. 3:17-311 .
  • plant promoters such as the small subunit of RUBISCO or heat shock promoters may be used ( Coruzzi, G. et al. (1984) EMBO J. 3:1671-1680 ; Broglie, R. et al. (1984) Science 224:838-843 ; and Winter, J. et al. (1991) Results Probl.
  • An insect system may also be used to express a polypeptide of interest.
  • Autographa californica nuclear polyhedrosis virus (AcNPV) is used as a vector to express foreign genes in Spodoptera frugiperda cells or in Trichoplusia larvae.
  • the sequences encoding the polypeptide may be cloned into a non-essential region of the virus, such as the polyhedrin gene, and placed under control of the polyhedrin promoter. Successful insertion of the polypeptide-encoding sequence will render the polyhedrin gene inactive and produce recombinant virus lacking coat protein.
  • the recombinant viruses may then be used to infect, for example, S.
  • a number of viral-based expression systems are generally available.
  • sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest may be ligated into an adenovirus transcription/translation complex consisting of the late promoter and tripartite leader sequence. Insertion in a non-essential E1 or E3 region of the viral genome may be used to obtain a viable virus which is capable of expressing the polypeptide in infected host cells ( Logan, J. and Shenk, T. (1984) Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. 81:3655-3659 ).
  • transcription enhancers such as the Rous sarcoma virus (RSV) enhancer, may be used to increase expression in mammalian host cells.
  • RSV Rous sarcoma virus
  • Specific initiation signals may also be used to achieve more efficient translation of sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest. Such signals include the ATG initiation codon and adjacent sequences. In cases where sequences encoding the polypeptide, its initiation codon, and upstream sequences are inserted into the appropriate expression vector, no additional transcriptional or translational control signals may be needed. However, in cases where only coding sequence, or a portion thereof, is inserted, exogenous translational control signals including the ATG initiation codon should be provided. Furthermore, the initiation codon should be in the correct reading frame to ensure translation of the entire insert. Exogenous translational elements and initiation codons may be of various origins, both natural and synthetic.
  • Enhancers which are appropriate for the particular cell system which is used, such as those described in the literature ( Scharf, D. et al. (1994) Results Probl. Cell Differ. 20:125-162 ).
  • a host cell strain may be chosen for its ability to modulate the expression of the inserted sequences or to process the expressed protein in the desired fashion.
  • modifications of the polypeptide include, but are not limited to, acetylation, carboxylation. glycosylation, phosphorylation, lipidation, and acylation.
  • Post-translational processing which cleaves a "prepro" form of the protein may also be used to facilitate correct insertion, folding and/or function.
  • Different host cells such as CHO, COS, HeLa, MDCK, HEK293, and W138, which have specific cellular machinery and characteristic mechanisms for such post-translational activities, may be chosen to ensure the correct modification and processing of the foreign protein.
  • cell lines which stably express a polynucleotide of interest may be transformed using expression vectors which may contain viral origins of replication and/or endogenous expression elements and a selectable marker gene on the same or on a separate vector. Following the introduction of the vector, cells may be allowed to grow for 1-2 days in an enriched media before they are switched to selective media.
  • the purpose of the selectable marker is to confer resistance to selection, and its presence allows growth and recovery of cells which successfully express the introduced sequences.
  • Resistant clones of stably transformed cells may be proliferated using tissue culture techniques appropriate to the cell type.
  • any number of selection systems may be used to recover transformed cell lines. These include, but are not limited to, the herpes simplex virus thymidine kinase ( Wigler, M. et al. (1977) Cell 11:223-32 ) and adenine phosphoribosyltransferase ( Lowy, I. et al. (1990) Cell 22:817-23 ) genes which can be employed in tk.sup.- or aprt.sup.- cells, respectively. Also, antimetabolite, antibiotic or herbicide resistance can be used as the basis for selection; for example, dhfr which confers resistance to methotrexate ( Wigler, M. et al. (1980) Proc.
  • npt which confers resistance to the aminoglycosides, neomycin and G-418 ( Colbere-Garapin, F. et al (1981) J. Mol. Biol. 150:1-14 ); and als or pat, which confer resistance to chlorsulfuron and phosphinotricin acetyltransferase, respectively (Murry, supra). Additional selectable genes have been described, for example, trpB, which allows cells to utilize indole in place of tryptophan, or hisD, which allows cells to utilize histinol in place of histidine ( Hartman, S. C. and R. C. Mulligan (1988) Proc.
  • marker gene expression suggests that the gene of interest is also present, its presence and expression may need to be confirmed.
  • sequence encoding a polypeptide is inserted within a marker gene sequence, recombinant cells containing sequences can be identified by the absence of marker gene function.
  • a marker gene can be placed in tandem with a polypeptide-encoding sequence under the control of a single promoter. Expression of the marker gene in response to induction or selection usually indicates expression of the tandem gene as well.
  • host cells that contain and express a desired polynucleotide sequence may be identified by a variety of procedures known to those of skill in the art. These procedures include, but are not limited to, DNA-DNA or DNA-RNA hybridizations and protein bioassay or immunoassay techniques which include, for example, membrane, solution, or chip based technologies for the detection and/or quantification of nucleic acid or protein.
  • a variety of protocols for detecting and measuring the expression of polynucleotide-encoded products, using either polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies specific for the product are known in the art. Examples include enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay (ELISA), radioimmunoassay (RIA), and fluorescence activated cell sorting (FACS).
  • ELISA enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay
  • RIA radioimmunoassay
  • FACS fluorescence activated cell sorting
  • a two-site, monoclonal-based immunoassay utilizing monoclonal antibodies reactive to two non-interfering epitopes on a given polypeptide may be preferred for some applications, but a competitive binding assay may also be employed. These and other assays are described, among other places, in Hampton, R. et al. (1990; Serological Methods, a Laboratory Manual, APS Press, St Paul. Minn .) and Maddox, D. E. et al. (1983; J. Exp. Med
  • Means for producing labeled hybridization or PCR probes for detecting sequences related to polynucleotides include oligolabeling, nick translation, end-labeling or PCR amplification using a labeled nucleotide.
  • the sequences, or any portions thereof may be cloned into a vector for the production of an mRNA probe.
  • Such vectors are known in the art, are commercially available, and may be used to synthesize RNA probes in vitro by addition of an appropriate RNA polymerase such as T7, T3, or SP6 and labeled nucleotides.
  • reporter molecules or labels include radionuclides, enzymes, fluorescent, chemiluminescent, or chromogenic agents as well as substrates, cofactors, inhibitors, magnetic particles, and the like.
  • Host cells transformed with a polynucleotide sequence of interest may be cultured under conditions suitable for the expression and recovery of the protein from cell culture.
  • the protein produced by a recombinant cell may be secreted or contained intracellularly depending on the sequence and/or the vector used.
  • expression vectors containing polynucleotides of the invention may be designed to contain signal sequences which direct secretion of the encoded polypeptide through a prokaryotic or eukaryotic cell membrane.
  • Other recombinant constructions may be used to join sequences encoding a polypeptide of interest to nucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide domain which will facilitate purification of soluble proteins.
  • Such purification facilitating domains include, but are not limited to, metal chelating peptides such as histidine-tryptophan modules that allow purification on immobilized metals, protein A domains that allow purification on immobilized immunoglobulin, and the domain utilized in the FLAGS extension/affinity purification system (Immunex Corp., Seattle, Wash.).
  • metal chelating peptides such as histidine-tryptophan modules that allow purification on immobilized metals
  • protein A domains that allow purification on immobilized immunoglobulin
  • the domain utilized in the FLAGS extension/affinity purification system Immunex Corp., Seattle, Wash.
  • cleavable linker sequences such as those specific for Factor XA or enterokinase (Invitrogen. San Diego, Calif.) between the purification domain and the encoded polypeptide may be used to facilitate purification.
  • One such expression vector provides for expression of a fusion protein containing a polypeptide of interest and a nucleic acid encoding 6 histidine residues preceding a thioredoxin or an enterokinase cleavage site.
  • the histidine residues facilitate purification on IMIAC (immobilized metal ion affinity chromatography) as described in Porath, J. et al. (1992, Prot. Exp. Purif. 3:263-281 ) while the enterokinase cleavage site provides a means for purifying the desired polypeptide from the fusion protein.
  • IMIAC immobilized metal ion affinity chromatography
  • polypeptides of the invention may be produced by direct peptide synthesis using solid-phase techniques ( Merrifield J. (1963) J. Am. Chem. Soc. 85:2149-2154 ). Protein synthesis may be performed using manual techniques or by automation. Automated synthesis may be achieved, for example, using Applied Biosystems 431A Peptide Synthesizer (Perkin Elmer). Alternatively, various fragments may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using chemical methods to produce the full length molecule.
  • the present invention further provides binding agents, such as antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof, that exhibit immunological binding to a tumor polypeptide disclosed herein, or to a portion, variant or derivative thereof.
  • binding agents such as antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof, that exhibit immunological binding to a tumor polypeptide disclosed herein, or to a portion, variant or derivative thereof.
  • An antibody, or antigen-binding fragment thereof is said to "specifically bind,” “immunogically bind,” and/or is “immunologically reactive” to a polypeptide of the invention if it reacts at a detectable level (within, for example, an ELISA assay) with the polypeptide, and does not react detectably with unrelated polypeptides under similar conditions.
  • Immunological binding generally refers to the non-covalent interactions of the type which occur between an immunoglobulin molecule and an antigen for which the immunoglobulin is specific.
  • the strength, or affinity of immunological binding interactions can be expressed in terms of the dissociation constant (K d ) of the interaction, wherein a smaller K d represents a greater affinity.
  • Immunological binding properties of selected polypeptides can be quantified using methods well known in the art. One such method entails measuring the rates of antigen-binding site/antigen complex formation and dissociation, wherein those rates depend on the concentrations of the complex partners, the affinity of the interaction, and on geometric parameters that equally influence the rate in both directions.
  • both the "on rate constant” (K on ) and the “off rate constant” (K off ) can be determined by calculation of the concentrations and the actual rates of association and dissociation.
  • the ratio of K off /K on enables cancellation of all parameters not related to affinity, and is thus equal to the dissociation constant K d . See, generally, Davies et al. (1990) Annual Rev. Biochem. 59:439-473 .
  • an “antigen-binding site,” or “binding portion” of an antibody refers to the part of the immunoglobulin molecule that participates in antigen binding.
  • the antigen binding site is formed by amino acid residues of the N-terminal variable ("V") regions of the heavy ("H") and light (“L”) chains.
  • V N-terminal variable
  • H heavy
  • L light
  • Three highly divergent stretches within the V regions of the heavy and light chains are referred to as “hypervariable regions" which are interposed between more conserved flanking stretches known as “framework regions,” or "FRs".
  • FR refers to amino acid sequences which are naturally found between and adjacent to hypervariable regions in immunoglobulins.
  • the three hypervariable regions of a light chain and the three hypervariable regions of a heavy chain are disposed relative to each other in three dimensional space to form an antigen-binding surface.
  • the antigen-binding surface is complementary to the three-dimensional surface of a bound antigen, and the three hypervariable regions of each of the heavy and light chains are referred to as "complementarity-determining regions,” or "CDRs.”
  • Binding agents may be further capable of differentiating between patients with and without a cancer, such as prostate cancer, using the representative assays provided herein.
  • a cancer such as prostate cancer
  • binding agents may be further capable of differentiating between patients with and without a cancer, such as prostate cancer, using the representative assays provided herein.
  • antibodies or other binding agents that bind to a tumor protein will preferably generate a signal indicating the presence of a cancer in at least about 20% of patients with the disease, more preferably at least about 30% of patients.
  • the antibody will generate a negative signal indicating the absence of the disease in at least about 90% of individuals without the cancer.
  • biological samples e.g., blood, sera, sputum, urine and/or tumor biopsies
  • samples e.g., blood, sera, sputum, urine and/or tumor biopsies
  • a cancer as determined using standard clinical tests
  • a statistically significant number of samples with and without the disease will be assayed.
  • Each binding agent should satisfy the above criteria; however, those of ordinary skill in the art will recognize that binding agents may be used in combination to improve sensitivity.
  • a binding agent may be a ribosome, with or without a peptide component, an RNA molecule or a polypeptide.
  • a binding agent is an antibody or an antigen-binding fragment thereof.
  • Antibodies may be prepared by any of a variety of techniques known to those of ordinary skill in the art. See, e.g., Harlow and Lane, Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, 1988 . In general, antibodies can be produced by cell culture techniques, including the generation of monoclonal antibodies as described herein, or via transfection of antibody genes into suitable bacterial or mammalian cell hosts, in order to allow for the production of recombinant antibodies.
  • an immunogen comprising the polypeptide is initially injected into any of a wide variety of mammals (e.g., mice, rats, rabbits, sheep or goats).
  • the polypeptides of this invention may serve as the immunogen without modification.
  • a superior immune response may be elicited if the polypeptide is joined to a carrier protein, such as bovine serum albumin or keyhole limpet hemocyanin.
  • the immunogen is injected into the animal host, preferably according to a predetermined schedule incorporating one or more booster immunizations, and the animals are bled periodically.
  • Polyclonal antibodies specific for the polypeptide may then be purified from such antisera by, for example, affinity chromatography using the polypeptide coupled to a suitable solid support.
  • Monoclonal antibodies specific for an antigenic polypeptide of interest may be prepared, for example, using the technique of Kohler and Milstein, Eur. J. Immunol. 6:511-519, 1976 , and improvements thereto. Briefly, these methods involve the preparation of immortal cell lines capable of producing antibodies having the desired specificity (i . e ., reactivity with the polypeptide of interest). Such cell lines may be produced, for example, from spleen cells obtained from an animal immunized as described above. The spleen cells are then immortalized by, for example, fusion with a myeloma cell fusion partner, preferably one that is syngeneic with the immunized animal. A variety of fusion techniques may be employed.
  • the spleen cells and myeloma cells may be combined with a nonionic detergent for a few minutes and then plated at low density on a selective medium that supports the growth of hybrid cells, but not myeloma cells.
  • a preferred selection technique uses HAT (hypoxanthine, aminopterin, thymidine) selection. After a sufficient time, usually about 1 to 2 weeks, colonies of hybrids are observed. Single colonies are selected and their culture supernatants tested for binding activity against the polypeptide. Hybridomas having high reactivity and specificity are preferred.
  • Monoclonal antibodies may be isolated from the supernatants of growing hybridoma colonies.
  • various techniques may be employed to enhance the yield, such as injection of the hybridoma cell line into the peritoneal cavity of a suitable vertebrate host, such as a mouse.
  • Monoclonal antibodies may then be harvested from the ascites fluid or the blood.
  • Contaminants may be removed from the antibodies by conventional techniques, such as chromatography, gel filtration, precipitation, and extraction.
  • the polypeptides of this invention may be used in the purification process in, for example, an affinity chromatography step.
  • a number of therapeutically useful molecules are known in the art which comprise antigen-binding sites that are capable of exhibiting immunological binding properties of an antibody molecule.
  • the proteolytic enzyme papain preferentially cleaves IgG molecules to yield several fragments, two of which (the "F(ab)" fragments) each comprise a covalent heterodimer that includes an intact antigen-binding site.
  • the enzyme pepsin is able to cleave IgG molecules to provide several fragments, including the "F(ab') 2 " fragment which comprises both antigen-binding sites.
  • An "Fv" fragment can be produced by preferential proteolytic cleavage of an IgM, and on rare occasions IgG or IgA immunoglobulin molecule.
  • Fv fragments are, however, more commonly derived using recombinant techniques known in the art.
  • the Fv fragment includes a non-covalent V H ::V L heterodimer including an antigen-binding site which retains much of the antigen recognition and binding capabilities of the native antibody molecule.
  • V H ::V L heterodimer including an antigen-binding site which retains much of the antigen recognition and binding capabilities of the native antibody molecule.
  • a single chain Fv (“sFv”) polypeptide is a covalently linked V H ::V L heterodimer which is expressed from a gene fusion including V H - and V L -encoding genes linked by a peptide-encoding linker.
  • a number of methods have been described to discern chemical structures for converting the naturally aggregated--but chemically separated--light and heavy polypeptide chains from an antibody V region into an sFv molecule which will fold into a three dimensional structure substantially similar to the structure of an antigen-binding site. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,091,513 and 5,132,405, to Huston et al .; and U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,778, to Ladner et al .
  • Each of the above-described molecules includes a heavy chain and a light chain CDR set, respectively interposed between a heavy chain and a light chain FR set which provide support to the CDRS and define the spatial relationship of the CDRs relative to each other.
  • CDR set refers to the three hypervariable regions of a heavy or light chain V region. Proceeding from the N-terminus of a heavy or light chain, these regions are denoted as "CDR1," "CDR2,” and “CDR3" respectively.
  • An antigen-binding site therefore, includes six CDRs, comprising the CDR set from each of a heavy and a light chain V region.
  • a polypeptide comprising a single CDR (e.g., a CDR1, CDR2 or CDR3) is referred to herein as a "molecular recognition unit.” Crystallographic analysis of a number of antigen-antibody complexes has demonstrated that the amino acid residues of CDRs form extensive contact with bound antigen, wherein the most extensive antigen contact is with the heavy chain CDR3. Thus, the molecular recognition units are primarily responsible for the specificity of an antigen-binding site.
  • FR set refers to the four flanking amino acid sequences which frame the CDRs of a CDR set of a heavy or light chain V region. Some FR residues may contact bound antigen; however, FRs are primarily responsible for folding the V region into the antigen-binding site, particularly the FR residues directly adjacent to the CDRS. Within FRs, certain amino residues and certain structural features are very highly conserved. In this regard, all V region sequences contain an internal disulfide loop of around 90 amino acid residues. When the V regions fold into a binding-site, the CDRs are displayed as projecting loop motifs which form an antigen-binding surface.
  • the terms “veneered FRs” and “recombinantly veneered FRs” refer to the selective replacement of FR residues from, e.g., a rodent heavy or light chain V region, with human FR residues in order to provide a xenogeneic molecule comprising an antigen-binding site which retains substantially all of the native FR polypeptide folding structure. Veneering techniques are based on the understanding that the ligand binding characteristics of an antigen-binding site are determined primarily by the structure and relative disposition of the heavy and light chain CDR sets within the antigen-binding surface. Davies et al. (1990) Ann. Rev. Biochem. 59:439-473 .
  • antigen binding specificity can be preserved in a humanized antibody only wherein the CDR structures, their interaction with each other, and their interaction with the rest of the V region domains are carefully maintained.
  • exterior (e.g., solvent-accessible) FR residues which are readily encountered by the immune system are selectively replaced with human residues to provide a hybrid molecule that comprises either a weakly immunogenic, or substantially non-immunogenic veneered surface.
  • the process of veneering makes use of the available sequence data for human antibody variable domains compiled by Kabat et al., in Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest, 4th ed., (U.S. Dept. of Health and Human Services, U.S. Government Printing Office, 1987), updates to the Kabat database, and other accessible U.S. and foreign databases (both nucleic acid and protein). Solvent accessibilities of V region amino acids can be deduced from the known three-dimensional structure for human and murine antibody fragments. There are two general steps in veneering a murine antigen-binding site. Initially, the FRs of the variable domains of an antibody molecule of interest are compared with corresponding FR sequences of human variable domains obtained from the above-identified sources.
  • the resultant "veneered" murine antigen-binding sites are thus designed to retain the murine CDR residues, the residues substantially adjacent to the CDRs, the residues identified as buried or mostly buried (solvent inaccessible), the residues believed to participate in non-covalent (e.g., electrostatic and hydrophobic) contacts between heavy and light chain domains, and the residues from conserved structural regions of the FRs which are believed to influence the "canonical" tertiary structures of the CDR loops.
  • monoclonal antibodies of the present invention may be coupled to one or more therapeutic agents.
  • Suitable agents in this regard include radionuclides, differentiation inducers, drugs, toxins, and derivatives thereof.
  • Preferred radionuclides include 90 Y, 123 I, 125 I, 131 I, 186 Re, 188 Re, 211 At, and 212 Bi.
  • Preferred drugs include methotrexate, and pyrimidine and purine analogs.
  • Preferred differentiation inducers include phorbol esters and butyric acid.
  • Preferred toxins include ricin, abrin, diptheria toxin, cholera toxin, gelonin, Pseudomonas exotoxin, Shigella toxin, and pokeweed antiviral protein.
  • a therapeutic agent may be coupled (e.g., covalently bonded) to a suitable monoclonal antibody either directly or indirectly (e.g., via a linker group).
  • a direct reaction between an agent and an antibody is possible when each possesses a substituent capable of reacting with the other.
  • a nucleophilic group such as an amino or sulfhydryl group
  • on one may be capable of reacting with a carbonyl-containing group, such as an anhydride or an acid halide, or with an alkyl group containing a good leaving group (e.g., a halide) on the other.
  • a linker group can function as a spacer to distance an antibody from an agent in order to avoid interference with binding capabilities.
  • a linker group can also serve to increase the chemical reactivity of a substituent on an agent or an antibody, and thus increase the coupling efficiency. An increase in chemical reactivity may also facilitate the use of agents, or functional groups on agents, which otherwise would not be possible.
  • a linker group which is cleavable during or upon internalization into a cell.
  • a number of different cleavable linker groups have been described.
  • the mechanisms for the intracellular release of an agent from these linker groups include cleavage by reduction of a disulfide bond (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,489,710, to Spitler ), by irradiation of a photolabile bond (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,625,014, to Senter et al .), by hydrolysis of derivatized amino acid side chains (e.g., U.S.
  • Patent No. 4,638,045 to Kohn et al .
  • serum complement-mediated hydrolysis e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,671,958, to Rodwell et al .
  • acid-catalyzed hydrolysis e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,569,789, to Blattler et al .
  • immunoconjugates with more than one agent may be prepared in a variety of ways. For example, more than one agent may be coupled directly to an antibody molecule, or linkers that provide multiple sites for attachment can be used. Alternatively, a carrier can be used.
  • a carrier may bear the agents in a variety of ways, including covalent bonding either directly or via a linker group.
  • Suitable carriers include proteins such as albumins ( e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,507,234, to Kato et al .), peptides and polysaccharides such as aminodextran (e.g., U.S. Patent No. 4,699,784, to Shih et al .).
  • a carrier may also bear an agent by noncovalent bonding or by encapsulation, such as within a liposome vesicle (e.g., U.S. Patent Nos. 4,429,008 and 4,873,088 ).
  • Carriers specific for radionuclide agents include radiohalogenated small molecules and chelating compounds.
  • U.S. Patent No. 4,735,792 discloses representative radiohalogenated small molecules and their synthesis.
  • a radionuclide chelate may be formed from chelating compounds that include those containing nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the donor atoms for binding the metal, or metal oxide, radionuclide.
  • U.S. Patent No. 4,673,562 to Davison et al discloses representative chelating compounds and their synthesis.
  • T cells specific for a tumor polypeptide disclosed herein, or for a variant or derivative thereof may generally be prepared in vitro or ex vivo, using standard procedures.
  • T cells may be isolated from bone marrow, peripheral blood, or a fraction of bone marrow or peripheral blood of a patient, using a commercially available cell separation system, such as the Isolex TM System, available from Nexell Therapeutics, Inc. (Irvine, CA; see also U.S. Patent No. 5,240,856 ; U.S. Patent No. 5,215,926 ; WO 89/06280 ; WO 91/16116 and WO 92/07243 ).
  • T cells may be derived from related or unrelated humans, non-human mammals, cell lines or cultures.
  • T cells may be stimulated with a polypeptide, polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide and/or an antigen presenting cell (APC) that expresses such a polypeptide.
  • APC antigen presenting cell
  • Such stimulation is performed under conditions and for a time sufficient to permit the generation of T cells that are specific for the polypeptide of interest.
  • a tumor polypeptide or polynucleotide of the invention is present within a delivery vehicle, such as a microsphere, to facilitate the generation of specific T cells.
  • T cells are considered to be specific for a polypeptide of the present invention if the T cells specifically proliferate, secrete cytokines or kill target cells coated with the polypeptide or expressing a gene encoding the polypeptide.
  • T cell specificity may be evaluated using any of a variety of standard techniques. For example, within a chromium release assay or proliferation assay, a stimulation index of more than two fold increase in lysis and/or proliferation, compared to negative controls, indicates T cell specificity. Such assays may be performed, for example, as described in Chen et al., Cancer Res. 54:1065-1070, 1994 . Alternatively, detection of the proliferation of T cells may be accomplished by a variety of known techniques.
  • T cell proliferation can be detected by measuring an increased rate of DNA synthesis (e.g., by pulse-labeling cultures of T cells with tritiated thymidine and measuring the amount of tritiated thymidine incorporated into DNA).
  • a tumor polypeptide 100 ng/ml - 100 ⁇ g/ml, preferably 200 ng/ml - 25 ⁇ g/ml
  • 3 - 7 days will typically result in at least a two fold increase in proliferation of the T cells.
  • T cells that have been activated in response to a tumor polypeptide, polynucleotide or polypeptide-expressing APC may be CD4 + and/or CD8 + .
  • Tumor polypeptide-specific T cells may be expanded using standard techniques.
  • the T cells are derived from a patient, a related donor or an unrelated donor, and are administered to the patient following stimulation and expansion.
  • CD4 + or CD8 + T cells that proliferate in response to a tumor polypeptide, polynucleotide or APC can be expanded in number either in vitro or in vivo. Proliferation of such T cells in vitro may be accomplished in a variety of ways. For example, the T cells can be re-exposed to a tumor polypeptide, or a short peptide corresponding to an immunogenic portion of such a polypeptide, with or without the addition of T cell growth factors, such as interleukin-2, and/or stimulator cells that synthesize a tumor polypeptide. Alternatively, one or more T cells that proliferate in the presence of the tumor polypeptide can be expanded in number by cloning. Methods for cloning cells are well known in the art, and include limiting dilution.
  • the present invention concerns formulation of one or more of the polynucleotide, polypeptide, T-cell and/or antibody compositions disclosed herein in pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers for administration to a cell or an animal, either alone, or in combination with one or more other modalities of therapy.
  • compositions as disclosed herein may be administered in combination with other agents as well, such as, e.g., other proteins or polypeptides or various pharmaceutically-active agents.
  • agents such as, e.g., other proteins or polypeptides or various pharmaceutically-active agents.
  • additional agents do not cause a significant adverse effect upon contact with the target cells or host tissues.
  • the compositions may thus be delivered along with various other agents as required in the particular instance.
  • Such compositions may be purified from host cells or other biological sources, or alternatively may be chemically synthesized as described herein.
  • such compositions may further comprise substituted or derivatized RNA or DNA compositions.
  • compositions comprising one or more of the polynucleotide, polypeptide, antibody, and/or T-cell compositions described herein in combination with a physiologically acceptable carrier.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention comprise immunogenic polynucleotide and/or polypeptide compositions of the invention for use in prophylactic and therapeutic vaccine applications.
  • Vaccine preparation is generally described in, for example, M.F. Powell and M.J. Newman, eds., "Vaccine Design (the subunit and adjuvant approach),” Plenum Press (NY, 1995 ).
  • such compositions will comprise one or more polynucleotide and/or polypeptide compositions of the present invention in combination with one or more immunostimulants.
  • any of the pharmaceutical compositions described herein can contain pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the polynucleotides and polypeptides of the invention.
  • Such salts can be prepared, for example, from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic bases, including organic bases (e.g., salts of primary, secondary and tertiary amines and basic amino acids) and inorganic bases (e.g., sodium, potassium, lithium, ammonium, calcium and magnesium salts).
  • illustrative immunogenic compositions e.g., vaccine compositions, of the present invention comprise DNA encoding one or more of the polypeptides as described above, such that the polypeptide is generated in situ.
  • the polynucleotide may be administered within any of a variety of delivery systems known to those of ordinary skill in the art. Indeed, numerous gene delivery techniques are well known in the art, such as those described by Rolland, Crit. Rev. Therap. Drug Carrier Systems 15:143-198, 1998 , and references cited therein. Appropriate polynucleotide expression systems will, of course, contain the necessary regulatory DNA regulatory sequences for expression in a patient (such as a suitable promoter and terminating signal).
  • bacterial delivery systems may involve the administration of a bacterium (such as Bacillus-Calmette-Guerrin) that expresses an immunogenic portion of the polypeptide on its cell surface or secretes such an epitope.
  • polynucleotides encoding immunogenic polypeptides described herein are introduced into suitable mammalian host cells for expression using any of a number of known viral-based systems.
  • retroviruses provide a convenient and effective platform for gene delivery systems.
  • a selected nucleotide sequence encoding a polypeptide of the present invention can be inserted into a vector and packaged in retroviral particles using techniques known in the art. The recombinant virus can then be isolated and delivered to a subject.
  • retroviral systems have been described (e.g. , U.S. Pat. No.
  • adenovirus-based systems have also been described. Unlike retroviruses which integrate into the host genome, adenoviruses persist extrachromosomally thus minimizing the risks associated with insertional mutagenesis ( Haj-Ahmad and Graham (1986) J. Virol. 57:267-274 ; Bett et al. (1993) J. Virol. 67:5911-5921 ; Mittereder et al. (1994) Human Gene Therapy 5:717-729 ; Seth et al. (1994) J. Virol. 68:933-940 ; Barr et al. (1994) Gene Therapy 1:51-58 ; Berkner, K. L. (1988) BioTechniques 6:616-629 ; and Rich et al. (1993) Human Gene Therapy 4:461-476 ).
  • AAV vectors can be readily constructed using techniques well known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,173,414 and 5,139,941 ; International Publication Nos. WO 92/01070 and WO 93/03769 ; Lebkowski et al. (1988) Molec. Cell. Biol. 8:3988-3996 ; Vincent et al. (1990) Vaccines 90 (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press ); Carter, B. J. (1992) Current Opinion in Biotechnology 3:533-539 ; Muzyczka, N.
  • Additional viral vectors useful for delivering the polynucleotides encoding polypeptides of the present invention by gene transfer include those derived from the pox family of viruses, such as vaccinia virus and avian poxvirus.
  • vaccinia virus recombinants expressing the novel molecules can be constructed as follows. The DNA encoding a polypeptide is first inserted into an appropriate vector so that it is adjacent to a vaccinia promoter and flanking vaccinia DNA sequences, such as the sequence encoding thymidine kinase (TK). This vector is then used to transfect cells which are simultaneously infected with vaccinia.
  • TK thymidine kinase
  • Homologous recombination serves to insert the vaccinia promoter plus the gene encoding the polypeptide of interest into the viral genome.
  • the resulting TK.sup.(-) recombinant can be selected by culturing the cells in the presence of 5-bromodeoxyuridine and picking viral plaques resistant thereto.
  • a vaccinia-based infection/transfection system can be conveniently used to provide for inducible, transient expression or coexpression of one or more polypeptides described herein in host cells of an organism.
  • cells are first infected in vitro with a vaccinia virus recombinant that encodes the bacteriophage T7 RNA polymerase.
  • This polymerase displays extraordinar specificity in that it only transcribes templates bearing T7 promoters.
  • cells are transfected with the polynucleotide or polynucleotides of interest, driven by a T7 promoter.
  • the polymerase expressed in the cytoplasm from the vaccinia virus recombinant transcribes the transfected DNA into RNA which is then translated into polypeptide by the host translational machinery.
  • the method provides for high level, transient, cytoplasmic production of large quantities of RNA and its translation products. See, e.g., Elroy-Stein and Moss, Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA (1990) 87:6743-6747 ; Fuerst et al. Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA (1986) 83:8122-8126 .
  • avipoxviruses such as the fowlpox and canarypox viruses
  • canarypox viruses can also be used to deliver the coding sequences of interest.
  • Recombinant avipox viruses expressing immunogens from mammalian pathogens, are known to confer protective immunity when administered to non-avian species.
  • the use of an Avipox vector is particularly desirable in human and other mammalian species since members of the Avipox genus can only productively replicate in susceptible avian species and therefore are not infective in mammalian cells.
  • Methods for producing recombinant Avipoxviruses are known in the art and employ genetic recombination, as described above with respect to the production of vaccinia viruses. See, e.g., WO 91/12882 ; WO 89/03429 ; and WO 92/03545 .
  • alphavirus vectors can also be used for delivery of polynucleotide compositions of the present invention, such as those vectors described in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,843,723 ; 6,015,686 ; 6,008,035 and 6,015,694 .
  • Certain vectors based on Venezuelan Equine Encephalitis (VEE) can also be used, illustrative examples of which can be found in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,505,947 and 5,643,576 .
  • molecular conjugate vectors such as the adenovirus chimeric vectors described in Michael et al. J. Biol. Chem. (1993) 268:6866-6869 and Wagner et al. Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA (1992) 89:6099-6103 , can also be used for gene delivery under the invention.
  • a polynucleotide may be integrated into the genome of a target cell. This integration may be in a specific location and orientation via homologous recombination (gene replacement) or it may be integrated in a random, non-specific location (gene augmentation).
  • the polynucleotide may be stably maintained in the cell as a separate, episomal segment of DNA. Such polynucleotide segments or "episomes" encode sequences sufficient to permit maintenance and replication independent of or in synchronization with the host cell cycle. The manner in which the expression construct is delivered to a cell and where in the cell the polynucleotide remains is dependent on the type of expression construct employed.
  • a polynucleotide is administered/delivered as "naked" DNA, for example as described in Ulmer et al., Science 259:1745-1749, 1993 and reviewed by Cohen, Science 259:1691-1692, 1993 .
  • the uptake of naked DNA may be increased by coating the DNA onto biodegradable beads, which are efficiently transported into the cells.
  • a composition of the present invention can be delivered via a particle bombardment approach, many of which have been described.
  • gas-driven particle acceleration can be achieved with devices such as those manufactured by Powderject Pharmaceuticals PLC (Oxford, UK) and Powderject Vaccines Inc. (Madison, Wl), some examples of which are described in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,846,796 ; 6,010,478 ; 5,865,796 ; 5,584,807 ; and EP Patent No. 0500 799 .
  • This approach offers a needle-free delivery approach wherein a dry powder formulation of microscopic particles, such as polynucleotide or polypeptide particles, are accelerated to high speed within a helium gas jet generated by a hand held device, propelling the particles into a target tissue of interest.
  • microscopic particles such as polynucleotide or polypeptide particles
  • compositions of the present invention include those provided by Bioject, Inc. (Portland, OR), some examples of which are described in U.S. Patent Nos. 4,790,824 ; 5,064,413 ; 5,312,335 ; 5,383,851 ; 5,399,163 ; 5,520,639 and 5,993,412 .
  • the pharmaceutical compositions described herein will comprise one or more immunostimulants in addition to the immunogenic polynucleotide, polypeptide, antibody, T-cell and/or APC compositions of this invention.
  • An immunostimulant refers to essentially any substance that enhances or potentiates an immune response (antibody and/or cell-mediated) to an exogenous antigen.
  • One preferred type of immunostimulant comprises an adjuvant.
  • Many adjuvants contain a substance designed to protect the antigen from rapid catabolism, such as aluminum hydroxide or mineral oil, and a stimulator of immune responses, such as lipid A, Bortadella pertussis or Mycobacterium tuberculosis derived proteins.
  • adjuvants are commercially available as, for example, Freund's Incomplete Adjuvant and Complete Adjuvant (Difco Laboratories, Detroit, MI); Merck Adjuvant 65 (Merck and Company, Inc., Rahway, NJ); AS-2 (SmithKline Beecham, Philadelphia, PA); aluminum salts such as aluminum hydroxide gel (alum) or aluminum phosphate; salts of calcium, iron or zinc; an insoluble suspension of acylated tyrosine; acylated sugars; cationically or anionically derivatized polysaccharides; polyphosphazenes; biodegradable microspheres; monophosphoryl lipid A and quil A.
  • Cytokines such as GM-CSF, interleukin-2, -7, -12, and other like growth factors, may also be used as adjuvants.
  • the adjuvant composition is preferably one that induces an immune response predominantly of the Th1 type.
  • High levels of Th1-type cytokines e.g., IFN- ⁇ , TNF ⁇ , IL-2 and IL-12
  • high levels of Th2-type cytokines e.g., IL-4, IL-5, IL-6 and IL-10
  • a patient will support an immune response that includes Th1- and Th2-type responses.
  • Th1-type cytokines will increase to a greater extent than the level of Th2-type cytokines.
  • the levels of these cytokines may be readily assessed using standard assays. For a review of the families of cytokines, see Mosmann and Coffman, Ann. Rev. Immunol. 7:145-173, 1989 .
  • Certain preferred adjuvants for eliciting a predominantly Th1-type response include, for example, a combination of monophosphoryl lipid A, preferably 3-de-O-acylated monophosphoryl lipid A, together with an aluminum salt.
  • MPL® adjuvants are available from Corixa Corporation (Seattle, WA; see, for example, US Patent Nos. 4,436,727 ; 4,877,611 ; 4,866,034 and 4,912,094 ).
  • CpG-containing oligonucleotides in which the CpG dinucleotide is unmethylated also induce a predominantly Th1 response.
  • oligonucleotides are well known and are described, for example, in WO 96/02555 , WO 99/33488 and U.S. Patent Nos. 6,008,200 and 5,856,462 .
  • Immunostimulatory DNA sequences are also described, for example, by Sato et al., Science 273:352, 1996 .
  • Another preferred adjuvant comprises a saponin, such as Quil A, or derivatives thereof, including QS21 and QS7 (Aquila Biopharmaceuticals Inc., Framingham, MA); Escin; Digitonin; or Gypsophila or Chenopodium quinoa saponins .
  • Other preferred formulations include more than one saponin in the adjuvant combinations of the present invention, for example combinations of at least two of the following group comprising QS21, QS7, Quil A, ⁇ -escin, or digitonin.
  • the saponin formulations may be combined with vaccine vehicles composed of chitosan or other polycationic polymers, polylactide and polylactide-co-glycolide particles, poly-N-acetyl glucosamine-based polymer matrix, particles composed of polysaccharides or chemically modified polysaccharides, liposomes and lipid-based particles, particles composed of glycerol monoesters, etc.
  • vaccine vehicles composed of chitosan or other polycationic polymers, polylactide and polylactide-co-glycolide particles, poly-N-acetyl glucosamine-based polymer matrix, particles composed of polysaccharides or chemically modified polysaccharides, liposomes and lipid-based particles, particles composed of glycerol monoesters, etc.
  • the saponins may also be formulated in the presence of cholesterol to form particulate structures such as liposomes or ISCOMs.
  • the saponins may be formulated together with a polyoxyethylene ether or ester, in either a non-particulate solution or suspension, or in a particulate structure such as a paucilamelar liposome or ISCOM.
  • the saponins may also be formulated with excipients such as Carbopol R to increase viscosity, or may be formulated in a dry powder form with a powder excipient such as lactose.
  • the adjuvant system includes the combination of a monophosphoryl lipid A and a saponin derivative, such as the combination of QS21 and 3D-MPL® adjuvant, as described in WO 94/00153 , or a less reactogenic composition where the QS21 is quenched with cholesterol, as described in WO 96/33739 .
  • Other preferred formulations comprise an oil-inwater emulsion and tocopherol.
  • Another particularly preferred adjuvant formulation employing QS21, 3D-MPL® adjuvant and tocopherol in an oil-inwater emulsion is described in WO 95/17210 .
  • Another enhanced adjuvant system involves the combination of a CpG-containing oligonucleotide and a saponin derivative particularly the combination of CpG and QS21 is disclosed in WO 00/09159 .
  • the formulation additionally comprises an oil in water emulsion and tocopherol.
  • Additional illustrative adjuvants for use in the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention include Montanide ISA 720 (Seppic, France), SAF (Chiron, California, United States), ISCOMS (CSL), MF-59 (Chiron), the SBAS series of adjuvants (e.g., SBAS-2 or SBAS-4, available from SmithKline Beecham, Rixensart, Belgium), Detox (Enhanzyn®; Corixa, Hamilton, MT), RC-529 (Corixa, Hamilton, MT) and other aminoalkyl glucosaminide 4-phosphates (AGPs), such as those described in pending U.S. Patent Application Serial Nos. 08/853,826 and 09/074,720 , the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entireties, and polyoxyethylene ether adjuvants such as those described in WO 99/52549A1 .
  • SBAS series of adjuvants e.g., SBAS-2 or SBAS-4, available
  • One embodiment of the present invention consists of a vaccine formulation comprising a polyoxyethylene ether of general formula (I), wherein n is between 1 and 50, preferably 4-24, most preferably 9; the R component is C 1-50 , preferably C 4 -C 20 alkyl and most preferably C 12 alkyl, and A is a bond.
  • the concentration of the polyoxyethylene ethers should be in the range 0.1-20%, preferably from 0.1-10%, and most preferably in the range 0.1-1%.
  • Preferred polyoxyethylene ethers are selected from the following group: polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether, polyoxyethylene-9-steoryl ether, polyoxyethylene-8-steoryl ether, polyoxyethylene-4-lauryl ether, polyoxyethylene-35-lauryl ether, and polyoxyethylene-23-lauryl ether.
  • Polyoxyethylene ethers such as polyoxyethylene lauryl ether are described in the Merck index (12 th edition: entry 7717). These adjuvant molecules are described in WO 99/52549 .
  • the polyoxyethylene ether according to the general formula (I) above may, if desired, be combined with another adjuvant.
  • a preferred adjuvant combination is preferably with CpG as described in the pending UK patent application GB 9820956.2 .
  • an immunogenic composition described herein is delivered to a host via antigen presenting cells (APCs), such as dendritic cells, macrophages, B cells, monocytes and other cells that may be engineered to be efficient APCs.
  • APCs antigen presenting cells
  • Such cells may, but need not, be genetically modified to increase the capacity for presenting the antigen, to improve activation and/or maintenance of the T cell response, to have anti-tumor effects per se and/or to be immunologically compatible with the receiver ( i . e ., matched HLA haplotype).
  • APCs may generally be isolated from any of a variety of biological fluids and organs, including tumor and peritumoral tissues, and may be autologous, allogeneic, syngeneic or xenogeneic cells.
  • Dendritic cells are highly potent APCs ( Banchereau and Steinman, Nature 392:245-251, 1998 ) and have been shown to be effective as a physiological adjuvant for eliciting prophylactic or therapeutic antitumor immunity (see Timmerman and Levy, Ann. Rev. Med. 50:507-529, 1999 ).
  • dendritic cells may be identified based on their typical shape (stellate in situ, with marked cytoplasmic processes (dendrites) visible in vitro), their ability to take up, process and present antigens with high efficiency and their ability to activate na ⁇ ve T cell responses.
  • Dendritic cells may, of course, be engineered to express specific cell-surface receptors or ligands that are not commonly found on dendritic cells in vivo or ex vivo, and such modified dendritic cells are contemplated by the present invention.
  • secreted vesicles antigen-loaded dendritic cells called exosomes
  • exosomes antigen-loaded dendritic cells
  • Dendritic cells and progenitors may be obtained from peripheral blood, bone marrow, tumor-infiltrating cells, peritumoral tissues-infiltrating cells, lymph nodes, spleen, skin, umbilical cord blood or any other suitable tissue or fluid.
  • dendritic cells may be differentiated ex vivo by adding a combination of cytokines such as GM-CSF, IL-4, IL-13 and/or TNF ⁇ to cultures of monocytes harvested from peripheral blood.
  • CD34 positive cells harvested from peripheral blood, umbilical cord blood or bone marrow may be differentiated into dendritic cells by adding to the culture medium combinations of GM-CSF, IL-3, TNF ⁇ , CD40 ligand, LPS, flt3 ligand and/or other compound(s) that induce differentiation, maturation and proliferation of dendritic cells.
  • Dendritic cells are conveniently categorized as “immature” and “mature” cells, which allows a simple way to discriminate between two well characterized phenotypes. However, this nomenclature should not be construed to exclude all possible intermediate stages of differentiation. Immature dendritic cells are characterized as APC with a high capacity for antigen uptake and processing, which correlates with the high expression of Fc ⁇ receptor and mannose receptor.
  • the mature phenotype is typically characterized by a lower expression of these markers, but a high expression of cell surface molecules responsible for T cell activation such as class I and class II MHC, adhesion molecules (e.g., CD54 and CD11) and costimulatory molecules (e.g., CD40, CD80, CD86 and 4-1 BB).
  • class I and class II MHC cell surface molecules responsible for T cell activation
  • adhesion molecules e.g., CD54 and CD11
  • costimulatory molecules e.g., CD40, CD80, CD86 and 4-1 BB.
  • APCs may generally be transfected with a polynucleotide of the invention (or portion or other variant thereof) such that the encoded polypeptide, or an immunogenic portion thereof, is expressed on the cell surface. Such transfection may take place ex vivo, and a pharmaceutical composition comprising such transfected cells may then be used for therapeutic purposes, as described herein. Alternatively, a gene delivery vehicle that targets a dendritic or other antigen presenting cell may be administered to a patient, resulting in transfection that occurs in vivo.
  • In vivo and ex vivo transfection of dendritic cells may generally be performed using any methods known in the art, such as those described in WO 97/24447 , or the gene gun approach described by Mahvi et al., Immunology and cell Biology 75:456-460, 1997 .
  • Antigen loading of dendritic cells may be achieved by incubating dendritic cells or progenitor cells with the tumor polypeptide, DNA (naked or within a plasmid vector) or RNA; or with antigen-expressing recombinant bacterium or viruses (e.g., vaccinia, fowlpox, adenovirus or lentivirus vectors).
  • the polypeptide Prior to loading, the polypeptide may be covalently conjugated to an immunological partner that provides T cell help (e.g., a carrier molecule).
  • an immunological partner that provides T cell help e.g., a carrier molecule.
  • a dendritic cell may be pulsed with a non-conjugated immunological partner, separately or in the presence of the polypeptide.
  • compositions of the present invention may be formulated for any appropriate manner of administration, including for example, topical, oral, nasal, mucosal, intravenous, intracranial, intraperitoneal, subcutaneous and intramuscular administration.
  • Carriers for use within such pharmaceutical compositions are biocompatible, and may also be biodegradable.
  • the formulation preferably provides a relatively constant level of active component release. In other embodiments, however, a more rapid rate of release immediately upon administration may be desired.
  • the formulation of such compositions is well within the level of ordinary skill in the art using known techniques.
  • Illustrative carriers useful in this regard include microparticles of poly(lactide-co-glycolide), polyacrylate, latex, starch, cellulose, dextran and the like.
  • illustrative delayed-release carriers include supramolecular biovectors, which comprise a non-liquid hydrophilic core (e.g., a cross-linked polysaccharide or oligosaccharide) and, optionally, an external layer comprising an amphiphilic compound, such as a phospholipid (see e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,151,254 and PCT applications WO 94/20078 , WO/94/23701 and WO 96/06638 ).
  • the amount of active compound contained within a sustained release formulation depends upon the site of implantation, the rate and expected duration of release and the nature of the condition to be treated or prevented.
  • biodegradable microspheres e.g., polylactate polyglycolate
  • Suitable biodegradable microspheres are disclosed, for example, in U.S. Patent Nos. 4,897,268 ; 5,075,109 ; 5,928,647 ; 5,811,128 ; 5,820,883 ; 5,853,763 ; 5,814,344 , 5,407,609 and 5,942,252 .
  • Modified hepatitis B core protein carrier systems such as described in WO/99 40934 , and references cited therein, will also be useful for many applications.
  • Another illustrative carrier/delivery system employs a carrier comprising particulate-protein complexes, such as those described in U.S. Patent No. 5,928,647 , which are capable of inducing a class I-restricted cytotoxic T lymphocyte responses in a host.
  • compositions of the invention will often further comprise one or more buffers (e.g., neutral buffered saline or phosphate buffered saline), carbohydrates (e.g., glucose, mannose, sucrose or dextrans), mannitol, proteins, polypeptides or amino acids such as glycine, antioxidants, bacteriostats, chelating agents such as EDTA or glutathione, adjuvants (e.g., aluminum hydroxide), solutes that render the formulation isotonic, hypotonic or weakly hypertonic with the blood of a recipient, suspending agents, thickening agents and/or preservatives.
  • buffers e.g., neutral buffered saline or phosphate buffered saline
  • carbohydrates e.g., glucose, mannose, sucrose or dextrans
  • mannitol proteins
  • proteins polypeptides or amino acids
  • proteins e.glycine
  • antioxidants e.g., gly
  • compositions described herein may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, such as sealed ampoules or vials. Such containers are typically sealed in such a way to preserve the sterility and stability of the formulation until use.
  • formulations may be stored as suspensions, solutions or emulsions in oily or aqueous vehicles.
  • a pharmaceutical composition may be stored in a freeze-dried condition requiring only the addition of a sterile liquid carrier immediately prior to use.
  • compositions disclosed herein may be delivered via oral administration to an animal.
  • these compositions may be formulated with an inert diluent or with an assimilable edible carrier, or they may be enclosed in hard- or soft-shell gelatin capsule, or they may be compressed into tablets, or they may be incorporated directly with the food of the diet.
  • the active compounds may even be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of ingestible tablets, buccal tables, troches, capsules, elixirs, suspensions, syrups, wafers, and the like (see, for example, Mathiowitz et al., Nature 1997 Mar 27;386(6623):410-4 ; Hwang et al., Crit Rev Ther Drug Carrier Syst 1998;15(3):243-84 ; U. S. Patent 5,641,515 ; U. S. Patent 5,580,579 and U. S. Patent 5,792,451 ).
  • Tablets, troches, pills, capsules and the like may also contain any of a variety of additional components, for example, a binder, such as gum tragacanth, acacia, cornstarch, or gelatin; excipients, such as dicalcium phosphate; a disintegrating agent, such as corn starch, potato starch, alginic acid and the like; a lubricant, such as magnesium stearate; and a sweetening agent, such as sucrose, lactose or saccharin may be added or a flavoring agent, such as peppermint, oil of wintergreen, or cherry flavoring.
  • a binder such as gum tragacanth, acacia, cornstarch, or gelatin
  • excipients such as dicalcium phosphate
  • a disintegrating agent such as corn starch, potato starch, alginic acid and the like
  • a lubricant such as magnesium stearate
  • a sweetening agent such as sucrose, lactose
  • any material used in preparing any dosage unit form should be pharmaceutically pure and substantially non-toxic in the amounts employed.
  • the active compounds may be incorporated into sustained-release preparation and formulations.
  • these formulations will contain at least about 0.1% of the active compound or more, although the percentage of the active ingredient(s) may, of course, be varied and may conveniently be between about 1 or 2% and about 60% or 70% or more of the weight or volume of the total formulation.
  • the amount of active compound(s) in each therapeutically useful composition may be prepared is such a way that a suitable dosage will be obtained in any given unit dose of the compound.
  • Factors such as solubility, bioavailability, biological half-life, route of administration, product shelf life, as well as other pharmacological considerations will be contemplated by one skilled in the art of preparing such pharmaceutical formulations, and as such, a variety of dosages and treatment regimens may be desirable.
  • compositions of the present invention may alternatively be incorporated with one or more excipients in the form of a mouthwash, dentifrice, buccal tablet, oral spray, or sublingual orally-administered formulation.
  • the active ingredient may be incorporated into an oral solution such as one containing sodium borate, glycerin and potassium bicarbonate, or dispersed in a dentifrice, or added in a therapeutically-effective amount to a composition that may include water, binders, abrasives, flavoring agents, foaming agents, and humectants.
  • the compositions may be fashioned into a tablet or solution form that may be placed under the tongue or otherwise dissolved in the mouth.
  • solutions of the active compounds as free base or pharmacologically acceptable salts may be prepared in water suitably mixed with a surfactant, such as hydroxypropylcellulose.
  • Dispersions may also be prepared in glycerol, liquid polyethylene glycols, and mixtures thereof and in oils. Under ordinary conditions of storage and use, these preparations generally will contain a preservative to prevent the growth of microorganisms.
  • Illustrative pharmaceutical forms suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersions (for example, see U. S. Patent 5,466,468 ).
  • the form must be sterile and must be fluid to the extent that easy syringability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms, such as bacteria and fungi.
  • the carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), suitable mixtures thereof, and/or vegetable oils.
  • polyol e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • suitable mixtures thereof e.g., vegetable oils
  • vegetable oils e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • suitable mixtures thereof e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • vegetable oils e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • Proper fluidity may be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion
  • isotonic agents for example, sugars or sodium chloride.
  • Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by the use in the compositions of agents delaying absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • the solution for parenteral administration in an aqueous solution, should be suitably buffered if necessary and the liquid diluent first rendered isotonic with sufficient saline or glucose.
  • aqueous solutions are especially suitable for intravenous, intramuscular, subcutaneous and intraperitoneal administration.
  • a sterile aqueous medium that can be employed will be known to those of skill in the art in light of the present disclosure.
  • one dosage may be dissolved in 1 ml of isotonic NaCl solution and either added to 1000 ml of hypodermoclysis fluid or injected at the proposed site of infusion, (see for example, " Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences” 15th Edition, pages 1035-1038 and 1570-1580 ). Some variation in dosage will necessarily occur depending on the condition of the subject being treated. Moreover, for human administration, preparations will of course preferably meet sterility, pyrogenicity, and the general safety and purity standards as required by FDA Office of Biologics standards.
  • compositions disclosed herein may be formulated in a neutral or salt form.
  • Illustrative pharmaceutically-acceptable salts include the acid addition salts (formed with the free amino groups of the protein) and which are formed with inorganic acids such as, for example, hydrochloric or phosphoric acids, or such organic acids as acetic, oxalic, tartaric, mandelic, and the like. Salts formed with the free carboxyl groups can also be derived from inorganic bases such as, for example, sodium, potassium, ammonium, calcium, or ferric hydroxides, and such organic bases as isopropylamine, trimethylamine, histidine, procaine and the like. Upon formulation, solutions will be administered in a manner compatible with the dosage formulation and in such amount as is therapeutically effective.
  • the carriers can further comprise any and all solvents, dispersion media, vehicles, coatings, diluents, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents, buffers, carrier solutions, suspensions, colloids, and the like.
  • solvents dispersion media, vehicles, coatings, diluents, antibacterial and antifungal agents, isotonic and absorption delaying agents, buffers, carrier solutions, suspensions, colloids, and the like.
  • the use of such media and agents for pharmaceutical active substances is well known in the art. Except insofar as any conventional media or agent is incompatible with the active ingredient, its use in the therapeutic compositions is contemplated. Supplementary active ingredients can also be incorporated into the compositions.
  • pharmaceutically-acceptable refers to molecular entities and compositions that do not produce an allergic or similar untoward reaction when administered to a human.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions may be delivered by intranasal sprays, inhalation, and/or other aerosol delivery vehicles.
  • Methods for delivering genes, nucleic acids, and peptide compositions directly to the lungs via nasal aerosol sprays has been described, e.g., in U. S. Patent 5,756,353 and U. S. Patent 5,804,212 .
  • the delivery of drugs using intranasal microparticle resins Takenaga et al., J Controlled Release 1998 Mar 2;52(1-2):81-7
  • lysophosphatidyl-glycerol compounds U. S. Patent 5,725,871
  • illustrative transmucosal drug delivery in the form of a polytetrafluoroetheylene support matrix is described in U. S. Patent 5,780,045 .
  • compositions of the present invention are used for the introduction of the compositions of the present invention into suitable host cells/organisms.
  • the compositions of the present invention may be formulated for delivery either encapsulated in a lipid particle, a liposome, a vesicle, a nanosphere, or a nanoparticle or the like.
  • compositions of the present invention can be bound, either covalently or non-covalently, to the surface of such carrier vehicles.
  • liposome and liposome-like preparations as potential drug carriers is generally known to those of skill in the art (see for example, Lasic, Trends Biotechnol 1998 Jul;16(7):307-21 ; Takakura, Nippon Rinsho 1998 Mar;56(3):691-5 ; Chandran et al., Indian J Exp Biol. 1997 Aug;35(8):801-9 ; Margalit, Crit Rev Ther Drug Carrier Syst. 1995;12(2-3):233-61 ; U.S. Patent 5,567,434 ; U.S. Patent 5,552,157 ; U.S. Patent 5,565,213 ; U.S. Patent 5,738,868 and U.S. Patent 5,795,587 , each specifically incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
  • Liposomes have been used successfully with a number of cell types that are normally difficult to transfect by other procedures, including T cell suspensions, primary hepatocyte cultures and PC 12 cells ( Renneisen et al., J Biol Chem. 1990 Sep 25;265(27):16337-42 ; Muller et al., DNA Cell Biol. 1990 Apr;9(3):221-9 ).
  • liposomes are free of the DNA length constraints that are typical of viral-based delivery systems. Liposomes have been used effectively to introduce genes, various drugs, radiotherapeutic agents, enzymes, viruses, transcription factors, allosteric effectors and the like, into a variety of cultured cell lines and animals. Furthermore, he use of liposomes does not appear to be associated with autoimmune responses or unacceptable toxicity after systemic delivery.
  • liposomes are formed from phospholipids that are dispersed in an aqueous medium and spontaneously form multilamellar concentric bilayer vesicles (also termed multilamellar vesicles (MLVs).
  • MLVs multilamellar vesicles
  • the invention provides for pharmaceutically-acceptable nanocapsule formulations of the compositions of the present invention.
  • Nanocapsules can generally entrap compounds in a stable and reproducible way (see, for example, Quintanar-Guerrero et al., Drug Dev Ind Pharm. 1998 Dec;24(12): 1113-28 ).
  • ultrafine particles sized around 0.1 ⁇ m
  • Such particles can be made as described, for example, by Couvreur et al., Crit Rev Ther Drug Carrier Syst.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions described herein may be used for the treatment of cancer, particularly for the immunotherapy of prostate cancer.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions described herein are administered to a patient, typically a warm-blooded animal, preferably a human.
  • a patient may or may not be afflicted with cancer.
  • the above pharmaceutical compositions may be used to prevent the development of a cancer or to treat a patient afflicted with a cancer.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be administered either prior to or following surgical removal of primary tumors and/or treatment such as administration of radiotherapy or conventional chemotherapeutic drugs.
  • administration of the pharmaceutical compositions may be by any suitable method, including administration by intravenous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular, subcutaneous, intranasal, intradermal, anal, vaginal, topical and oral routes.
  • immunotherapy may be active immunotherapy, in which treatment relies on the in vivo stimulation of the endogenous host immune system to react against tumors with the administration of immune response-modifying agents (such as polypeptides and polynucleotides as provided herein).
  • immune response-modifying agents such as polypeptides and polynucleotides as provided herein.
  • immunotherapy may be passive immunotherapy, in which treatment involves the delivery of agents with established tumor-immune reactivity (such as effector cells or antibodies) that can directly or indirectly mediate antitumor effects and does not necessarily depend on an intact host immune system.
  • agents with established tumor-immune reactivity such as effector cells or antibodies
  • effector cells include T cells as discussed above, T lymphocytes (such as CD8 + cytotoxic T lymphocytes and CD4 + T-helper tumor-infiltrating lymphocytes), killer cells (such as Natural Killer cells and lymphokine-activated killer cells), B cells and antigen-presenting cells (such as dendritic cells and macrophages) expressing a polypeptide provided herein.
  • T cell receptors and antibody receptors specific for the polypeptides recited herein may be cloned, expressed and transferred into other vectors or effector cells for adoptive immunotherapy.
  • the polypeptides provided herein may also be used to generate antibodies or anti-idiotypic antibodies (as described above and in U.S. Patent No. 4,918,164 ) for passive immunotherapy.
  • Effector cells may generally be obtained in sufficient quantities for adoptive immunotherapy by growth in vitro, as described herein.
  • Culture conditions for expanding single antigen-specific effector cells to several billion in number with retention of antigen recognition in vivo are well known in the art.
  • Such in vitro culture conditions typically use intermittent stimulation with antigen, often in the presence of cytokines (such as IL-2) and non-dividing feeder cells.
  • cytokines such as IL-2
  • immunoreactive polypeptides as provided herein may be used to rapidly expand antigen-specific T cell cultures in order to generate a sufficient number of cells for immunotherapy.
  • antigen-presenting cells such as dendritic, macrophage, monocyte, fibroblast and/or B cells
  • antigen-presenting cells may be pulsed with immunoreactive polypeptides or transfected with one or more polynucleotides using standard techniques well known in the art.
  • antigen-presenting cells can be transfected with a polynucleotide having a promoter appropriate for increasing expression in a recombinant virus or other expression system.
  • Cultured effector cells for use in therapy must be able to grow and distribute widely, and to survive long term in vivo.
  • a vector expressing a polypeptide recited herein may be introduced into antigen presenting cells taken from a patient and clonally propagated ex vivo for transplant back into the same patient.
  • Transfected cells may be reintroduced into the patient using any means known in the art, preferably in sterile form by intravenous, intracavitary, intraperitoneal or intratumor administration.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions and vaccines may be administered by injection (e.g., intracutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or subcutaneous), intranasally (e.g., by aspiration) or orally.
  • injection e.g., intracutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or subcutaneous
  • intranasally e.g., by aspiration
  • between 1 and 10 doses may be administered over a 52 week period.
  • 6 doses are administered, at intervals of 1 month, and booster vaccinations may be given periodically thereafter.
  • Alternate protocols may be appropriate for individual patients.
  • a suitable dose is an amount of a compound that, when administered as described above, is capable of promoting an anti-tumor immune response, and is at least 10-50% above the basal ( i.e., untreated) level.
  • Such response can be monitored by measuring the anti-tumor antibodies in a patient or by vaccine-dependent generation of cytolytic effector cells capable of killing the patient's tumor cells in vitro.
  • Such vaccines should also be capable of causing an immune response that leads to an improved clinical outcome (e.g., more frequent remissions, complete or partial or longer disease-free survival) in vaccinated patients as compared to non-vaccinated patients.
  • the amount of each polypeptide present in a dose ranges from about 25 ⁇ g to 5 mg per kg of host. Suitable dose sizes will vary with the size of the patient, but will typically range from about 0.1 mL to about 5 mL.
  • an appropriate dosage and treatment regimen provides the active compound(s) in an amount sufficient to provide therapeutic and/or prophylactic benefit.
  • a response can be monitored by establishing an improved clinical outcome (e.g., more frequent remissions, complete or partial, or longer disease-free survival) in treated patients as compared to non-treated patients.
  • Increases in preexisting immune responses to a tumor protein generally correlate with an improved clinical outcome.
  • Such immune responses may generally be evaluated using standard proliferation, cytotoxicity or cytokine assays, which may be performed using samples obtained from a patient before and after treatment.
  • a cancer may be detected in a patient based on the presence of one or more prostate tumor proteins and/or polynucleotides encoding such proteins in a biological sample (for example, blood, sera, sputum urine and/or tumor biopsies) obtained from the patient.
  • a biological sample for example, blood, sera, sputum urine and/or tumor biopsies
  • proteins may be used as markers to indicate the presence or absence of a cancer such as prostate cancer.
  • proteins may be useful for the detection of other cancers.
  • the binding agents provided herein generally permit detection of the level of antigen that binds to the agent in the biological sample.
  • Polynucleotide primers and probes may be used to detect the level of mRNA encoding a tumor protein, which is also indicative of the presence or absence of a cancer.
  • a prostate tumor sequence should be present at a level that is at least three fold higher in tumor tissue than in normal tissue
  • the presence or absence of a cancer in a patient may be determined by (a) contacting a biological sample obtained from a patient with a binding agent; (b) detecting in the sample a level of polypeptide that binds to the binding agent; and (c) comparing the level of polypeptide with a predetermined cut-off value.
  • the assay involves the use of binding agent immobilized on a solid support to bind to and remove the polypeptide from the remainder of the sample.
  • the bound polypeptide may then be detected using a detection reagent that contains a reporter group and specifically binds to the binding agent/polypeptide complex.
  • detection reagents may comprise, for example, a binding agent that specifically binds to the polypeptide or an antibody or other agent that specifically binds to the binding agent, such as an anti-immunoglobulin, protein G, protein A or a lectin.
  • a competitive assay may be utilized, in which a polypeptide is labeled with a reporter group and allowed to bind to the immobilized binding agent after incubation of the binding agent with the sample.
  • the extent to which components of the sample inhibit the binding of the labeled polypeptide to the binding agent is indicative of the reactivity of the sample with the immobilized binding agent.
  • Suitable polypeptides for use within such assays include full length prostate tumor proteins and polypeptide portions thereof to which the binding agent binds, as described above.
  • the solid support may be any material known to those of ordinary skill in the art to which the tumor protein may be attached.
  • the solid support may be a test well in a microtiter plate or a nitrocellulose or other suitable membrane.
  • the support may be a bead or disc, such as glass, fiberglass, latex or a plastic material such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride.
  • the support may also be a magnetic particle or a fiber optic sensor, such as those disclosed, for example, in U.S. Patent No. 5,359,681 .
  • the binding agent may be immobilized on the solid support using a variety of techniques known to those of skill in the art, which are amply described in the patent and scientific literature.
  • immobilization refers to both noncovalent association, such as adsorption, and covalent attachment (which may be a direct linkage between the agent and functional groups on the support or may be a linkage by way of a cross-linking agent). Immobilization by adsorption to a well in a microtiter plate or to a membrane is preferred. In such cases, adsorption may be achieved by contacting the binding agent, in a suitable buffer, with the solid support for a suitable amount of time. The contact time varies with temperature, but is typically between about 1 hour and about 1 day.
  • contacting a well of a plastic microtiter plate (such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride) with an amount of binding agent ranging from about 10 ng to about 10 ⁇ g, and preferably about 100 ng to about 1 ⁇ g, is sufficient to immobilize an adequate amount of binding agent.
  • a plastic microtiter plate such as polystyrene or polyvinylchloride
  • Covalent attachment of binding agent to a solid support may generally be achieved by first reacting the support with a bifunctional reagent that will react with both the support and a functional group, such as a hydroxyl or amino group, on the binding agent.
  • a bifunctional reagent that will react with both the support and a functional group, such as a hydroxyl or amino group, on the binding agent.
  • the binding agent may be covalently attached to supports having an appropriate polymer coating using benzoquinone or by condensation of an aldehyde group on the support with an amine and an active hydrogen on the binding partner (see, e.g., Pierce Immunotechnology Catalog and Handbook, 1991, atA12-A13 ).
  • the assay is a two-antibody sandwich assay. This assay may be performed by first contacting an antibody that has been immobilized on a solid support, commonly the well of a microtiter plate, with the sample, such that polypeptides within the sample are allowed to bind to the immobilized antibody. Unbound sample is then removed from the immobilized polypeptide-antibody complexes and a detection reagent (preferably a second antibody capable of binding to a different site on the polypeptide) containing a reporter group is added. The amount of detection reagent that remains bound to the solid support is then determined using a method appropriate for the specific reporter group.
  • a detection reagent preferably a second antibody capable of binding to a different site on the polypeptide
  • the immobilized antibody is then incubated with the sample, and polypeptide is allowed to bind to the antibody.
  • the sample may be diluted with a suitable diluent, such as phosphate-buffered saline (PBS) prior to incubation.
  • PBS phosphate-buffered saline
  • an appropriate contact time i.e., incubation time is a period of time that is sufficient to detect the presence of polypeptide within a sample obtained from an individual with prostate cancer.
  • the contact time is sufficient to achieve a level of binding that is at least about 95% of that achieved at equilibrium between bound and unbound polypeptide.
  • a level of binding that is at least about 95% of that achieved at equilibrium between bound and unbound polypeptide.
  • the time necessary to achieve equilibrium may be readily determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time. At room temperature, an incubation time of about 30 minutes is generally sufficient.
  • Unbound sample may then be removed by washing the solid support with an appropriate buffer, such as PBS containing 0.1 % Tween 20 TM .
  • the second antibody which contains a reporter group, may then be added to the solid support.
  • Preferred reporter groups include those groups recited above.
  • the detection reagent is then incubated with the immobilized antibody-polypeptide complex for an amount of time sufficient to detect the bound polypeptide.
  • An appropriate amount of time may generally be determined by assaying the level of binding that occurs over a period of time.
  • Unbound detection reagent is then removed and bound detection reagent is detected using the reporter group.
  • the method employed for detecting the reporter group depends upon the nature of the reporter group. For radioactive groups, scintillation counting or autoradiographic methods are generally appropriate. Spectroscopic methods may be used to detect dyes, luminescent groups and fluorescent groups. Biotin may be detected using avidin, coupled to a different reporter group (commonly a radioactive or fluorescent group or an enzyme). Enzyme reporter groups may generally be detected by the addition of substrate (generally for a specific period of time), followed by spectroscopic or other analysis of the reaction products.
  • the signal detected from the reporter group that remains bound to the solid support is generally compared to a signal that corresponds to a predetermined cut-off value.
  • the cut-off value for the detection of a cancer is the average mean signal obtained when the immobilized antibody is incubated with samples from patients without the cancer.
  • a sample generating a signal that is three standard deviations above the predetermined cut-off value is considered positive for the cancer.
  • the cut-off value is determined using a Receiver Operator Curve, according to the method of Sackett et al., Clinical Epidemiology: A Basic Science for Clinical Medicine, Little Brown and Co., 1985, p. 106-7 .
  • the cut-off value may be determined from a plot of pairs of true positive rates (i.e., sensitivity) and false positive rates (100%-specificity) that correspond to each possible cut-off value for the diagnostic test result.
  • the cut-off value on the plot that is the closest to the upper left-hand corner i.e ., the value that encloses the largest area
  • a sample generating a signal that is higher than the cut-off value determined by this method may be considered positive.
  • the cut-off value may be shifted to the left along the plot, to minimize the false positive rate, or to the right, to minimize the false negative rate.
  • a sample generating a signal that is higher than the cut-off value determined by this method is considered positive for a cancer.
  • the assay is performed in a flow-through or strip test format, wherein the binding agent is immobilized on a membrane, such as nitrocellulose.
  • a membrane such as nitrocellulose.
  • polypeptides within the sample bind to the immobilized binding agent as the sample passes through the membrane.
  • a second, labeled binding agent then binds to the binding agentpolypeptide complex as a solution containing the second binding agent flows through the membrane.
  • the detection of bound second binding agent may then be performed as described above.
  • the strip test format one end of the membrane to which binding agent is bound is immersed in a solution containing the sample. The sample migrates along the membrane through a region containing second binding agent and to the area of immobilized binding agent.
  • Concentration of second binding agent at the area of immobilized antibody indicates the presence of a cancer.
  • concentration of second binding agent at that site generates a pattern, such as a line, that can be read visually. The absence of such a pattern indicates a negative result.
  • the amount of binding agent immobilized on the membrane is selected to generate a visually discernible pattern when the biological sample contains a level of polypeptide that would be sufficient to generate a positive signal in the two-antibody sandwich assay, in the format discussed above.
  • Preferred binding agents for use in such assays are antibodies and antigen-binding fragments thereof.
  • the amount of antibody immobilized on the membrane ranges from about 25 ng to about 1 ⁇ g, and more preferably from about 50 ng to about 500 ng. Such tests can typically be performed with a very small amount of biological sample.
  • a cancer may also, or alternatively, be detected based on the presence of T cells that specifically react with a tumor protein in a biological sample.
  • a biological sample comprising CD4 + and/or CD8 + T cells isolated from a patient is incubated with a tumor polypeptide, a polynucleotide encoding such a polypeptide and/or an APC that expresses at least an immunogenic portion of such a polypeptide, and the presence or absence of specific activation of the T cells is detected.
  • Suitable biological samples include, but are not limited to, isolated T cells.
  • T cells may be isolated from a patient by routine techniques (such as by Ficoll/Hypaque density gradient centrifugation of peripheral blood lymphocytes).
  • T cells may be incubated in vitro for 2-9 days (typically 4 days) at 37°C with polypeptide (e.g., 5 - 25 ⁇ g/ml). It may be desirable to incubate another aliquot of a T cell sample in the absence of tumor polypeptide to serve as a control.
  • activation is preferably detected by evaluating proliferation of the T cells.
  • activation is preferably detected by evaluating cytolytic activity.
  • a level of proliferation that is at least two fold greater and/or a level of cytolytic activity that is at least 20% greater than in disease-free patients indicates the presence of a cancer in the patient.
  • a cancer may also, or alternatively, be detected based on the level of mRNA encoding a tumor protein in a biological sample.
  • at least two oligonucleotide primers may be employed in a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) based assay to amplify a portion of a tumor cDNA derived from a biological sample, wherein at least one of the oligonucleotide primers is specific for ( i.e. , hybridizes to) a polynucleotide encoding the tumor protein.
  • PCR polymerase chain reaction
  • the amplified cDNA is then separated and detected using techniques well known in the art, such as gel electrophoresis.
  • oligonucleotide probes that specifically hybridize to a polynucleotide encoding a tumor protein may be used in a hybridization assay to detect the presence of polynucleotide encoding the tumor protein in a biological sample.
  • oligonucleotide primers and probes should comprise an oligonucleotide sequence that has at least about 60%, preferably at least about 75% and more preferably at least about 90%, identity to a portion of a polynucleotide encoding a tumor protein of the invention that is at least 10 nucleotides, and preferably at least 20 nucleotides, in length.
  • oligonucleotide primers and/or probes hybridize to a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide described herein under moderately stringent conditions, as defined above.
  • Oligonucleotide primers and/or probes which may be usefully employed in the diagnostic methods described herein preferably are at least 10-40 nucleotides in length.
  • the oligonucleotide primers comprise at least 10 contiguous nucleotides, more preferably at least 15 contiguous nucleotides, of a DNA molecule having a sequence as disclosed herein.
  • Techniques for both PCR based assays and hybridization assays are well known in the art (see, for example, Mullis et al., Cold Spring Harbor Symp. Quant. Biol., 51:263, 1987 ; Erlich ed., PCR Technology, Stockton Press, NY, 1989 ).
  • RNA is extracted from a biological sample, such as biopsy tissue, and is reverse transcribed to produce cDNA molecules.
  • PCR amplification using at least one specific primer generates a cDNA molecule, which may be separated and visualized using, for example, gel electrophoresis.
  • Amplification may be performed on biological samples taken from a test patient and from an individual who is not afflicted with a cancer. The amplification reaction may be performed on several dilutions of cDNA spanning two orders of magnitude. A two-fold or greater increase in expression in several dilutions of the test patient sample as compared to the same dilutions of the non-cancerous sample is typically considered positive.
  • compositions described herein may be used as markers for the progression of cancer.
  • assays as described above for the diagnosis of a cancer may be performed over time, and the change in the level of reactive polypeptide(s) or polynucleotide(s) evaluated.
  • the assays may be performed every 24-72 hours for a period of 6 months to 1 year, and thereafter performed as needed.
  • a cancer is progressing in those patients in whom the level of polypeptide or polynucleotide detected increases over time.
  • the cancer is not progressing when the level of reactive polypeptide or polynucleotide either remains constant or decreases with time.
  • Certain in vivo diagnostic assays may be performed directly on a tumor.
  • One such assay involves contacting tumor cells with a binding agent.
  • the bound binding agent may then be detected directly or indirectly via a reporter group.
  • binding agents may also be used in histological applications.
  • polynucleotide probes may be used within such applications.
  • multiple tumor protein markers may be assayed within a given sample. It will be apparent that binding agents specific for different proteins provided herein may be combined within a single assay. Further, multiple primers or probes may be used concurrently. The selection of tumor protein markers may be based on routine experiments to determine combinations that results in optimal sensitivity. In addition, or alternatively, assays for tumor proteins provided herein may be combined with assays for other known tumor antigens.
  • cell capture technologies may be used prior to detection to improve the sensitivity of the various detection methodologies disclosed herein.
  • Exemplary cell enrichment methodologies employ immunomagnetic beads that are coated with specific monoclonal antibodies to surface cell markers, or tetrameric antibody complexes, may be used to first enrich or positively select cancer cells in a sample.
  • Various commercially available kits may be used, including Dynabeads® Epithelial Enrich (Dynal Biotech, Oslo, Norway), StemSep TM (StemCell Technologies, Inc., Vancouver, BC), and RosetteSep (StemCell Technologies). The skilled artisan will recognize that other readily available methodologies and kits may also be suitably employed to enrich or positively select desired cell populations.
  • Dynabeads® Epithelial Enrich contains magnetic beads coated with mAbs specific for two glycoprotein membrane antigens expressed on normal and neoplastic epithelial tissues.
  • the coated beads may be added to a sample and the sample then applied to a magnet, thereby capturing the cells bound to the beads. The unwanted cells are washed away and the magnetically isolated cells eluted from the beads and used in further analyses.
  • RosetteSep can be used to enrich cells directly from a blood sample and consists of a cocktail of tetrameric antibodies that target a variety of unwanted cells and crosslinks them to glycophorin A on red blood cells (RBC) present in the sample, forming rosettes. When centrifuged over Ficoll, targeted cells pellet along with the free RBC.
  • RBC red blood cells
  • Antibodies that are available include, but are not limited to: CD2, CD3, CD4, CD5, CD8, CD10, CD11b, CD14, CD15, CD16, CD19, CD20, CD24, CD25, CD29, CD33, CD34, CD36, CD38, CD41, CD45, CD45RA, CD45RO, CD56, CD66B, CD66e, HLA-DR, IgE, and TCR ⁇ .
  • mAbs specific for prostate tumor antigens can be developed and used in a similar manner.
  • mAbs that bind to tumor-specific cell surface antigens may be conjugated to magnetic beads, or formulated in a tetrameric antibody complex, and used to enrich or positively select metastatic prostate tumor cells from a sample.
  • cells may be further analyzed.
  • the cells may be lysed and RNA isolated.
  • RNA may then be subjected to RT-PCR analysis using prostate tumor-specific primers in a Real-time PCR assay as described herein.
  • cell capture technologies may be used in conjunction with real-time PCR to provide a more sensitive tool for detection of metastatic cells expressing prostate tumor antigens. Detection of prostate cancer cells in bone marrow samples, peripheral blood, biopsies, and other samples is desirable for diagnosis and prognosis in prostate cancer patients.
  • kits for use within any of the above diagnostic methods.
  • Such kits typically comprise two or more components necessary for performing a diagnostic assay.
  • Components may be compounds, reagents, containers and/or equipment.
  • one container within a kit may contain a monoclonal antibody or fragment thereof that specifically binds to a tumor protein.
  • Such antibodies or fragments may be provided attached to a support material, as described above.
  • One or more additional containers may enclose elements, such as reagents or buffers, to be used in the assay.
  • Such kits may also, or alternatively, contain a detection reagent as described above that contains a reporter group suitable for direct or indirect detection of antibody binding.
  • kits may be designed to detect the level of mRNA encoding a tumor protein in a biological sample.
  • kits generally comprise at least one oligonucleotide probe or primer, as described above, that hybridizes to a polynucleotide encoding a tumor protein.
  • Such an oligonucleotide may be used, for example, within a PCR or hybridization assay. Additional components that may be present within such kits include a second oligonucleotide and/or a diagnostic reagent or container to facilitate the detection of a polynucleotide encoding a tumor protein.
  • This Example describes the isolation of certain prostate-specific polypeptides from a prostate tumor cDNA library.
  • a human prostate tumor cDNA expression library was constructed from prostate tumor poly A + RNA using a Superscript Plasmid System for cDNA Synthesis and Plasmid Cloning kit (BRL Life Technologies, Gaithersburg, MD 20897) following the manufacturer's protocol. Specifically, prostate tumor tissues were homogenized with polytron (Kinematica, Switzerland) and total RNA was extracted using Trizol reagent (BRL Life Technologies) as directed by the manufacturer. The poly A + RNA was then purified using a Qiagen oligotex spin column mRNA purification kit (Qiagen, Santa Clarita, CA 91355) according to the manufacturer's protocol. First-strand cDNA was synthesized using the Notl/Oligo-dT18 primer.
  • Double-stranded cDNA was synthesized, ligated with EcoRI/BAXI adaptors (Invitrogen, San Diego, CA) and digested with Notl. Following size fractionation with Chroma Spin-1000 columns (Clontech, Palo Alto, CA), the cDNA was ligated into the EcoRI/NotI site of pCDNA3.1 (Invitrogen) and transformed into ElectroMax E. coli DH10B cells (BRL Life Technologies) by electroporation.
  • a normal human pancreas cDNA expression library was prepared from a pool of six tissue specimens (Clontech).
  • the cDNA libraries were characterized by determining the number of independent colonies, the percentage of clones that carried insert, the average insert size and by sequence analysis.
  • the prostate tumor library contained 1.64 x 10 7 independent colonies, with 70% of clones having an insert and the average insert size being 1745 base pairs.
  • the normal pancreas cDNA library contained 3.3 x 10 6 independent colonies, with 69% of clones having inserts and the average insert size being 1120 base pairs.
  • sequence analysis showed that the majority of clones had a full length cDNA sequence and were synthesized from mRNA, with minimal rRNA and mitochondrial DNA contamination.
  • cDNA library subtraction was performed using the above prostate tumor and normal pancreas cDNA libraries, as described by Hara et al. (Blood, 84:189-199, 1994 ) with some modifications.
  • a prostate tumor-specific subtracted cDNA library was generated as follows. Normal pancreas cDNA library (70 ⁇ g) was digested with EcoRI, Notl, and Sful, followed by a filling-in reaction with DNA polymerase Klenow fragment. After phenolchloroform extraction and ethanol precipitation, the DNA was dissolved in 100 ⁇ l of H 2 O, heat-denatured and mixed with 100 ⁇ l (100 ⁇ g) of Photoprobe biotin (Vector Laboratories, Burlingame, CA).
  • the resulting mixture was irradiated with a 270 W sunlamp on ice for 20 minutes. Additional Photoprobe biotin (50 ⁇ l) was added and the biotinylation reaction was repeated. After extraction with butanol five times, the DNA was ethanol-precipitated and dissolved in 23 ⁇ l H 2 O to form the driver DNA.
  • ⁇ g prostate tumor cDNA library was digested with BamHI and Xhol, phenol chloroform extracted and passed through Chroma spin-400 columns (Clontech). Following ethanol precipitation, the tracer DNA was dissolved in 5 ⁇ l H 2 O. Tracer DNA was mixed with 15 ⁇ l driver DNA and 20 ⁇ l of 2 x hybridization buffer (1.5 M NaCl/10 mM EDTA/50 mM HEPES pH 7.5/0.2% sodium dodecyl sulfate), overlaid with mineral oil, and heat-denatured completely. The sample was immediately transferred into a 68 °C water bath and incubated for 20 hours (long hybridization [LH]).
  • 2 x hybridization buffer 1.5 M NaCl/10 mM EDTA/50 mM HEPES pH 7.5/0.2% sodium dodecyl sulfate
  • plasmid DNA was prepared from 100 independent clones, randomly picked from the subtracted prostate tumor specific library and grouped based on insert size. Representative cDNA clones were further characterized by DNA sequencing with a Perkin Elmer/Applied Biosystems Division Automated Sequencer Model 373A (Foster City, CA). Six cDNA clones, hereinafter referred to as F1-13, F1-12, F1-16, H1-1, H1-9 and H1-4, were shown to be abundant in the subtracted prostate-specific cDNA library.
  • the determined 3' and 5' cDNA sequences for F1-12 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 2 and 3, respectively, with determined 3' cDNA sequences for F1-13, F1-16, H1-1, H1-9 and H1-4 being provided in SEQ ID NO: 1 and 4-7, respectively.
  • the cDNA sequences for the isolated clones were compared to known sequences in the gene bank using the EMBL and GenBank databases (release 96).
  • PSA prostate specific antigen
  • H1-9 was found to be identical to a previously identified human autonomously replicating sequence. No significant homologies to the cDNA sequence for F1-12 were found.
  • cDNA library subtraction was performed by subtracting the prostate tumor cDNA library described above with the normal pancreas cDNA library and with the three most abundant genes in the previously subtracted prostate tumor specific cDNA library: human glandular kallikrein, prostate specific antigen (PSA), and mitochondria cytochrome C oxidase subunit II. Specifically, 1 ⁇ g each of human glandular kallikrein, PSA and mitochondria cytochrome C oxidase subunit II cDNAs in pCDNA3.1 were added to the driver DNA and subtraction was performed as described above to provide a second subtracted cDNA library hereinafter referred to as the "subtracted prostate tumor specific cDNA library with spike".
  • cDNA clones Twenty-two cDNA clones were isolated from the subtracted prostate tumor specific cDNA library with spike.
  • the determined 3' and 5' cDNA sequences for the clones referred to as J1-17, L1-12, N1-1862, J1-13, J1-19, J1-25, J1-24, K1-58, K1-63, L1-4 and L1-14 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 8-9, 10-11, 12-13, 14-15, 16-17, 18-19, 20-21, 22-23, 24-25, 26-27 and 28-29, respectively.
  • the determined 3' cDNA sequences for the clones referred to as J1-12, J1-16, J1-21, K1-48, K1-55, L1-2, L1-6, N1-1858, N1-1860, N1-1861, N1-1864 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 30-40, respectively. Comparison of these sequences with those in the gene bank as described above, revealed no significant homologies to three of the five most abundant DNA species, (J1-17, L1-12 and N1-1862; SEQ ID NO: 8-9, 10-11 and 12-13, respectively).
  • J1-12; SEQ ID NO:30 was found to be identical to the previously identified human pulmonary surfactant-associated protein, and the other (K1-48; SEQ ID NO:33) was determined to have some homology to R. norvegicus mRNA for 2-arylpropionyl-CoA epimerase.
  • N1-1862 (also referred to as P503S; SEQ ID NO: 111) was found to show prostate-specific expression. Immunohistochemistry and flow cytometry analysis indicated that P503S is a plasma membrane-associated molecule. P503S contains four transmembrane domains predicted to be encoded by amino acids 59-75, 90-106, 107-123 and 218-234. P503S contains a cleavable N-terminal signal sequence at amino acids 1-29. The N-terminus of P503S encoding amino acids 1-58 is internal, amino acids 76-89 are extracellular, amino acids 124-217 are extracellular and amino acids 235-241 are intracellular.
  • N-linked glycosylation sites are at amino acids N-141, N154, N-178 and N-184. Glycosylation of P503S has been confirmed experimentally using enzymes that selectively strip sugar residues from protein and Western blot analysis.
  • P503S is a member of a family of molecules collectively known as the tetraspanin family or TM4SF (transmembrane 4 superfamily). This family of proteins has been shown to interact, and homo and heterodimerize with, other family members.
  • TM4SF family members associate with a family of adhesion molecules known as integrins. TM4SF family members have been shown to regulate cell adhesion as well as cell proliferation by controlling signal transduction pathways associated with these physiological responses.
  • a second subtraction with spike (referred to as "prostate subtraction spike 2") was performed by subtracting a prostate tumor specific cDNA library with spike with normal pancreas cDNA library and further spiked with PSA, J1-17, pulmonary surfactant-associated protein, mitochondrial DNA, cytochrome c oxidase subunit II, N1-1862, autonomously replicating sequence, L1-12 and tumor expression enhanced gene.
  • Four additional clones hereinafter referred to as V1-3686, R1-2330, 1 B-3976 and V1-3679, were isolated. The determined cDNA sequences for these clones are provided in SEQ ID NO:73-76, respectively. Comparison of these sequences with those in the gene bank revealed no significant homologies to V1-3686 and R1-2330.
  • prostate subtraction 3 An additional subtraction was performed by subtracting a normal prostate cDNA library with normal pancreas cDNA (referred to as "prostate subtraction 3"). This led to the identification of six additional clones referred to as 1 G-4761, 1 G-4762, 1 H-4766, 1 H-4770, 1 H-4771 and 1 H-4772 (SEQ ID NO: 93-98). Comparison of these sequences with those in the gene bank revealed no significant homologies to 1G-4761 and 1H-4771 (SEQ ID NO: 93 and 97, respectively).
  • P509S and P510S Two clones (referred to as P509S and P510S) were found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor and normal prostate and expressed at low levels in all other normal tissues tested (liver, pancreas, skin, bone marrow, brain, breast, adrenal gland, bladder, testes, salivary gland, large intestine, kidney, ovary, lung, spinal cord, skeletal muscle and colon).
  • the determined cDNA sequences for P509S and P510S are provided in SEQ ID NO: 223 and 224, respectively. Comparison of these sequences with those in the gene bank as described above, revealed some homology to previously identified ESTs.
  • P510S was found to be expressed in a prostate-specific manner. Immunohistochemistry and flow cytometry analysis indicated that P510S is a plasma membrane-associated molecule. Based on sequence similarity to other multidrug resistance-associated transporter proteins, P510S is predicted to be a cell surface expressed drug transport protein that contains an ATP binding cassette. P510S contains nine transmembrane domains predicted to be encoded by amino acids 135-151, 233-249, 330-346, 351-367, 711-727, 775-791, 850-866, 867-883 and 954-970. The C-terminus of P510S is predicted to be intracellular. Potential N-linked glycosylation sites are at amino acids N-651, N-690, N-746 and N754, N792, N-1176 and N-1312.
  • the determined cDNA sequences for additional prostate-specific clones isolated during characterization of prostate specific cDNA libraries are provided in SEQ ID NO: 618-689, 691-697 and 709-772. Comparison of these sequences with those in the public databases revealed no significant homologies to any of these sequences.
  • mRNA expression levels for the representative prostate-specific polypeptides F1-16, H1-1, J1-17 (also referred to as P502S), L1-12 (also referred to as P501S), F1-12 (also referred to as P504S) and N1-1862 (also referred to as P503S) were examined in a variety of normal and tumor tissues using RT-PCR.
  • ⁇ -actin was used as an internal control for each of the tissues examined.
  • serial dilutions of the first strand cDNAs were prepared and RT-PCR assays were performed using ⁇ -actin specific primers.
  • a dilution was then chosen that enabled the linear range amplification of the ⁇ -actin template and which was sensitive enough to reflect the differences in the initial copy numbers.
  • the ⁇ -actin levels were determined for each reverse transcription reaction from each tissue. DNA contamination was minimized by DNase treatment and by assuring a negative PCR result when using first strand cDNA that was prepared without adding reverse transcriptase.
  • mRNA Expression levels were examined in four different types of tumor tissue (prostate tumor from 2 patients, breast tumor from 3 patients, colon tumor, lung tumor), and sixteen different normal tissues, including prostate, colon, kidney, liver, lung, ovary, pancreas, skeletal muscle, skin, stomach, testes, bone marrow and brain.
  • F1-16 was found to be expressed at high levels in prostate tumor tissue, colon tumor and normal prostate, and at lower levels in normal liver, skin and testes, with expression being undetectable in the other tissues examined.
  • H1-1 was found to be expressed at high levels in prostate tumor, lung tumor, breast tumor, normal prostate, normal colon and normal brain, at much lower levels in normal lung, pancreas, skeletal muscle, skin, small intestine, bone marrow, and was not detected in the other tissues tested.
  • J1-17 (P502S) and L1-12 (P501S) appear to be specifically over-expressed in prostate, with both genes being expressed at high levels in prostate tumor and normal prostate but at low to undetectable levels in all the other tissues examined.
  • N1-1862 (P503S) was found to be over-expressed in 60% of prostate tumors and detectable in normal colon and kidney. The RT-PCR results thus indicate that F1-16, H1-1, J1-17 (P502S), N1-1862 (P503S) and L1-12 (P501 S) are either prostate specific or are expressed at significantly elevated levels in prostate.
  • F1-12 (P504S) is over-expressed in 60% of prostate tumors, detectable in normal kidney but not detectable in all other tissues tested.
  • R1-2330 was shown to be over-expressed in 40% of prostate tumors, detectable in normal kidney and liver, but not detectable in all other tissues tested.
  • U1-3064 was found to be over-expressed in 60% of prostate tumors, and also expressed in breast and colon tumors, but was not detectable in normal tissues.
  • RT-PCR characterization of R1-2330, U1-3064 and 1D-4279 showed that these three antigens are over-expressed in prostate and/or prostate tumors.
  • L1-12 (P501S) is over-expressed in prostate tumors and normal prostate, while being undetectable in other normal tissues tested.
  • J1-17 (P502S) was detected in two prostate tumors and not in the other tissues tested.
  • N1-1862 (P503S) was found to be over-expressed in three prostate tumors and to be expressed in normal prostate, colon and kidney, but not in other tissues tested.
  • F1-12 (P504S) was found to be highly expressed in two prostate tumors and to be undetectable in all other tissues tested.
  • L1-12 (P501S) was found to be over-expressed in normal prostate and prostate tumor, with some expression being detected in normal skeletal muscle.
  • J1-12 and F1-12 (P504S) were found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor, with expression being lower or undetectable in all other tissues tested.
  • N1-1862 (P503S) was found to be expressed at high levels in prostate tumor and normal prostate, and at low levels in normal large intestine and normal colon, with expression being undetectable in all other tissues tested.
  • R1-2330 was found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor and normal prostate, and to be expressed at lower levels in all other tissues tested.
  • 1 D-4279 was found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor and normal prostate, expressed at lower levels in normal spinal cord, and to be undetectable in all other tissues tested.
  • P1000C and P1001C Two of these clones (referred to as P1000C and P1001C) were found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor and normal prostate, and expressed at low to undetectable levels in all other tissues tested (normal aorta, thymus, resting and activated PBMC, epithelial cells, spinal cord, adrenal gland, fetal tissues, skin, salivary gland, large intestine, bone marrow, liver, lung, dendritic cells, stomach, lymph nodes, brain, heart, small intestine, skeletal muscle, colon and kidney.
  • the determined cDNA sequences for P1000C and P1001C are provided in SEQ ID NO: 384 and 472, respectively.
  • the sequence of P1001C was found to show some homology to the previously isolated Human mRNA for JM27 protein. Subsequent comparison of the sequence of SEQ ID NO: 384 with sequences in the public databases, led to the identification of a full-length cDNA sequence of P1000C (SEQ ID NO: 929), which encodes a 492 amino acid sequence. Analysis of the amino acid sequence using the PSORT II program led to the identification of a putative transmembrane domain from amino acids 84-100.
  • the cDNA sequence of the open reading frame of P1000C, including the stop codon, is provided in SEQ ID NO: 930, with the open reading frame without the stop codon being provided in SEQ ID NO: 931.
  • the full-length amino acid sequence of P1000C is provided in SEQ ID NO: 932.
  • SEQ ID NO: 933 and 934 represent amino acids 1-100 and 100-492 of P1000C, respectively.
  • the expression of the polypeptide encoded by the full length cDNA sequence for F1-12 was investigated by immunohistochemical analysis.
  • the rabbit-anti-P504S polyclonal antibody did not appear to label benign prostate cells with the same cytoplasmic granular staining, but rather with light nuclear staining. Analysis of normal tissues revealed that the encoded polypeptide was found to be expressed in some, but not all normal human tissues. Positive cytoplasmic staining with rabbit-anti-P504S polyclonal antibody was found in normal human kidney, liver, brain, colon and lung-associated macrophages, whereas heart and bone marrow were negative.
  • a cDNA subtraction library containing cDNA from normal prostate subtracted with ten other normal tissue cDNAs (brain, heart, kidney, liver, lung, ovary, placenta, skeletal muscle, spleen and thymus) and then submitted to a first round of PCR amplification, was purchased from Clontech. This library was subjected to a second round of PCR amplification, following the manufacturer's protocol. The resulting cDNA fragments were subcloned into the vector pT7 Blue T-vector (Novagen, Madison, WI) and transformed into XL-1 Blue MRF' E . coli (Stratagene). DNA was isolated from independent clones and sequenced using a Perkin Elmer/Applied Biosystems Division Automated Sequencer Model 373A.
  • Fifty-nine positive clones were sequenced. Comparison of the DNA sequences of these clones with those in the gene bank, as described above, revealed no significant homologies to 25 of these clones, hereinafter referred to as P5, P8, P9, P18, P20, P30, P34, P36, P38, P39, P42, P49, P50, P53, P55, P60, P64, P65, P73, P75, P76, P79 and P84.
  • the determined cDNA sequences for these clones are provided in SEQ ID NO: 41-45, 47-52 and 54-65, respectively.
  • P29, P47, P68, P80 and P82 (SEQ ID NO: 46, 53 and 66-68, respectively) were found to show some degree of homology to previously identified DNA sequences. To the best of the inventors' knowledge, none of these sequences have been previously shown to be present in prostate.
  • cDNA clones containing the P20 sequence represent splice variants of a gene referred to as P703P.
  • the determined DNA sequence for the variants referred to as DE1, DE13 and DE14 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 171, 175 and 177, respectively, with the corresponding amino acid sequences being provided in SEQ ID NO: 172, 176 and 178, respectively.
  • the determined cDNA sequence for an extended spliced form of P703 is provided in SEQ ID NO: 225.
  • the DNA sequences for the splice variants referred to as DE2 and DE6 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 173 and 174, respectively.
  • P9 was found to be highly expressed in normal prostate and prostate tumor compared to all normal tissues tested except for normal colon which showed comparable expression.
  • P30 similar expression levels were seen in normal prostate and prostate tumor, compared to six of twelve other normal tissues tested. Increased expression was seen in breast tumors, one lung tumor sample and one colon tumor sample, and also in normal PBMC. P29 was found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor (5 of 5) and normal prostate (5 of 5) compared to the majority of normal tissues. However, substantial expression of P29 was observed in normal colon and normal lung (2 of 2). P80 was found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor (5 of 5) and normal prostate (5 of 5) compared to all other normal tissues tested, with increased expression also being seen in colon tumor.
  • the determined DNA sequences for 10-d8, 10-h10, 11-c8, 8-d4, 8-d9, 8-h11, 9-f12 and 9-f3 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 207, 208, 209, 216, 217, 220, 221 and 222, respectively.
  • the determined forward and reverse DNA sequences for 7-g6, 8-b5, 8-b6 and 8-g3 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 210 and 211; 212 and 213; 214 and 215; and 218 and 219, respectively. Comparison of these sequences with those in the gene bank revealed no significant homologies to the sequence of 9-f3.
  • the clones 10-d8, 11-c8 and 8-h11 were found to show some homology to previously isolated ESTs, while 10-h10, 8-b5, 8-b6, 8-d4, 8-d9, 8-g3 and 9-f12 were found to show some homology to previously identified genes. Further characterization of 7-G6 and 8-G3 showed identity to the known genes PAP and PSA, respectively.
  • mRNA expression levels for these clones were determined using the micro-array technology described above.
  • the clones 7-G6, 8-G3, 8-B5, 8-B6, 8-D4, 8-D9, 9-F3, 9-F12, 9-H3, 10-A2, 10-A4, 11-C9 and 11-F2 were found to be over-expressed in prostate tumor and normal prostate, with expression in other tissues tested being low or undetectable.
  • Increased expression of 8-F11 was seen in prostate tumor and normal prostate, bladder, skeletal muscle and colon.
  • Increased expression of 10-H10 was seen in prostate tumor and normal prostate, bladder, lung, colon, brain and large intestine.
  • Increased expression of 9-B1 was seen in prostate tumor, breast tumor, and normal prostate, salivary gland, large intestine and skin, with increased expression of 11-C8 being seen in prostate tumor, and normal prostate and large intestine.
  • P703PDE5 was recovered by screening of a cDNA library (#141-26) with a portion of P703P as a probe.
  • P703P6.26 was recovered from a mixture of three prostate tumor cDNAs and P703PX_23 was recovered from cDNA library (#438-48). Together, the additional sequences include all of the putative mature serine protease along with part of the putative signal sequence.
  • the full-length cDNA sequence for P703P is provided in SEQ ID NO: 524, with the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 525.
  • amino acids 164-172 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 866); amino acids 160-168 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 867); amino acids 239-247 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 868); amino acids 118-126 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 869); amino acids 112-120 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 870); amino acids 155-164 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 871); amino acids 117-126 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 872); amino acids 164-173 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 873); amino acids 154-163 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 874); amino acids 163-172 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 866); amino acids 160-168 of SEQ ID NO: 525 (SEQ ID NO: 867); amino acids 239
  • P703P was found to show some homology to previously identified proteases, such as thrombin.
  • the thrombin receptor has been shown to be preferentially expressed in highly metastatic breast carcinoma cells and breast carcinoma biopsy samples.
  • Introduction of thrombin receptor antisense cDNA has been shown to inhibit the invasion of metastatic breast carcinoma cells in culture.
  • Antibodies against thrombin receptor inhibit thrombin receptor activation and thrombin-induced platelet activation.
  • peptides that resemble the receptor's tethered ligand domain inhibit platelet aggregation by thrombin.
  • P703P may play a role in prostate cancer through a protease-activated receptor on the cancer cell or on stromal cells.
  • the potential trypsin-like protease activity of P703P may either activate a protease-activated receptor on the cancer cell membrane to promote tumorgenesis or activate a protease-activated receptor on the adjacent cells (such as stromal cells) to secrete growth factors and/or proteases (such as matrix metalloproteinases) that could promote tumor angiogenesis, invasion and metastasis. P703P may thus promote tumor progression and/or metastasis through the activation of protease-activated receptor. Polypeptides and antibodies that block the P703P-receptor interaction may therefore be usefully employed in the treatment of prostate cancer.
  • JP PCR subtraction
  • Clones P774P, P775P and P710P showed comparatively lower expression and expression in fewer prostate tumors and BPH samples, with negative to low expression in normal prostate.
  • SEQ ID NO: 552 The amino acid sequences encoded by 16 predicted open reading frames present within the sequence of SEQ ID NO: 552 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 553-568.
  • the full-length cDNA for P711 P was obtained by employing the partial sequence of SEQ ID NO: 307 to screen a prostate cDNA library. Specifically, a directionally cloned prostate cDNA library was prepared using standard techniques. One million colonies of this library were plated onto LB/Amp plates. Nylon membrane filters were used to lift these colonies, and the cDNAs which were picked up by these filters were denatured and cross-linked to the filters by UV light. The P711 P cDNA fragment of SEQ ID NO: 307 was radio-labeled and used to hybridize with these filters. Positive clones were selected, and cDNAs were prepared and sequenced using an automatic Perkin Elmer/Applied Biosystems sequencer. The determined full-length sequence of P711 P is provided in SEQ ID NO: 382, with the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 383.
  • P707P and P714P were derived for two clones described above, 11-C9 and 9-F3, herein after referred to as P707P and P714P, respectively (SEQ ID NO: 333 and 334).
  • P707P was found to be a splice variant of the known gene HoxB13.
  • no significant homologies to P714P were found.
  • Clones 8-B3, P89, P98, P130 and P201 were found to be contained within one contiguous sequence, referred to as P705P (cDNA sequence provided in SEQ ID NO: 335, with the amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 336), which was determined to be a splice variant of the known gene NKX 3.1. Subsequent studies led to the isolation of a corrected cDNA sequence for P705P. The coding region of this sequence is provided in SEQ ID NO: 948.
  • SEQ ID NO: 473-476 The sequence of SEQ ID NO: 474 was found to contain two open reading frames (ORFs). The amino acid sequences encoded by these ORFs are provided in SEQ ID NO: 477 and 478.
  • the cDNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 475 was found to contain an ORF which encodes the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 479.
  • the cDNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 473 was found to contain four ORFs. The amino acid sequences encoded by these ORFs are provided in SEQ ID NO: 480-483. Additional splice variants of P775P are provided in SEQ ID NO: 593-597.
  • P558S is identical to the prostate-specific transglutaminase gene, which is known to have two forms.
  • the full-length sequences for the two forms are provided in SEQ ID NO: 773 and 774, with the corresponding amino acid sequences being provided in SEQ ID NO: 775 and 776, respectively.
  • the cDNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 774 has a 15 pair base insert, resulting in a 5 amino acid insert in the corresponding amino acid sequence (SEQ ID NO: 776). This insert is not present in the sequence of SEQ ID NO: 773.
  • amino acid positions 118-134, 172-188, 211-227, 230-246, 282-298 and 348-364 Six transmembrane domains were predicted at amino acid positions 118-134, 172-188, 211-227, 230-246, 282-298 and 348-364.
  • the amino acid sequences of SEQ ID NO: 910-915 represent amino acids 1-134, 135-188, 189-227, 228-246, 247-298 and 299-511 of P768P, respectively.
  • Polypeptides may be synthesized on a Perkin Elmer/Applied Biosystems 430A peptide synthesizer using FMOC chemistry with HPTU (O-Benzotriazole-N,N,N',N'-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate) activation.
  • HPTU O-Benzotriazole-N,N,N',N'-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate
  • a Gly-Cys-Gly sequence may be attached to the amino terminus of the peptide to provide a method of conjugation, binding to an immobilized surface, or labeling of the peptide.
  • Cleavage of the peptides from the solid support may be carried out using the following cleavage mixture: trifluoroacetic acid:ethanedithiol:thioanisole:water:phenol (40:1:2:2:3).
  • the peptides may be precipitated in cold methyl-t-butyl-ether.
  • the peptide pellets may then be dissolved in water containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) and lyophilized prior to purification by C18 reverse phase HPLC.
  • TFA trifluoroacetic acid
  • a gradient of 0%-60% acetonitrile (containing 0.1% TFA) in water (containing 0.1% TFA) may be used to elute the peptides.
  • the peptides may be characterized using electrospray or other types of mass spectrometry and by amino acid analysis.
  • a cDNA library generated from prostate primary tumor mRNA as described above was subtracted with cDNA from normal prostate.
  • the subtraction was performed using a PCR-based protocol (Clontech), which was modified to generate larger fragments.
  • tester and driver double stranded cDNA were separately digested with five restriction enzymes that recognize six-nucleotide restriction sites (Mlul, Mscl, Pvull, Sall and Stul). This digestion resulted in an average cDNA size of 600 bp, rather than the average size of 300 bp that results from digestion with Rsal according to the Clontech protocol. This modification did not affect the subtraction efficiency.
  • Two tester populations were then created with different adapters, and the driver library remained without adapters.
  • the tester and driver libraries were then hybridized using excess driver cDNA.
  • driver was separately hybridized with each of the two tester cDNA populations. This resulted in populations of (a) unhybridized tester cDNAs, (b) tester cDNAs hybridized to other tester cDNAs, (c) tester cDNAs hybridized to driver cDNAs and (d) unhybridized driver cDNAs.
  • the two separate hybridization reactions were then combined, and rehybridized in the presence of additional denatured driver cDNA.
  • a fifth population (e) was generated in which tester cDNA with one adapter hybridized to tester cDNA with the second adapter. Accordingly, the second hybridization step resulted in enrichment of differentially expressed sequences which could be used as templates for PCR amplification with adaptor-specific primers.
  • This PCR-based subtraction technique normalizes differentially expressed cDNAs so that rare transcripts that are overexpressed in prostate tumor tissue may be recoverable. Such transcripts would be difficult to recover by traditional subtraction methods.
  • JPTPN23 (SEQ ID NO: 231; similarity to pig valosin-containing protein), JPTPN30 (SEQ ID NO: 234; similarity to rat mRNA for proteasome subunit), JPTPN45 (SEQ ID NO: 243; similarity to rat norvegicus cytosolic NADP-dependent isocitrate dehydrogenase), JPTPN46 (SEQ ID NO: 244; similarity to human subclone H8 4 d4 DNA sequence), JP1 D6 (SEQ ID NO: 265; similarity to G.
  • JP8D6 SEQ ID NO: 288; similarity to human BAC clone RG016J04
  • JP8F5 SEQ ID NO: 289; similarity to human subclone H8 3 b5 DNA sequence
  • JP8E9 SEQ ID NO: 299; similarity to human Alu sequence
  • PT-PN PCR subtraction consisting of a prostate tumor pool subtracted against a normal prostate pool. Comparison of the cDNA sequences of these clones with the most recent release of GenBank revealed no significant homologies to the two clones referred to as P715P and P767P (SEQ ID NO: 312 and 314). The remaining clone was found to show some homology to the known gene KIAA0056 (SEQ ID NO: 318). Using microarray analysis to measure mRNA expression levels in various tissues, all three clones were found to be over-expressed in prostate tumors and BPH tissues.
  • clone P715P was over-expressed in most prostate tumors and BPH tissues by a factor of three or greater, with elevated expression seen in the majority of normal prostate samples and in fetal tissue, but negative to low expression in all other normal tissues.
  • Clone P767P was over-expressed in several prostate tumors and BPH tissues, with moderate expression levels in half of the normal prostate samples, and background to low expression in all other normal tissues tested.
  • This determined cDNA sequence of this polymorphic variant of P788P is provided in SEQ ID NO: 779, with the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 780.
  • the sequence of SEQ ID NO: 780 differs from that of SEQ ID NO: 778 by six amino acid residues.
  • the P788P protein has 7 potential transmembrane domains at the C-terminal portion and is predicted to be a plasma membrane protein with an extracellular N-terminal region.
  • P790P Further studies on the clone of SEQ ID NO: 352 (referred to as P790P) led to the isolation of the full-length cDNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 526. The corresponding amino acid is provided in SEQ ID NO: 527. Data from two quantitative PCR experiments indicated that P790P is over-expressed in 11/15 tested prostate tumor samples and is expressed at low levels in spinal cord, with no expression being seen in all other normal samples tested. Data from further PCR experiments and microarray experiments showed over-expression in normal prostate and prostate tumor with little or no expression in other tissues tested. P790P was subsequently found to show significant homology to a previously identified G-protein coupled prostate tissue receptor.
  • SEQ ID NO: 569 Additional studies on the clone of SEQ ID NO: 354 led to the isolation of an extended cDNA sequence, provided in SEQ ID NO: 569.
  • ORFs predicted open reading frames
  • clone F1 the clone of SEQ ID NO: 882
  • clone F2 the clone of SEQ ID NO: 881
  • clone F2 the clone of SEQ ID NO: 881
  • clone F2 the clone of SEQ ID NO: 881
  • the predicted amino acid sequences encoded by 5 open reading frames located within SEQ ID NO: 880 are provided in SEQ ID NO: 883-887, with the predicted amino acid sequences encoded by the clone of SEQ ID NO: 881 and 882 being provided in SEQ ID NO: 888-893.
  • P789P The clone of SEQ ID NO: 342 (referred to as P789P) was found to show homology to a previously identified gene.
  • the full length cDNA sequence for P789P and the corresponding amino acid sequence are provided in SEQ ID NO: 878 and 879, respectively.
  • P780P Comparison of the sequence of SEQ ID NO: 355 (referred to as P780P) with sequences in the Geneseq DNA database, revealed that P780P shares 100% sequence identity with GeneSEQ accessions Z29049 and Z29050 (SEQ ID NO: 944 and 945, respectively).
  • Z29049 and Z29050 differ from each other in that Z29049 contains a 714 bp deletion relative to Z29050.
  • Z29049 and Z29050 appear to represent 2 alternative splice forms of the gene P780P.
  • Z29049 encodes a protein that is 379 amino acids in length (GeneSeq Accession number Y15155; SEQ ID NO: 946).
  • Z29050 encodes a protein that is 617 amino acids in length (GeneSeq Accession number Y15156; SEQ ID NO: 947). These two proteins are identical with the exception that Y15155 contains a 238 amino acid deletion relative to Y15156. This amino acid deletion corresponds to the 714 bp deletion in Z29049.
  • This Example illustrates the preparation of a cytotoxic T lymphocyte (CTL) cell line specific for cells expressing the P502S gene.
  • CTL cytotoxic T lymphocyte
  • mice expressing the transgene for human HLA A2Kb were immunized with P2S#12 peptide (VLGWVAEL; SEQ ID NO: 306), which is derived from the P502S gene (also referred to herein as J1-17, SEQ ID NO: 8), as described by Theobald et al., Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 92:11993-11997, 1995 with the following modifications.
  • mice were immunized with 100 ⁇ g of P2S#12 and 120 ⁇ g of an I-A b binding peptide derived from hepatitis B Virus protein emulsified in incomplete Freund's adjuvant. Three weeks later these mice were sacrificed and single cell suspensions prepared.
  • cells (5 x 10 5 /ml) were restimulated with 2.5 x 10 6 /ml peptide pulsed irradiated (20,000 rads) EL4A2Kb cells ( Sherman et al, Science 258:815-818, 1992 ) and 3 x 10 6 /ml A2 transgenic spleen feeder cells.
  • Cells were cultured in the presence of 20U/ml IL-2. Cells continued to be restimulated on a weekly basis as described, in preparation for cloning the line.
  • P2S#12 line was cloned by limiting dilution analysis with peptide pulsed EL4 A2Kb tumor cells (1 x 10 4 cells/ well) as stimulators and A2 transgenic spleen cells as feeders (5 x 10 5 cells/ well) grown in the presence of 30U/ml IL-2. On day 14, cells were restimulated as before. On day 21, clones that were growing were isolated and maintained in culture. Several of these clones demonstrated significantly higher reactivity (lysis) against human fibroblasts (HLA A2Kb expressing) transduced with P502S than against control fibroblasts. An example is presented in Figure 1 .
  • P2S #12 represents a naturally processed epitope of the P502S protein that is expressed in the context of the human HLA A2Kb molecule.
  • This Example illustrates the preparation of murine CTL lines and CTL clones specific for cells expressing the P501S gene.
  • mice were immunized with the P1S#10 peptide (SEQ ID NO: 337), which is derived from the P501S gene (also referred to herein as L1-12, SEQ ID NO: 110).
  • the P1S#10 peptide was derived by analysis of the predicted polypeptide sequence for P501S for potential HLA-A2 binding sequences as defined by published HLA-A2 binding motifs ( Parker, KC, et al, J. Immunol., 152:163, 1994 ).
  • P1S#10 peptide was synthesized as described in Example 4, and empirically tested for HLA-A2 binding using a T cell based competition assay.
  • Predicted A2 binding peptides were tested for their ability to compete HLA-A2 specific peptide presentation to an HLA-A2 restricted CTL clone (D150M58), which is specific for the HLA-A2 binding influenza matrix peptide fluM58.
  • D150M58 CTL secretes TNF in response to self-presentation of peptide fluM58.
  • test peptides at 100-200 ⁇ g/ml were added to cultures of D150M58 CTL in order to bind HLA-A2 on the CTL. After thirty minutes, CTL cultured with test peptides, or control peptides, were tested for their antigen dose response to the fluM58 peptide in a standard TNF bioassay.
  • peptide P1S#10 competes with HLA-A2 restricted presentation of fluM58, demonstrating that peptide P1S#10 binds HLA-A2.
  • mice expressing the transgene for human HLA A2Kb were immunized as described by Theobald et al. (Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 92:11993-11997, 1995 ) with the following modifications. Mice were immunized with 62.5 ⁇ g of P1S #10 and 120 ⁇ g of an I-A b binding peptide derived from Hepatitis B Virus protein emulsified in incomplete Freund's adjuvant. Three weeks later these mice were sacrificed and single cell suspensions prepared using a nylon mesh.
  • a P1S#10-specific CTL line was cloned by limiting dilution analysis with peptide pulsed EL4 A2Kb tumor cells (1 x 10 4 cells/ well) as stimulators and A2 transgenic spleen cells as feeders (5 x 10 5 cells/ well) grown in the presence of 30U/ml IL-2. On day 14, cells were restimulated as before. On day 21, viable clones were isolated and maintained in culture. As shown in Figure 5 , five of these clones demonstrated specific cytolytic reactivity against P501 S-transduced Jurkat A2Kb targets. This data indicates that P1S#10 represents a naturally processed epitope of the P501 S protein that is expressed in the context of the human HLA-A2.1 molecule.
  • the prostate-specific antigen L1-12 is also referred to as P501 S.
  • HLA A2Kb Tg mice (provided by Dr L. Sherman, The Scripps Research Institute, La Jolla, CA) were immunized with 100 ⁇ g P501 S in the vector VR1012 either intramuscularly or intradermally. The mice were immunized three times, with a two week interval between immunizations. Two weeks after the last immunization, immune spleen cells were cultured with Jurkat A2Kb-P501S transduced stimulator cells. CTL lines were stimulated weekly. After two weeks of in vitro stimulation, CTL activity was assessed against P501 S transduced targets. Two out of 8 mice developed strong anti-P501 S CTL responses. These results demonstrate that P501 S contains at least one naturally processed HLA-A2-restricted CTL epitope.
  • mice were immunized with either P501 S in the vector VR1012 as described above or with a P501 S-adenovirus construct at 1 x 10 8 pfu/animal.
  • animals received a boost immunization, with animals that were primed with P501 S alone being boosted with either P501 S alone or P501 S-adenovirus.
  • Spleen cells were harvested at 3 and 6 weeks post-immunization and cultured with irradiated Jurkat A2Kb cells (day 0). CTL activity was assayed on day 6, spleen cells restimulated on day 7, and a secondary CTL assay was performed on day 13.
  • IgG1 and IgG2a responses against the N-terminal region of P501 S were assayed using ELISA.
  • the P501S-adenovirus construct effectively elicited both T cell and antibody responses, with P501 S alone eliciting CTL responses but not antibody responses.
  • Immunization with P501 S alone was found to be most effective in combination with a P501 S-adenovirus boost. Immunizations with P501 S alone generated T cells that respond to peptide 370 (CLSHSVAW).
  • This Example illustrates the ability of T cells specific for a prostate tumor polypeptide to recognize human tumor.
  • Human CD8 + T cells were primed in vitro to the P2S-12 peptide (SEQ ID NO: 306) derived from P502S (also referred to as J1-17) using dendritic cells according to the protocol of Van Tsai et al. (Critical Reviews in Immunology 18:65-75, 1998 ).
  • the resulting CD8 + T cell microcultures were tested for their ability to recognize the P2S-12 peptide presented by autologous fibroblasts or fibroblasts which were transduced to express the P502S gene in a ⁇ -interferon ELISPOT assay (see Lalvani et al., J. Exp. Med. 186:859-865, 1997 ).
  • T cells were assayed in duplicate on 10 4 fibroblasts in the presence of 3 ⁇ g/ml human ⁇ 2 -microglobulin and 1 ⁇ g/ml P2S-12 peptide or control E75 peptide.
  • T cells were simultaneously assayed on autologous fibroblasts transduced with the P502S gene or as a control, fibroblasts transduced with HER-2/ neu .
  • the fibroblasts were treated with 10 ng/ml ⁇ -interferon for 48 hours to upregulate class I MHC expression.
  • FIG. 2A demonstrates that there was a strong increase in the number of ⁇ -interferon spots with increasing numbers of T cells on fibroblasts pulsed with the P2S-12 peptide (solid bars) but not with the control E75 peptide (open bars). This shows the ability of these T cells to specifically recognize the P2S-12 peptide.
  • FIG. 2B this microculture also demonstrated an increase in the number of ⁇ -interferon spots with increasing numbers of T cells on fibroblasts transduced to express the P502S gene but not the HER-2/neu gene.
  • This Example illustrates the ability of the prostate-specific antigen P501 S to elicit a cytotoxic T lymphocyte (CTL) response in blood of normal humans and defines important epitopes responsible for T-cell recognition.
  • CTL cytotoxic T lymphocyte
  • DC dendritic cells
  • monocyte cultures derived from PBMC of normal donors by growth for five days in RPMI medium containing 10% human serum, 50 ng/ml GMCSF and 30 ng/ml IL-4.
  • DC were infected overnight with recombinant P501 S-expressing vaccinia virus at an M.O.I. of 5 and matured for 8 hours by the addition of 2 micrograms/ml CD40 ligand.
  • Virus was inactivated by UV irradiation, CD8 + cells were isolated by positive selection using magnetic beads, and priming cultures were initiated in 24-well plates.
  • CD8+ lines were identified that specifically produced interferon-gamma when stimulated with autologous P501 S-transduced fibroblasts.
  • the P501 S-specific activity of cell line 3A-1 could be maintained following additional stimulation cycles on autologous B-LCL transduced with P501S.
  • Line 3A-1 was shown to specifically recognize autologous B-LCL transduced to express P501 S, but not EGFP-transduced autologous B-LCL, as measured by cytotoxicity assays ( 51 Cr release) and interferon-gamma production (Interferon-gamma Elispot; see above and Lalvani et al., J. Exp. Med. 186:859-865, 1997 ).
  • the results of these assays are presented in Figures 6A and 6B .
  • DC Dendritic Cells
  • RPMI medium containing 1% human serum, 50 ng/ml GM-CSF and 30 ng/ml IL-4.
  • DC were infected for 24 hours with P501S-expressing Adenovirus at an MOI of 10 and matured for an additional 24 hours by the addition of 2 ug/ml CD40 ligand.
  • CD8 cells were enriched from PBMC of a normal male donor by the subtraction of CD4+, CD14+ and CD16+ populations from PBMC with magnetic beads.
  • P501 S-specific CD8+ T cell lines were identified that produced IFN-gamma in response to IFN-gamma treated P501 S/CD80-expressing autologous fibroblasts, but not in response to IFN-gamma treated P703P/CD80-expressing autologous fibroblasts in a ⁇ -IFN Elispot assay.
  • the three most promising lines referred to as 1 H1, 2H2 and 6F1, were cloned in 96-well plates with 0.5 cell/well or 2 cells/well in the presence of 75,000 PBMC/well, 10,000 B-LCL/well, 30ng/ml OKT3 and 50 u/ml IL-2 to isolate P501 S-specific clones.
  • HLA blocking and mismatch analyses were performed as follows.
  • ⁇ -IFN Elispot assays the specific response of clones to P501 S transduced autologous fibroblasts was blocked by pre-incubation with 25 ug/ml W6/32 (pan-Class I blocking antibody) and for 6F1 with BB7.2 (HLA-A2 blocking antibody), and for 1H1 and 2H2 with B1.23.2 (HLA-B/C blocking antibody).
  • W6/32 pan-Class I blocking antibody
  • BB7.2 HLA-A2 blocking antibody
  • 1H1 and 2H2 with B1.23.2
  • autologous fibroblasts D310, HLA-A2,A3,B44,B51,Cw5,Cw14
  • heterologous fibroblasts D326, HLA-A1, A2,B8,B51,Cw1,Cw7 that share the HLA-A-2 and HLAB51 allele were transduced with P501 S and used to stimulate the clones.
  • ⁇ -IFN Elispot assays 1H1 and 2H2 only recognized the autologous fibroblasts, suggesting (together with the antibody blocking assays above) that the relevant allele was B44, Cw5, or Cw14, and 6F1 recognized both D310 and D326, suggesting the response was restricted to HLA-A0201.
  • each of the alleles from D310 was cloned into the pBIB expression vector and cotransfected into Cos-7 cells together with full-length P501 S.
  • 1H1 and 2H2 clones specifically recognized Cos-7 cells cotransfected with P501S and the Cw0501 alelle, while 6F1 clones recognized Cos-7 cells cotransfected with P501S and the HLA-A0201 allele.
  • a 6F1 clone was found to recognize an epitope derived from the initial 354 nucleotides of the P501S open reading frame (ORF), a 2H2 clone (referred to as 2H2-1A12) recognized an epitope derived from the sequence of P501 S found between amino acids 471-553 of P501 S (SEQ ID NO: 113), and a 1H1 clone (referred to as 1 H1-1A6) recognized an epitope derived from the sequence of P501S found between amino acids 278-353 of P501 S (SEQ ID NO: 113).
  • the 8-mer was also recognized efficiently by the CTL, demonstrating that a minimal naturally processed peptide epitope recognized by the CTL spans SEQ ID NO: 981. Further analysis revealed that the minimal epitope for the clone 1H1-1A6 was YTDFVGEGL (amino acids 292-300 of P501), the amino acid and DNA sequences for which are disclosed in SEQ ID NOs:1021 and 1022, respectively. Peptide titration assays revealed that CD8+ T cells specific for this epitope recognized APC pulsed with 0.0016 ⁇ g/ml of the 9-mer. Therefore a minimal CD8+ T cell epitope specific for P501 is YTDFVGEGL (SEQ ID NO:1022).
  • peptide 464 (amino acids 464-474; SEQ ID NO: 978; cDNA sequence provided in SEQ ID NO: 970) and also peptides 463 (amino acids 463-472) and 465 (amino acids 465-475) were specifically recognized by the CTL.
  • sequence of SEQ ID NO: 978 (amino acids 464-474 of P501S) contains the minimal epitope recognized by 2H2-1A12 CTL.
  • the minimal epitope for the clone 2H2-1A12 was ACDVSVRVV (amino acids 465-473 of P501 S) the amino acid and DNA sequences of which are disclosed in SEQ ID NOs:1012 and 1013, respectively.
  • the recognition of peptides 463 and 465 either reflects contamination of these peptides with peptide 464, or additional secondary and inefficient recognition of these peptides by the CTL.
  • P501 S is capable of eliciting a human CTL response and identifies multiple CTL epitopes responsible for T-cell recognition of this prostate-specific antigen. Such information further validates P501 S as an important target for use in immunodiagnostic and immunotherapeutic applications.
  • the 9-mer peptide p5 (SEQ ID NO: 338) was derived from the P703P antigen (also referred to as P20).
  • the p5 peptide is immunogenic in human HLA-A2 donors and is a naturally processed epitope.
  • Antigen specific human CD8+ T cells can be primed following repeated in vitro stimulations with monocytes pulsed with p5 peptide.
  • These CTL specifically recognize p5-pulsed and P703P-transduced target cells in both ELISPOT (as described above) and chromium release assays.
  • immunization of HLA-A2Kb transgenic mice with p5 leads to the generation of CTL lines which recognize a variety of HLA-A2Kb or HLA-A2 transduced target cells expressing P703P.
  • HLA-A2Kb transgenic mice were immunized subcutaneously in the footpad with 100 ⁇ g of p5 peptide together with 140 ⁇ g of hepatitis B virus core peptide (a Th peptide) in Freund's incomplete adjuvant.
  • spleen cells from immunized mice were stimulated in vitro with peptide-pulsed LPS blasts.
  • CTL activity was assessed by chromium release assay five days after primary in vitro stimulation.
  • Retrovirally transduced cells expressing the control antigen P703P and HLA-A2Kb were used as targets. CTL lines that specifically recognized both p5-pulsed targets as well as P703P-expressing targets were identified.
  • DC Dendritic cells
  • monocyte cultures derived from PBMC of normal human donors by culturing for five days in RPMI medium containing 10% human serum, 50 ng/ml human GM-CSF and 30 ng/ml human IL-4. Following culture, the DC were pulsed with 1 ug/ml p5 peptide and cultured with CD8+ T cell enriched PBMC.
  • CTL lines were restimulated on a weekly basis with p5-pulsed monocytes. Five to six weeks after initiation of the CTL cultures, CTL recognition of p5-pulsed target cells was demonstrated. CTL were additionally shown to recognize human cells transduced to express P703P, demonstrating that p5 is a naturally processed epitope.
  • peptide 4 a further peptide epitope derived from the prostate tumor-specific antigen P703P that is capable of being recognized by CD4 T cells on the surface of cells in the context of HLA class II molecules was carried out as follows.
  • the amino acid sequence for peptide 4 is provided in SEQ ID NO: 781, with the corresponding cDNA sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 782.
  • DC Dendritic cells
  • CD4 T cells were generated from the same donor as the DC using MACS beads and negative selection.
  • Pulsed DC were washed and plated at 1 x 10 4 cells/well of 96-well V-bottom plates and purified CD4 T cells were added at 1 x 10 5 /well.
  • Cultures were supplemented with 60 ng/ml IL-6 and 10 ng/ml IL-12 and incubated at 37°C. Cultures were restimulated as above on a weekly basis using DC generated and pulsed as above as antigen presenting cells, supplemented with 5 ng/ml IL-7 and 10 u/ml IL-2. Following 4 in vitro stimulation cycles, 96 lines (each line corresponding to one well) were tested for specific proliferation and cytokine production in response to the stimulating pools with an irrelevant pool of peptides derived from mammaglobin being used as a control.
  • Line 1F9 One line (referred to as 1-F9) was identified from pool #1 that demonstrated specific proliferation (measured by 3H proliferation assays) and cytokine production (measured by interferon-gamma ELISA assays) in response to pool #1 of P703P peptides. This line was further tested for specific recognition of the peptide pool, specific recognition of individual peptides in the pool, and in HLA mismatch analyses to identify the relevant restricting allele. Line 1-F9 was found to specifically proliferate and produce interferon-gamma in response to peptide pool #1, and also to peptide 4 (SEQ ID NO: 781). Peptide 4 corresponds to amino acids 126-140 of SEQ ID NO: 327.
  • APC antigen presenting cells
  • Antibody blocking assays were utilized to determine if the restricting allele was HLA-DR0701 or HLA-DQ02.
  • the anti-HLA-DR blocking antibody L243 or an irrelevant isotype matched IgG2a were added to T cells and APC cultures pulsed with the peptide RMPTVLQCVNVSVVS (SEQ ID NO: 781) at 250 ng/ml. Standard interferon-gamma and proliferation assays were performed. Whereas the control antibody had no effect on the ability of the T cells to recognize peptide-pulsed APC, in both assays the anti-HLA-DR antibody completely blocked the ability of the T cells to specifically recognize peptide-pulsed APC.
  • CD4 T cell lines which demonstrated specific activity were restimulated on the appropriate pool of P703P peptides and reassayed on the individual peptides of each pool as well as a peptide dose titration of the pool of peptides in a IFN-gamma release assay and in a proliferation assay.
  • immunogenic peptides were recognized by the T cells from the entire set of peptide antigens tested.
  • the amino acid sequences of these peptides are provided in SEQ ID NO: 799-814, with the corresponding cDNA sequences being provided in SEQ ID NO: 783-798, respectively.
  • the peptide reactivity of the T cell line could be mapped to a single peptide, however some could be mapped to more than one peptide in each pool.
  • CD4 T cell lines that displayed a representative pattern of recognition from each peptide pool with a reasonable affinity for peptide were chosen for further analysis (I-1A, -6A; II-4C, -5E; III-6E, IV-4B, -3F, -9B, -10F, V-5B, -4D, and -10F). These CD4 T cells lines were restimulated on the appropriate individual peptide and reassayed on autologous DC pulsed with a truncated form of recombinant P703P protein made in E. coli (a.a.
  • line I-1A recognized specifically the truncated form of P703P ( E . coli ) but no other recombinant form of P703P.
  • This line also recognized the peptide used to elicit the T cells.
  • Line 2-4C recognized the truncated form of P703P ( E. coli ) and the full length form of P703P made in baculovirus, as well as peptide.
  • T cell lines tested were either peptide-specific only (II-5E, II-6F, IV-4B, IV-3F, IV-9B, IV-10F, V-5B and V-4D) or were non-responsive to any antigen tested (V-10F).
  • RPLLANDLMLIKLDE SEQ ID NO: 814; corresponding to a.a. 110-124 of SEQ ID NO: 525) recognized by the T cell line I-1A
  • SVSESDTIRSISIAS SEQ ID NO: 811; corresponding to a.a. 125-139 of SEQ ID NO: 525) and ISIASQCPTAGNSCL (SEQ ID NO: 810; corresponding to a.a. 135-149 of SEQ ID NO: 525) recognized by the T cell line II-4C may be naturally processed epitopes of the P703P protein.
  • Lines 3A5H and 3A9H specifically proliferated and produced gamma-interferon in response to recombinant protein and one individual peptide as well as the peptide pool.
  • targets loaded with the specific peptide only 3A9H responded specifically to targets exposed to lysates of fibroblasts infected adenovirus expressing full-length P703P.
  • the peptide to which the specific CD4 line responded correspond to amino acids 155-170 of P703P (SEQ ID NO: 943).
  • the DNA sequence for this peptide is provided in SEQ ID NO: 942.
  • the determined DNA sequence of this ORF is provided in SEQ ID NO: 531.
  • This frameshift generates a protein sequence (provided in SEQ ID NO: 532) of 293 amino acids that contains the C-terminal domain common to the other isoforms of B305D but that differs in the N-terminal region.
  • B305D The expression levels of B305D in a variety of tumor and normal tissues were examined by real time PCR and by Northern analysis. The results indicated that B305D is highly expressed in breast tumor, prostate tumor, normal prostate and normal testes, with expression being low or undetectable in all other tissues examined (colon tumor, lung tumor, ovary tumor, and normal bone marrow, colon, kidney, liver, lung, ovary, skin, small intestine, stomach).
  • colon tumor, lung tumor, ovary tumor, and normal bone marrow, colon, kidney, liver, lung, ovary, skin, small intestine, stomach Using real-time PCR on a panel of prostate tumors, expression of B305D in prostate tumors was shown to increase with increasing Gleason grade, demonstrating that expression of B305D increases as prostate cancer progresses.
  • DC dendritic cells
  • monocyte cultures derived from PBMC of normal human donors by growing for five days in RPMI medium containing 10% human serum, 50 ng/ml human GM-CSF and 30 ng/ml human IL-4.
  • DC were infected overnight with recombinant P501 S vaccinia virus at a multiplicity of infection (M.O.I) of five, and matured overnight by the addition of 3 ⁇ g/ml CD40 ligand.
  • Virus was inactivated by UV irradiation.
  • CD8+ T cells were isolated using a magnetic bead system, and priming cultures were initiated using standard culture techniques.
  • cDNA encoding P501 S was fragmented by various restriction digests, and sub-cloned into the retroviral expression vector pBIB-KS. Retroviral supernatants were generated by transfection of the helper packaging line Phoenix-Ampho. Supernatants were then used to transduce Jurkat/A2Kb cells for CTL screening. CTL were screened in IFN-gamma ELISPOT assays against these A2Kb targets transduced with the "library" of P501S fragments.
  • Initial positive fragments P501 S/H3 and P501 S/F2 were sequenced and found to encode amino acids 106-553 and amino acids 136-547, respectively, of SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • a truncation of H3 was made to encode amino acid residues 106-351 of SEQ ID NO: 113, which was unable to stimulate the CTL, thus localizing the epitope to amino acid residues 351-547. Additional fragments encoding amino acids 1-472 (Fragment A) and amino acids 1-351 (Fragment B) were also constructed. Fragment A but not Fragment B stimulated the CTL thus localizing the epitope to amino acid residues 351-472. Overlapping 20-mer and 18-mer peptides representing this region were tested by pulsing Jurkat/A2Kb cells versus CTL in an IFN-gamma assay.
  • CTL microcultures were re-stimulated with P501 S-transduced B cells and then assayed for specificity. Following this initial screen, microcultures with significant signal above background were cloned on autologous EBV-transformed B cells (BLCL), also transduced with P501 S. Using IFN-gamma ELISPOT for detection, several of these CD8 T cell clones were found to be specific for P501 S, as demonstrated by reactivity to BLCL/P501S but not BLCL transduced with control antigen. It was further demonstrated that the anti-P501 S CD8 T cell specificity is HLA-A2-restricted.
  • CD8 class I-restricted peptide epitope of P501 S was identified as follows.
  • Dendritic cells DC were isolated by Percol gradient followed by differential adherence, and cultured for 5 days in the presence of RPMI medium containing 1% human serum, 50ng/ml GM-CSF and 30ng/ml IL-4. Following culture, DC were infected for 24 hours with P501 S-expressing adenovirus at an MOl of 10 and matured for an additional 24 hours by the addition of 2ug/ml CD40 ligand.
  • CD8 cells were enriched for by the subtraction of CD4+, CD14+ and CD16+ populations from PBMC with magnetic beads.
  • one P501S-specific CD8+ T cell line (referred to as 2A2) was identified that produced IFN-gamma in response to IFN-gamma-treated P501S/CD80 expressing autologous fibroblasts, but not in response to IFN-gamma-treated P703P/CD80 expressing autologous fibroblasts in a ⁇ -IFN Elispot assay.
  • Line 2A2 was cloned in 96-well plates with 0.5 cell/well or 2 cells/well in the presence of 75,000 PBMC/well, 10,000 B-LCL/well, 30ng/ml OKT3 and 50u/ml IL-2. Twelve clones were isolated that showed strong P501S specificity in response to transduced fibroblasts.
  • Fluorescence activated cell sorting analysis was performed on P501 S-specific clones using CD3-, CD4- and CD8-specific antibodies conjugated to PercP, FITC and PE respectively. Consistent with the use of CD8 enriched T cells in the priming cultures, P5401 S-specific clones were determined to be CD3+, CD8+ and CD4-.
  • pools of 18-20 mer or 30-mer peptides that spanned the majority of the amino acid sequence of P501 S were loaded onto autologous B-LCL and tested in ⁇ -IFN Elispot assays for the ability to stimulate two P501S-specific CTL clones, referred to as 4E5 and 4E7.
  • each of the 18-20 mer peptides that comprised the positive pool were tested individually in ⁇ -IFN Elispot assays for the ability to stimulate the two P501 S-specific CTL clones, 4E5 and 4E7. Both 4E5 and 4E7 specifically recognized one 20-mer peptide (SEQ ID NO: 853; cDNA sequence provided in SEQ ID NO: 854) that spanned amino acids 453-472 of P501 S.
  • This sequence defines a minimal 10-mer epitope from P501 S that can be naturally processed and to which CTL responses can be identified in normal PBMC.
  • this epitope is a candidate for use as a vaccine moiety, and as a therapeutic and/or diagnostic reagent for prostate cancer.
  • SEQ ID NO: 855-specific response was detected using both the autologous (D326) and heterologous (D107) B-LCL, and furthermore the responses were blocked by pre-incubation with 25ug/ml of B1.23.2 HLA-B/C blocking antibody. Together these results demonstrate that the P501 S-specific response to the peptide of SEQ ID NO: 855 is restricted to the HLA-B51 class I allele. Molecular cloning and sequence analysis of the HLA-B51 allele from D3326 revealed that the HLA-B51 subtype of D326 is HLA-B51011.
  • each of the HLA B and C alleles were cloned from the donor used in the in vitro priming experiment. Sequence analysis indicated that the relevant alleles were HLA-B8, HLA-B51, HLA-Cw01 and HLA-Cw07. Each of these alleles were subcloned into an expression vector and co-transfected together with the P501 S gene into VA-13 cells. Transfected VA-13 cells were then tested for the ability to specifically stimulate the P501 S-specific CTL in ELISPOT assays.
  • VA-13 cells transfected with P501 S and HLA-B51 were capable of stimulating the P501 S-specific CTL to secrete gamma-IFN.
  • VA-13 cells transfected with HLA-B51 alone or P501 S + the other HLA-alleles were not capable of stimulating the P501 S-specific CTL.
  • the P501 S-positive lines LnCAP and CRL2422 both expressing "moderate” amounts of P501 S mRNA and protein
  • PC-3 expressing low amounts of P501 S mRNA and protein
  • the P501 S-negative cell line DU-145 were retrovirally transduced with the HLA-B51011 allele that was cloned from the donor used to generate the P501 S-specific CTL.
  • HLA-B51011- or EGFP-transduced and selected tumor cells were treated with gamma-interferon and androgen (to upregulate stimulatory functions and P501 S, respectively) and used in gamma-interferon Elispot assays with the P501 S-specific CTL clones 4E5 and 4E7. Untreated cells were used as a control.
  • CD4 cells specific for P501S were prepared as described above. A series of 16 overlapping peptides were synthesized that spanned approximately 50% of the amino terminal portion of the P501S gene (amino acids 1- 325 of SEQ ID NO: 113). For priming, peptides were combined into pools of 4 peptides, pulsed at 4 ⁇ g/ml onto dendritic cells (DC) for 24 hours, with TNF-alpha. DC were then washed and mixed with negatively selected CD4+ T cells in 96 well U-bottom plates. Cultures were re-stimulated weekly on fresh DC loaded with peptide pools.
  • DC dendritic cells
  • lines AD9 and AE10 specifically recognized peptide 1 (SEQ ID NO: 862), and line AF5 recognized peptide 39 (SEQ ID NO: 861).
  • line BC6 could be identified that recognized peptide 58 (SEQ ID NO: 860). Each of these lines were stimulated on the specific peptide and tested for specific recognition of the peptide in a titration assay as well as cell lysates generated by infection of HEK 293 cells with adenovirus expressing either P501 S or an irrelevant antigen.
  • APC-adherent monocytes were pulsed with either 10, 1, or 0.1 ⁇ g/ml individual P501S peptides, and DC were pulsed overnight with a 1:5 dilution of adenovirally infected cell lysates.
  • Lines AD9, AE10 and AF5 retained significant recognition of the relevant P501 S-derived peptides even at 0.1 mg/ml.
  • line AD9 demonstrated significant (8.1 fold stimulation index) specific activity for lysates from adenovirus-P501S infected cells.
  • This Example describes the isolation of certain prostate-specific polypeptides from a prostate tumor cDNA library.
  • a human prostate tumor cDNA expression library as described above was screened using microarray analysis to identify clones that display at least a three fold over-expression in prostate tumor and/or normal prostate tissue, as compared to non-prostate normal tissues (not including testis). 372 clones were identified, and 319 were successfully sequenced. Table II presents a summary of these clones, which are shown in SEQ ID NO:385-400. Of these sequences SEQ ID NO:386, 389, 390 and 392 correspond to novel genes, and SEQ ID NO: 393 and 396 correspond to previously identified sequences. The others (SEQ ID NO:385, 387, 388, 391, 394, 395 and 397-400) correspond to known sequences, as shown in Table II.
  • P784P L-iditol-2 dehydrogenase (23376; SEQ ID NO:388) p502S Ets transcription factor PDEF (22672; SEQ ID NO:398) P706P hTGR (22678; SEQ ID NO:399) 19142.2, bangur.seq (22621; SEQ ID NO:396) KIAA0295(22685; SEQ ID NO:400) 5566.1 Wang (23404; SEQ ID NO:393) Prostatic Acid Phosphatase(22655; SEQ ID NO:397) P712P transglutaminase (22611; SEQ ID NO:395) P778P HDLBP (23508; SEQ ID NO:394) CGI-69 Protein(23367; SEQ ID NO:387) KIAA0122(23383; SEQ ID NO:391) TEEG
  • CGI-82 showed 4.06 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 43% of prostate tumors, 25% normal prostate, not detected in other normal tissues tested.
  • L-iditol-2 dehydrogenase showed 4.94 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 90% of prostate tumors, 100% of normal prostate, and not detected in other normal tissues tested.
  • Ets transcription factor PDEF showed 5.55 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 47% prostate tumors, 25% normal prostate and not detected in other normal tissues tested.
  • hTGR1 showed 9.11 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested.
  • KIAA0295 showed 5.59 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 47% of prostate tumors, low to undetectable in normal tissues tested including normal prostate tissues.
  • Prostatic acid phosphatase showed 9.14 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 67% of prostate tumors, 50% of normal prostate, and not detected in other normal tissues tested.
  • Transglutaminase showed 14.84 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 30% of prostate tumors, 50% of normal prostate, and is not detected in other normal tissues tested.
  • High density lipoprotein binding protein showed 28.06 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 97% of prostate tumors, 75% of normal prostate, and is undetectable in all other normal tissues tested.
  • CGI-69 showed 3.56 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It is a low abundant gene, detected in more than 90% of prostate tumors, and in 75% normal prostate tissues. The expression of this gene in normal tissues was very low.
  • KIAA0122 showed 4.24 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 57% of prostate tumors, it was undetectable in all normal tissues tested including normal prostate tissues.
  • Novel clone 23399 showed 4.09 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was over-expressed in 27% of prostate tumors and was undetectable in all normal tissues tested including normal prostate tissues. Novel clone 23320 showed 3.15 fold over-expression in prostate tissues as compared to other normal tissues tested. It was detectable in all prostate tumors and 50% of normal prostate tissues. It was also expressed in normal colon and trachea. Other normal tissues do not express this gene at high level.
  • SEQ ID NO: 705 An amino acid sequence encoded by SEQ ID NO: 705 is provided in SEQ ID NO: 706.
  • the cDNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 702 was found to contain two open reading frames (ORFs). The amino acid sequences encoded by these two ORFs are provided in SEQ ID NO: 707 and 708.
  • This Example describes the use of an electronic subtraction technique to identify prostate-specific antigens.
  • prostate-specific genes present in the GenBank human EST database were identified by electronic subtraction (similar to that described by Vasmatizis et al., Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 95:300-304, 1998 ).
  • the sequences of EST clones (43,482) derived from various prostate libraries were obtained from the GenBank public human EST database.
  • Each prostate EST sequence was used as a query sequence in a BLASTN (National Center for Biotechnology Information) search against the human EST database. All matches considered identical (length of matching sequence >100 base pairs, density of identical matches over this region > 70%) were grouped (aligned) together in a cluster.
  • Clusters containing more than 200 ESTs were discarded since they probably represented repetitive elements or highly expressed genes such as those for ribosomal proteins. If two or more clusters shared common ESTs, those clusters were grouped together into a "supercluster,” resulting in 4,345 prostate superclusters.
  • Each supercluster was analyzed in terms of the ESTs within the supercluster.
  • the tissue source of each EST clone was noted and used to classify the superclusters into four groups: Type 1- EST clones found in the Plus group libraries only; no expression detected in Minus or Other group libraries; Type 2- EST clones derived from the Plus and Other group libraries only; no expression detected in the Minus group; Type 3- EST clones derived from the Plus, Minus and Other group libraries, but the number of ESTs derived from the Plus group is higher than in either the Minus or Other groups; and Type 4- EST clones derived from Plus, Minus and Other group libraries, but the number derived from the Plus group is higher than the number derived from the Minus group.
  • the EST clone inserts were PCR-amplified using amino-linked PCR primers for Synteni microarray analysis. When more than one PCR product was obtained for a particular clone, that PCR product was not used for expression analysis.
  • 2,528 clones from the electronic subtraction method were analyzed by microarray analysis to identify electronic subtraction breast clones that had high levels of tumor vs. normal tissue mRNA. Such screens were performed using a Synteni (Palo Alto, CA) microarray, according to the manufacturer's instructions (and essentially as described by Schena et al., Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 93:10614-10619, 1996 and Heller et al., Proc.
  • Clones with an expression ratio greater than 3 i.e., the level in prostate tumor and normal prostate mRNA was at least three times the level in other normal tissue mRNA
  • the sequences of these clones are provided in SEQ ID NO: 401-453, with certain novel sequences shown in SEQ ID NO: 407, 413, 416-419, 422, 426, 427 and 450.
  • TABLE V PROSTATE-TUMOR SPECIFIC CLONES SEQ ID NO.
  • SEQ ID NO: 407 also referred to as P1020C
  • P1020C extended cDNA sequence
  • SEQ ID NO: 591 This extended cDNA sequence was found to contain an open reading frame that encodes the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 592.
  • the P1020C cDNA and amino acid sequences were found to show some similarity to the human endogenous retroviral HERV-K pol gene and protein.
  • This Example describes the isolation of additional prostate-specific polypeptides from a prostate tumor cDNA library.
  • a human prostate tumor cDNA expression library as described above was screened using microarray analysis to identify clones that display at least a three fold over-expression in prostate tumor and/or normal prostate tissue, as compared to non-prostate normal tissues (not including testis).
  • 142 clones were identified and sequenced. Certain of these clones are shown in SEQ ID NO: 454-467. Of these sequences, SEQ ID NO: 459-460 represent novel genes. The others (SEQ ID NO: 454-458 and 461-467) correspond to known sequences.
  • Comparison of the determined cDNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 461 with sequences in the Genbank database using the BLAST program revealed homology to the previously identified transmembrane protease serine 2 (TMPRSS2).
  • the full-length cDNA sequence for this clone is provided in SEQ ID NO: 894, with the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 895.
  • the cDNA sequence encoding the first 209 amino acids of TMPRSS2 is provided in SEQ ID NO: 896, with the first 209 amino acids being provided in SEQ ID NO: 897.
  • SEQ ID NO: 462 The sequence of SEQ ID NO: 462 (referred to as P835P) was found to correspond to the previously identified clone FLJ13518 (Accession AK023643; SEQ ID NO: 917), which had no associated open reading frame (ORF). This clone was used to search the Geneseq DNA database and matched a clone previously identified as a G protein-coupled receptor protein (DNA Geneseq Accession A09351; amino acid Geneseq Accession Y92365), that is characterized by the presence of seven transmembrane domains.
  • SEQ ID NO: 921-928 The sequences of fragments between these domains are provided in SEQ ID NO: 921-928, with SEQ ID NO: 921, 923, 925 and 927 representing extracellular domains and SEQ ID NO: 922, 924, 926 and 928 representing intracellular domains.
  • SEQ ID NO: 921-928 represent amino acids 1-28, 53-61, 83-103, 124-143, 165-201, 226-238, 263-272 and 297-381, respectively, of P835P.
  • the full-length cDNA sequence for P835P is provided in SEQ ID NO: 916.
  • the cDNA sequence of the open reading frame for P835P, including stop codon, is provided in SEQ ID NO: 918, with the open reading frame without stop codon being provided in SEQ ID NO: 919 and the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 920.
  • This Example describes the full length cloning of P710P.
  • the prostate cDNA library described above was screened with the P710P fragment described above.
  • One million colonies were plated on LB/Ampicillin plates. Nylon membrane filters were used to lift these colonies, and the cDNAs picked up by these filters were then denatured and cross-linked to the filters by UV light.
  • the P710P fragment was radiolabeled and used to hybridize with the filters. Positive cDNA clones were selected and their cDNAs recovered and sequenced by an automatic Perkin Elmer/Applied Biosystems Division Sequencer. Four sequences were obtained, and are presented in SEQ ID NO: 468-471. These sequences appear to represent different splice variants of the P710P gene.
  • This example describes the expression and purification of prostate-specific antigens in E. coli, baculovirus and mammalian cells.
  • P501S DNA was used to perform PCR using the primers AW025 (SEQ ID NO: 485) and AW003 (SEQ ID NO: 486).
  • AW025 is a sense cloning primer that contains a HindIII site.
  • AW003 is an antisense cloning primer that contains an EcoRI site.
  • DNA amplification was performed using 5 ⁇ l 10X Pfu buffer, 1 ⁇ l 20 mM dNTPs, 1 ⁇ l each of the PCR primers at 10 ⁇ M concentration, 40 ⁇ l water, 1 ⁇ l Pfu DNA polymerase (Stratagene, La Jolla, CA) and 1 ⁇ l DNA at 100 ng/ ⁇ l. Denaturation at 95°C was performed for 30 sec, followed by 10 cycles of 95°C for 30 sec, 60°C for 1 min and by 72°C for 3 min. 20 cycles of 95°C for 30 sec, 65°C for 1 min and by 72°C for 3 min, and lastly by 1 cycle of 72°C for 10 min.
  • the PCR product was cloned to Ra12m/pET17b using HindIII and EcoRI. The sequence of the resulting fusion construct (referred to as Ra12-P501S-F) was confirmed by DNA sequencing.
  • the fusion construct was transformed into BL21 (DE3)pLysE, pLysS and CodonPlus E. coli (Stratagene) and grown overnight in LB broth with kanamycin. The resulting culture was induced with IPTG. Protein was transferred to PVDF membrane and blocked with 5% non-fat milk (in PBS-Tween buffer), washed three times and incubated with mouse anti-His tag antibody (Clontech) for 1 hour. The membrane was washed 3 times and probed with HRP-Protein A (Zymed) for 30 min. Finally, the membrane was washed 3 times and developed with ECL (Amersham). No expression was detected by Western blot. Similarly, no expression was detected by Western blot when the Ra12-P501S-F fusion was used for expression in BL21 CodonPlus by CE6 phage (Invitrogen).
  • P501 S DNA was used to perform PCR using the primers AW025 (SEQ ID NO: 485) and AW027 (SEQ ID NO: 487).
  • AW027 is an antisense cloning primer that contains an EcoRI site and a stop codon. DNA amplification was performed essentially as described above. The resulting PCR product was cloned to Ra12 in pET17b at the HindIII and EcoRI sites. The fusion construct (referred to as Ra12-P501S-N) was confirmed by DNA sequencing.
  • the Ra12-P501S-N fusion construct was used for expression in BL21(DE3)pLysE, pLysS and CodonPlus, essentially as described above. Using Western blot analysis, protein bands were observed at the expected molecular weight of 36 kDa. Some high molecular weight bands were also observed, probably due to aggregation of the recombinant protein. No expression was detected by Western blot when the Ra12-P501S-F fusion was used for expression in BL21 CodonPlus by CE6 phage.
  • a fusion construct comprising a C-terminal portion of P501 S (amino acids 257-553 of SEQ ID NO: 113) located down-stream of the first 30 amino acids of the M. tuberculosis antigen Ra12 (SEQ ID NO: 484) was prepared as follows.
  • P501 S DNA was used to perform PCR using the primers AW026 (SEQ ID NO: 488) and AW003 (SEQ ID NO: 486).
  • AW026 is a sense cloning primer that contains a HindIII site. DNA amplification was performed essentially as described above. The resulting PCR product was cloned to Ra12 in pET17b at the HindIII and EcoRI sites.
  • the sequence for the fusion construct (referred to as Ra12-P501S-C) was confirmed.
  • the Ra12-P501S-C fusion construct was used for expression in BL21 (DE3)pLysE, pLysS and CodonPlus, as described above. A small amount of protein was detected by Western blot, with some molecular weight aggregates also being observed. Expression was also detected by Western blot when the Ra12-P501S-C fusion was used for expression in BL21CodonPlus induced by CE6 phage.
  • a fusion construct comprising a fragment of P501 S (amino acids 36-298 of SEQ ID NO: 113) located down-stream of the M. tuberculosis antigen Ra12 (SEQ ID NO: 848) was prepared as follows.
  • P501S DNA was used to perform PCR using the primers AW042 (SEQ ID NO: 849) and AW053 (SEQ ID NO: 850).
  • AW042 is a sense cloning primer that contains a EcoRl site.
  • AW053 is an antisense primer with stop and Xho I sites. DNA amplification was performed essentially as described above. The resulting PCR product was cloned to Ra12 in pET17b at the EcoRI and Xho I sites.
  • the resulting fusion construct (referred to as Ra12-P501S-E2) was expressed in B834 (DE3) pLys S E. coli host cells in TB media for 2 h at room temperature.
  • Expressed protein was purified by washing the inclusion bodies and running on a Ni-NTA column. The purified protein stayed soluble in buffer containing 20 mM Tris-HCl (pH 8), 100 mM NaCl, 10 mM ⁇ -Me and 5% glycerol.
  • the determined cDNA and amino acid sequences for the expressed fusion protein are provided in SEQ ID NO: 851 and 852, respectfully.
  • the Bac-to-Bac baculovirus expression system (BRL Life Technologies, Inc.) was used to express P501 S protein in insect cells.
  • Full-length P501S (SEQ ID NO: 113) was amplified by PCR and cloned into the Xbal site of the donor plasmid pFastBacl.
  • the recombinant bacmid and baculovirus were prepared according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • the recombinant baculovirus was amplified in Sf9 cells and the high titer viral stocks were utilized to infect High Five cells (Invitrogen) to make the recombinant protein.
  • the localization of recombinant P501 S in the insect cells was investigated as follows.
  • the insect cells overexpressing P501 S were fractionated into fractions of nucleus, mitochondria, membrane and cytosol. Equal amounts of protein from each fraction were analyzed by Western blot with a monoclonal antibody against P501 S. Due to the scheme of fractionation, both nucleus and mitochondria fractions contain some plasma membrane components. However, the membrane fraction is basically free from mitochondria and nucleus. P501 S was found to be present in all fractions that contain the membrane component, suggesting that P501 S may be associated with plasma membrane of the insect cells expressing the recombinant protein.
  • P501 S 553 amino acids; SEQ ID NO: 113 was cloned into various mammalian expression vectors, including pCEP4 (Invitrogen), pVR1012 (Vical, San Diego, CA) and a modified form of the retroviral vector pBMN, referred to as pBIB.
  • Transfection of P501S/pCEP4 and P501S/pVR1012 into HEK293 fibroblasts was carried out using the Fugene transfection reagent (Boehringer Mannheim). Briefly, 2 ul of Fugene reagent was diluted into 100 ul of serum-free media and incubated at room temperature for 5-10 min.
  • Transfection of p501 S/pCEP4 into CHO-K cells was carried out using GenePorter transfection reagent (Gene Therapy Systems, San Diego, CA). Briefly, 15 ⁇ l of GenePorter was diluted in 500 ⁇ l of serum-free media and incubated at room temperature for 10 min. The GenePorter/media mixture was added to 2 ⁇ g of plasmid DNA that was diluted in 500 ⁇ l of serum-free media, mixed briefly and incubated for 30 min at room temperature. CHO-K cells were rinsed in PBS to remove serum proteins, and the GenePorter/DNA mix was added and incubated for 5 hours. The transfected cells were then fed an equal volume of 2x media and incubated for 24-48 hours.
  • FACS analysis of P501S transiently infected CHO-K cells demonstrated surface expression of P501 S. Expression was detected using rabbit polyclonal antisera raised against a P501 S peptide, as described below. Flow cytometric analysis was performed using a FaCScan (Becton Dickinson), and the data were analyzed using the Cell Quest program.
  • the cDNA for full-length P703P-DE5 (SEQ ID NO: 326), together with several flanking restriction sites, was obtained by digesting the plasmid pCDNA703 with restriction endonucleases Xba I and Hind III. The resulting restriction fragment (approx. 800 base pairs) was ligated into the transfer plasmid pFastBacl which was digested with the same restriction enzymes. The sequence of the insert was confirmed by DNA sequencing.
  • the recombinant transfer plasmid pFBP703 was used to make recombinant bacmid DNA and baculovirus using the Bac-To-Bac Baculovirus expression system (BRL Life Technologies). High Five cells were infected with the recombinant virus BVP703, as described above, to obtain recombinant P703P protein.
  • P788P-N A truncated, N-terminal portion, of P788P (residues 1-644 of SEQ ID NO: 777; referred to as P788P-N) fused with a C-terminal 6xHis Tag was expressed in E. coli as follows.
  • P788P cDNA was amplified using the primers AW080 and AW081 (SEQ ID NO: 815 and 816).
  • AW080 is a sense cloning primer with an Ndel site.
  • AW081 is an antisense cloning primer with a Xhol site.
  • the PCR-amplified P788P, as well as the vector pCRX1, were digested with Ndel and Xhol.
  • the P510S protein has 9 potential transmembrane domains and is predicted to be located at the plasma membrane.
  • the C-terminal protein of this protein, as well as the predicted third extracellular domain of P510S were expressed in E. coli as follows.
  • Ra12-P501S-C The expression construct referred to as Ra12-P501S-C was designed to have a 6 HisTag at the N-terminal enc, followed by the M. tuberculosis antigen Ra12 (SEQ ID NO: 819) and then the C-terminal portion of P510S (amino residues 1176-1261 of SEQ ID NO: 538).
  • Full-length P510S was used to amplify the P510S-C fragment by PCR using the primers AW056 and AW057 (SEQ ID NO: 820 and 821, respectively).
  • AW056 is a sense cloning primer with an EcoRl site.
  • AW057 is an antisense primer with stop and Xhol sites.
  • the amplified P501S fragment and Ra12/pCRX1 were digested with EcoRI and Xhol and then purified.
  • the insert and vector were ligated together and transformed into NovaBlue. Colonies were randomly screened for insert and sequences.
  • the expression construct was transformed into E . coli BL21 (DE3) CodonPlus-RIL competent cells.
  • a mini-induction screen was performed to optimize the expression conditions. After induction the cells grew well, achieving OD 600 nm greater than 2.0 after 3 hours.
  • Coomassie stain SDS-PAGE showed a highly over-expressed band at approx. 30 kD. Though this is higher than the expected molecular weight, western blot analysis was positive, showing this band to be the His tagcontaining protein.
  • the expression construct P510S-C was designed to have a 5' added start codon and a glycine (GGA) codon and then the P510S C terminal fragment followed by the in frame 6x histidine tag and stop codon from the pET28b vector.
  • the cloning strategy is similar to that used for Ra12-P510S-C, except that the PCR primers employed were those shown in SEQ ID NO: 828 and 829, respectively and the Ncol/Xhol cut in pET28b was used.
  • the primer of SEQ ID NO: 828 created a 5' Ncol site and added a start codon.
  • the antisense primer of SEQ ID NO: 829 creates a Xhol site on P510S C terminal fragment. Clones were confirmed by sequencing.
  • the expression construct was transformed into E . coli BL21 (DE3) CodonPlus-RIL competent cells. An OD600 of greater than 2.0 was obtained 30 hours after induction. Coomassie stained SDS-PAGE showed an over-expressed band at about 11 kD. Western blot analysis confirmed that the band was P510S-C, as did N-terminal protein sequencing.
  • the optimized culture conditions are as follows: dilute overnight culture/daytime culture (LB + kanamycin + chloramphenicol) into 2x YT (+ kanamycin and chloramphenicol) at a ratio of 25 mL culture to 1 liter 2x YT, and allow to grow at 37°C until an OD 600 of about 0.5 is reached.
  • the predicted third extracellular domain of P510S (P510S-E3; residues 328-676 of SEQ ID NO: 538) was expressed in E . coli as follows.
  • the P510S fragment was amplified by PCR using the primers shown in SEQ ID NO: 830 and 831.
  • the primer of SEQ ID NO: 830 is a sense primer with an Ndel site for use in ligating into pPDM.
  • the primer of SEQ ID NO: 831 is an antisense primer with an added Xhol site for use in ligating into pPDM.
  • the resulting fragment was cloned to pPDM at the Ndel and Xhol sites. Clones were confirmed by sequencing. For protein expression, the clone ws transformed into E.
  • Optimized culture conditions are as follows: dilute overnight culture/daytime culture (LB + kanamycin + chloramphenicol) into 2x YT (kanamycin and chloramphenicol) at a ratio of 25 ml culture to 1 liter 2x YT. Allow to grow at 37°C until OD 600 equals 0.6. Take out an aliquot as T0 sample.
  • the antigen P775P contains multiple open reading frames (ORF).
  • ORF open reading frames
  • the third ORF, encoding the protein of SEQ ID NO: 483, has the best emotif score.
  • An expression fusion construct containing the M. tuberculosis antigen Ra12 (SEQ ID NO: 819) and P775P-ORF3 with an N-terminal 6x HisTag was prepared as follows.
  • P775P-ORF3 was amplified using the sense PCR primers of SEQ ID NO: 832 and the anti-sense PCR primer of SEQ ID NO: 833.
  • the PCR amplified fragment of P775P and Ra12/pCRX1 were digested with the restriction enzymes EcoRI and XhoI. Vector and insert were ligated and then transformed into NovaBlue cells.
  • Colonies were randomly screened for insert and then sequenced. A clone having the desired sequence was transformed into E. coli BL21 (DE3) CodonPlus-RIL competent cells. Two hours after induction, the cell density peaked at OD600 of approximately 1.8. Coomassie stained SDS-PAGE showed an over-expressed band at about 31 kD. Western blot using 6x HisTag antibody confirmed that the band was Ra12-P775P-ORF3. The determined cDNA and amino acid sequences for the fusion construct are provided in SEQ ID NO: 834 and 835, respectively.
  • the cDNA for the coding region of P703P was prepared by PCR using the primers of SEQ ID NO: 836 and 837.
  • the PCR product was digested with EcoRI restriction enzyme, gel purified and cloned into a modified pET28 vector with a His tag in frame, which had been digested with Eco72I and EcoRI restriction enzymes.
  • the correct construct was confirmed by DNA sequence analysis and then transformed into E . coli BL21 (DE3) pLys S expression host cells.
  • the determined amino acid and cDNA sequences for the expressed recombinant P703P are provided in SEQ ID NO: 838 and 839, respectively.
  • the cDNA for the coding region of P705P was prepared by PCR using the primers of SEQ ID NO: 840 and 841.
  • the PCR product was digested with EcoRl restriction enzyme, gel purified and cloned into a modified pET28 vector with a His tag in frame, which had been digested with Eco721 and EcoRl restriction enzymes.
  • the correct construct was confirmed by DNA sequence analysis and then transformed into E. coli BL21 (DE3) pLys S and BL21 (DE3) CodonPlus expression host cells.
  • the determined amino acid and cDNA sequences for the expressed recombinant P705P are provided in SEQ ID NO: 842 and 843, respectively.
  • the cDNA for the coding region of P711 P was prepared by PCR using the primers of SEQ ID NO: 844 and 845.
  • the PCR product was digested with EcoRl restriction enzyme, gel purified and cloned into a modified pET28 vector with a His tag in frame, which had been digested with Eco721 and EcoRl restriction enzymes.
  • the correct construct was confirmed by DNA sequence analysis and then transformed into E . coli BL21 (DE3) pLys S and BL21 (DE3) CodonPlus expression host cells.
  • the determined amino acid and cDNA sequences for the expressed recombinant P711 P are provided in SEQ ID NO: 846 and 847, respectively.
  • the full-length coding region of P767P was amplified by PCR using the primers PDM-468 and PDM-469 (SEQ ID NO: 935 and 936, respectively).
  • DNA amplification was performed using 10 ⁇ l 10X Pfu buffer, 1 ⁇ l 10 mM dNTPs, 2 ⁇ l each of the PCR primers at 10 ⁇ M concentration, 83 ⁇ l water, 1.5 ⁇ l Pfu DNA polymerase (Stratagene, La Jolla, CA) and 1 ⁇ l DNA at 100 ng/ ⁇ l.
  • Denaturation at 96°C was performed for 2 min, followed by 40 cycles of 96°C for 20 sec, 66°C for 15 sec and by 72°C for 2 min., and lastly by 1 cycle of 72°C for 4 min.
  • the PCR product was digested with Xhol and cloned into a modified pET28 vector with a histidine tag in frame on the 5' end that was digested with Eco721 and Xhol. The construct was confirmed to be correct through sequence analysis and transformed into E . coli BL21 pLysS and BL21 CodonPlus RP cells.
  • the cDNA coding region for the recombinant B767P protein is provided in SEQ ID NO: 938, with the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 941.
  • the full-length P767P did not express at high enough levels for detection or purification.
  • a truncated coding region of P767P (referred to as B767P-B; amino acids 47-374 of SEQ ID NO: 590) was amplified by PCR using the primers PDM-573 and PDM-469 (SEQ ID NO: 937 and 936, respectively) and the PCR conditions described above for full-length P767P.
  • the PCR product was digested with Xhol and cloned into the modified pET28 vector that was digested with Eco72I and Xhol.
  • the construct was confirmed to be correct through sequence analysis and transformed into E . coli BL21 pLysS and BL21 CodonPlus RP cells.
  • the protein was found to be expressed in the inclusion body pellet.
  • the coding region for the expressed B767P-B protein is provided in SEQ ID NO: 939, with the corresponding amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 940.
  • the full length P767P cDNA (SEQ ID NO: 587) was subcloned into the mammalian expression vector pCEP4 (Invitrogen) that was modified to contain a FLAG epitope tag.
  • This construct was transfected into HEK293 cells (American Type Culture Collection) using Fugene 6 reagent (Roche). Briefly, the HEK cells were plated at a density of 100,000 cells/ml in DMEM (Gibco) containing 10% FBS (Hyclone) and grown overnight. The following day, 2 ul of Fugene 6 was added to 100 ul of DMEM containing no FBS and incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature.
  • the Fugene 6/DMEM mixture was then added to 1 ug of P767P/pCEP4 plasmid DNA and incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature.
  • the Fugene/DNA mix was then added to the HEK293 cells and incubated for 48-72 hrs at 37° C with 7% CO 2 . Cells were rinsed with PBS then collected and pelleted by centrifugation.
  • P767P expression was detect in transfected HEK293 whole cell lysates by Western blot analysis using an anti-epitope tag antibody. Specifically, whole cell lysates were generated by incubating the cells in Triton-X100 containing lysis buffer for 30 minutes on ice. Lysates were then cleared by centrifugation at 5,000 rpm for 5 minutes at 4° C. Samples were diluted with SDS-PAGE loading buffer containing beta-mercaptoethanol, then boiled for 10 minutes prior to loading the SDS-PAGE gel. Protein was transferred to nitrocellulose and probed using an anti-FLAG mouse monoclonal antibody (Sigma) at a dilution of 1 ug/ml. The blot was revealed with a donkey anti-mouse lg coupled to HRP followed by incubation in ECL substrate.
  • P767P was found to be expressed on the surface of transfected HEK293 cells by flow cytometry using rabbit anti-P767P sera as follows.
  • Cells were collected and washed with ice cold staining buffer (PBS+1 %BSA+Azide). Next, the cells were incubated for 30 minutes on ice with undiluted anti-P767P rabbit polyclonal sera. The cells were washed 3 times with staining buffer and then incubated with a 1:100 dilution of a goat anti-rabbit lg(H+L)-FITC reagent (Southern Biotechnology) for 30 minutes on ice. Following 3 washes, the cells were resuspended in staining buffer containing Propidium lodide (PI), a vital stain that allows for identification of permeable cells, and analyzed by FACS.
  • PI Propidium lodide
  • the full length P788P cDNA was subcloned into the mammalian expression vector pcDNA3.1 (Invitrogen). This construct was transfected into HEK293 cells (American Type Culture Collection) using Fugene 6 reagent (Roche). Briefly, the HEK cells were plated at a density of 100,000 cells/ml in DMEM (Gibco) containing 10% FBS (Hyclone) and grown overnight. The following day, 2 ul of Fugene6 was added to 100 ul of DMEM containing no FBS and incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature.
  • the Fugene6/DMEM mixture was then added to 1ug of P788P/pcDNA3.1 plasmid DNA and incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature.
  • the Fugene/DNA mix was then added to the HEK293 cells and incubated for 48-72 hrs at 37° C with 7% CO 2 . Cells were rinsed with PBS then collected and pelleted by centrifugation.
  • P788P expression was detected in transfected HEK293 whole cell lysates by Western blot analysis using rabbit anti-P788P sera as probe. Specifically, whole cell lysates were generated by incubating the cells in Triton-X100 containing lysis buffer for 30 minutes on ice. Lysates were then cleared by centrifugation at 5,000 rpm for 5 minutes at 4° C. Samples were diluted with SDS-PAGE loading buffer containing beta-mercaptoethanol, then boiled for 10 minutes prior to loading the SDS-PAGE gel. Protein was transferred to nitrocellulose and probed using purified anti-P788P rabbit polyclonal sera at a concentration of 1 ug/ml. The blot was revealed with a donkey anti-rabbit lg coupled to HRP (Jackson ImmunoResearch) followed by incubation in ECL substrate.
  • HRP Jackson ImmunoResearch
  • P788P expression was detected on the surface of transfected HEK293 cells by flow cytometry using rabbit anti-P788P sera.
  • cells were collected and washed with ice cold staining buffer (PBS+1%BSA+Azide). Next, the cells were incubated for 30 minutes on ice with anti-P788P polyclonal sera (10ug/ml final concentration). The cells were washed 3 times with staining buffer and then incubated with a 1:100 dilution of a goat anti-rabbit lg(H+L)-FITC reagent (Southern Biotechnology) for 30 minutes on ice. Following 3 washes, the cells were resuspended in staining buffer containing Propidium iodide (PI), a vital stain that allows for identification of permeable cells, and analyzed by flow cytometry.
  • PI Propidium iodide
  • P703PFL Polyclonal antibodies against P703P, P504S, P509S, P501 S, P510S-E3, P510S-C, P705P, full-length P703P (referred to as P703PFL), P711 P, P767P, P788P-N, and peptides of P790P and P775P were prepared as follows.
  • amino acid sequences of the P790P peptides are provided in SEQ ID NO: 949-956, with the amino acid sequences of the P775P peptides being provided in SEQ ID NO: 957-966.
  • Each prostate tumor antigen expressed in an E . coli recombinant expression system was grown overnight in LB broth with the appropriate antibiotics at 37°C in a shaking incubator. The next morning, 10 ml of the overnight culture was added to 500 ml to 2x YT plus appropriate antibiotics in a 2L-baffled Erlenmeyer flask. When the Optical Density (at 560 nm) of the culture reached 0.4-0.6, the cells were induced with IPTG (1 mM). Four hours after induction with IPTG, the cells were harvested by centrifugation. The cells were then washed with phosphate buffered saline and centrifuged again. The supernatant was discarded and the cells were either frozen for future use or immediately processed.
  • lysis buffer Twenty ml of lysis buffer was added to the cell pellets and vortexed. To break open the E. coli cells, this mixture was then run through the French Press at a pressure of 16,000 psi. The cells were then centrifuged again and the supernatant and pellet were checked by SDS-PAGE for the partitioning of the recombinant protein. For proteins that localized to the cell pellet, the pellet was resuspended in 10 mM Tris pH 8.0, 1 % CHAPS and the inclusion body pellet was washed and centrifuged again. This procedure was repeated twice more.
  • the washed inclusion body pellet was solubilized with either 8 M urea or 6 M guanidine HCl containing 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 plus 10 mM imidazole.
  • the solubilized protein was added to 5 ml of nickel-chelate resin (Qiagen) and incubated for 45 min to 1 hour at room temperature with continuous agitation. After incubation, the resin and protein mixture were poured through a disposable column and the flow through was collected. The column was then washed with 10-20 column volumes of the solubilization buffer.
  • the antigen was then eluted from the column using 8M urea, 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 and 300 mM imidazole and collected in 3 ml fractions. A SDS-PAGE gel was run to determine which fractions to pool for further purification.
  • a strong anion exchange resin such as HiPrepQ (Biorad) was equilibrated with the appropriate buffer and the pooled fractions from above were loaded onto the column. Each antigen was eluted off the column with a increasing salt gradient. Fractions were collected as the column was run and another SDS-PAGE gel was run to determine which fractions from the column to pool. The pooled fractions were dialyzed against 10 mM Tris pH 8.0. The proteins were then vialed after filtration through a 0.22 micron filter and the antigens were frozen until needed for immunization.
  • HiPrepQ Biorad
  • the P790P and P775P peptides were synthesized, conjugated to KLH and frozen until needed for immunization.
  • HRP horse radish peroxidase
  • IHC immunohistochemistry
  • Tissue samples were fixed in formalin solution for 12-24 hrs and embedded in paraffin before being sliced into 8 micron sections.
  • SHIER Steam heat induced epitope retrieval
  • the avidin biotin complex/horse radish peroxidase (ABC/HRP) system was used along with DAB chromogen to visualize antigen expression. Slides were counterstained with hematoxylin to visualize cell nuclei. P509S expression was detected in prostate cancer, BPH, colon, and kidney but not in heart, lung and liver.
  • a murine monoclonal antibody directed against the carboxy-terminus of the prostate-specific antigen P501 S was prepared as follows.
  • a truncated fragment of P501 S (amino acids 355-526 of SEQ ID NO: 113) was generated and cloned into the pET28b vector (Novagen) and expressed in E. coli as a thioredoxin fusion protein with a histidine tag.
  • the trx-P501S fusion protein was purified by nickel chromatography, digested with thrombin to remove the trx fragment and further purified by an acid precipitation procedure followed by reverse phase HPLC.
  • mice were immunized with truncated P501 S protein. Serum bleeds from mice that potentially contained anti-P501 S polyclonal sera were tested for P501 S-specific reactivity using ELISA assays with purified P501 S and trx-P501 S proteins. Serum bleeds that appeared to react specifically with P501 S were then screened for P501 S reactivity by Western analysis. Mice that contained a P501 S-specific antibody component were sacrificed and spleen cells were used to generate anti-P501 S antibody producing hybridomas using standard techniques. Hybridoma supernatants were tested for P501S-specific reactivity initially by ELISA, and subsequently by FACS analysis of reactivity with P501 S transduced cells.
  • a monoclonal hybridoma referred to as 10E3 was chosen for further subcloning.
  • a number of subclones were generated, tested for specific reactivity to P501S using ELISA and typed for IgG isotype. The results of this analysis are shown below in Table V.
  • the monoclonal antibody 10E3-G4-D3 was selected for further study.
  • 10E3-G4-D3 for P501 S was examined by FACS analysis. Specifically, cells were fixed (2% formaldehyde, 10 minutes), permeabilized (0.1% saponin, 10 minutes) and stained with 10E3-G4-D3 at 0.5 - 1 ⁇ g/ml, followed by incubation with a secondary, FITC-conjugated goat anti-mouse lg antibody (Pharmingen, San Diego, CA). Cells were then analyzed for FITC fluorescence using an Excalibur fluorescence activated cell sorter. For FACS analysis of transduced cells, B-LCL were retrovirally transduced with P501 S.
  • B-LCL were infected with a vaccinia vector that expresses P501 S.
  • B-LCL transduced with a different antigen (P703P) and uninfected B-LCL vectors were utilized.
  • 10E3-G4-D3 was shown to bind with P501 S-transduced B-LCL and also with P501 S-infected B-LCL, but not with either uninfected cells or P703P-transduced cells.
  • B-LCL were transduced with P501 S or HLA-B8 as a control antigen and either fixed and permeabilized as described above or directly stained with 10E3-G4-D3 and analyzed as above. Specific recognition of P501 S by 1 0E3-G4-D3 was found to require permeabilization, suggesting that the epitope recognized by this antibody is intracellular.
  • P501 S mRNA expression is consistent with these results since semi-quantitative PCR analysis revealed that P501 S mRNA is expressed in Lncap, to a lesser but detectable level in PC-3 and not at all in DU-145 cells.
  • Bacterially expressed and purified recombinant P501 S (referred to as P501 SStr2) was recognized by 10E3-G4-D3 (24 kDa), as was full-length P501 S that was transiently expressed in HEK293 cells using either the expression vector VR1012 or pCEP4. Although the predicted molecular weight of P501 S is 60.5 kDa, both transfected and "native" P501 S run at a slightly lower mobility due to its hydrophobic nature.
  • Immunohistochemical analysis was performed on prostate tumor and a panel of normal tissue sections (prostate, adrenal, breast, cervix, colon, duodenum, gall bladder, ileum, kidney, ovary, pancreas, parotid gland, skeletal muscle, spleen and testis). Tissue samples were fixed in formalin solution for 24 hours and embedded in paraffin before being sliced into 10 micron sections. Tissue sections were permeabilized and incubated with 10E3-G4-D3 antibody for 1 hr. HRP-labeled anti-mouse followed by incubation with DAB chromogen was used to visualize P501 S immunoreactivity. P501 S was found to be highly expressed in both normal prostate and prostate tumor tissue but was not detected in any of the other tissues tested.
  • Purified antibody 10E3-G4-D3 was added at 2 fold dilutions (1000 ng - 16 ng) in PBST and incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature. This was followed by washing 6 times with PBST and subsequently incubating with HRP-conjugated donkey anti-mouse IgG (H+L)Affinipure F(ab') fragment (Jackson Immunoresearch, West Grove, PA) at 1:20000 for 30 minutes. Plates were then washed and incubated for 15 minutes in tetramethyl benzidine. Reactions were stopped by the addition of 1 N sulfuric acid and plates were read at 450 nm using an ELISA plate reader. As shown in Fig.
  • a fragment of P503S (amino acids 113-241 of SEQ ID NO: 114) was expressed and purified from bacteria essentially as described above for P501S and used to immunize both rabbits and mice.
  • Mouse monoclonal antibodies were isolated using standard hybridoma technology as described above. Rabbit monoclonal antibodies were isolated using Selected Lymphocyte Antibody Method (SLAM) technology at Immgenics Pharmaceuticals (Vancouver, BC, Canada). Table VI, below, lists the monoclonal antibodies that were developed against P503S. TABLE VII Antibody Species 20D4 Rabbit JA1 Rabbit 1A4 Mouse 1 C3 Mouse 1C9 Mouse 1D12 Mouse 2A11 Mouse 2H9 Mouse 4H7 Mouse 8A8 Mouse 8D10 Mouse 9C12 Mouse 6D12 Mouse
  • CDRs complementarity determining regions
  • PBST PBS containing 0.1 % Tween 20
  • Purified rabbit monoclonal antibodies diluted in PBST were added to the wells and incubated for 30 min at room temperature. This was followed by washing 6 times with PBST and incubation with Protein-A HRP conjugate at a 1:2000 dilution for a further 30 min. Plates were washed six times in PBST and incubated with tetramethylbenzidine (TMB) substrate for a further 15 min. The reaction was stopped by the addition of 1 N sulfuric acid and plates were read at 450 nm using at ELISA plate reader. ELISA with the mouse monoclonal antibodies was performed with supernatants from tissue culture run neat in the assay.
  • TMB tetramethylbenzidine
  • the antibodies were tested by FACS analysis on a cell line that stably expressed P503S to confirm that the antibodies bind to cell surface epitopes.
  • Cells stably transfected with a control plasmid were employed as a negative control.
  • Cells were stained live with no fixative.
  • 0.5 ug of anti-P503S monoclonal antibody was added and cells were incubated on ice for 30 min before being washed twice and incubated with a FITC-labelled goat anti-rabbit or mouse secondary antibody for 20 min. After being washed twice, cells were analyzed with an Excalibur fluorescent activated cell sorter.
  • the monoclonal antibodies 1C3, 1D12, 9C12, 20D4 and JA1, but not 8D3, were found to bind to a cell surface epitope of P503S.
  • P503S was found to be highly expressed in prostate tissue, with lower levels of expression being observed in cervix, colon, ileum and kidney, and no expression being observed in adrenal, breast, duodenum, gall bladder, ovary, pancreas, parotid gland, skeletal muscle, spleen and testis.
  • the monoclonal antibody 20D4 detected the appropriate molecular weight 14 kDa recombinant P503S (amino acids 113-241) and the 23.5 kDa species in the HEK293 cell lysates transfected with full length P503S.
  • Other anti-P503S monoclonal antibodies displayed similar specificity by Western blot.
  • Rabbits were immunized with either a truncated (P703Ptr1; SEQ ID NO: 172) or full-length mature form (P703Pfl; SEQ ID NO: 523) of recombinant P703P protein was expressed in and purified from bacteria as described above. Affinity purified polyclonal antibody was generated using immunogen P703Pfl or P703Ptr1 attached to a solid support. Rabbit monoclonal antibodies were isolated using SLAM technology at Immgenics Pharmaceuticals. Table VII below lists both the polyclonal and monoclonal antibodies that were generated against P703P. TABLE VIII Antibody Immunogen Species/type Aff. Purif.
  • P703P (truncated); #2594 P703Ptrl Rabbit polyclonal Aff. Purif. P703P (full length); #9245 P703Pfl Rabbit polyclonal 2D4 P703Ptrl Rabbit monoclonal 8H2 P703Ptrl Rabbit monoclonal 7H8 P703Ptrl Rabbit monoclonal
  • CDRs complementarity determining regions
  • Monoclonal antibodies 2D4 and 7H8 were found to specifically bind to the peptides of SEQ ID NO: 509 (corresponding to amino acids 145-159 of SEQ ID NO: 172) and SEQ ID NO: 510 (corresponding to amino acids 11-25 of SEQ ID NO: 172), respectively.
  • the polyclonal antibody 2594 was found to bind to the peptides of SEQ ID NO: 511-514, with the polyclonal antibody 9427 binding to the peptides of SEQ ID NO: 515-517.
  • the specificity of the anti-P703P antibodies was determined by Western blot analysis as follows. SDS-PAGE was performed on (1) bacterially expressed recombinant antigen; (2) lysates of HEK293 cells and Ltk-/- cells either untransfected or transfected with a plasmid expressing full length P703P; and (3) supernatant isolated from these cell cultures. Protein was transferred to nitrocellulose and then Western blotted using the anti-P703P polyclonal antibody #2594 at an antibody concentration of 1 ug/ml. Protein was detected using horse radish peroxidase (HRP) conjugated to an anti-rabbit antibody.
  • HRP horse radish peroxidase
  • a 35 kDa immunoreactive band could be observed with recombinant P703P.
  • Recombinant P703P runs at a slightly higher molecular weight since it is epitope tagged.
  • a 30 kDa band corresponding to P703P was observed.
  • lysates from HEK293 cells stably transfected with a control plasmid were also tested and were negative for P703P expression.
  • Other anti-P703P antibodies showed similar results.
  • P703P was found to be expressed at high levels in normal prostate and prostate tumor tissue but was not detectable in all other tissues tested (breast tumor, lung tumor and normal kidney).
  • Full-length P504S (SEQ ID NO: 108) was expressed and purified from bacteria essentially as described above for P501 S and employed to raise rabbit monoclonal antibodies using Selected Lymphocyte Antibody Method (SLAM) technology at Immgenics Pharmaceuticals (Vancouver, BC, Canada).
  • the anti-P504S monoclonal antibody 13H4 was shown by Western blot to bind to both expressed recombinant P504S and to native P504S in tumor cells.
  • P504S was stained strongly and diffusely in carcinomas (4+ in 91.2% of cases of PC; 3+ in 5.5%; 2+ in 2.2% and 1+ in 1.1%) and high grade prostatic intraepithelial neoplasia (4+ in all cases).
  • the expression of P504S did not vary with Gleason score. Only 17/91 (18.7%) of cases of NP/BPH around PC and 2/13 (15.4%) of BPH cases were focally (1+, no 2+ to 4+ in all cases) and weakly positive for P504S in large glands.
  • P504S may be usefully employed for the diagnosis of prostate cancer.
  • This example describes studies demonstrating that the prostate-specific antigen P501 S is expressed on the surface of cells, together with studies to determine the probable chromosomal location of P501S.
  • the protein P501S (SEQ ID NO: 113) is predicted to have 11 transmembrane domains. Based on the discovery that the epitope recognized by the anti-P501 S monoclonal antibody 10E3-G4-D3 (described above in Example 17) is intracellular, it was predicted that following transmembrane determinants would allow the prediction of extracellular domains of P501 S.
  • Fig. 9 is a schematic representation of the P501 S protein showing the predicted location of the transmembrane domains and the intracellular epitope described in Example 17. Underlined sequence represents the predicted transmembrane domains, bold sequence represents the predicted extracellular domains, and italicized sequence represents the predicted intracellular domains.
  • Sequence that is both bold and underlined represents sequence employed to generate polyclonal rabbit serum.
  • the location of the transmembrane domains was predicted using HHMTOP as described by Tusnady and Simon (Principles Governing Amino Acid Composition of Integral Membrane Proteins: Applications to Topology Prediction, J. Mol. Biol. 283:489-506, 1998 ).
  • the P501 S domain flanked by the transmembrane domains corresponding to amino acids 274-295 and 323-342 is predicted to be extracellular.
  • the peptide of SEQ ID NO: 518 corresponds to amino acids 306-320 of P501 S and lies in the predicted extracellular domain.
  • the peptide of SEQ ID NO: 519 which is identical to the peptide of SEQ ID NO: 518 with the exception of the substitution of the histidine with an asparginine, was synthesized as described above. A Cys-Gly was added to the C-terminus of the peptide to facilitate conjugation to the carrier protein.
  • Cleavage of the peptide from the solid support was carried out using the following cleavage mixture: trifluoroacetic acid:ethanediol:thioanisol:water:phenol (40:1:2:2:3). After cleaving for two hours, the peptide was precipitated in cold ether. The peptide pellet was then dissolved in 10% v/v acetic acid and lyophilized prior to purification by C18 reverse phase hplc. A gradient of 5-60% acetonitrile (containing 0.05% TFA) in water (containing 0.05% TFA) was used to elute the peptide. The purity of the peptide was verified by hplc and mass spectrometry, and was determined to be >95%. The purified peptide was used to generate rabbit polyclonal antisera as described above.
  • P501S surface expression of P501S was examined by FACS analysis.
  • Cells were stained with the polyclonal anti-P501 S peptide serum at 10 ⁇ g/ml, washed, incubated with a secondary FITC-conjugated goat anti-rabbit Ig antibody (ICN), washed and analyzed for FITC fluorescence using an Excalibur fluorescence activated cell sorter.
  • ICN secondary FITC-conjugated goat anti-rabbit Ig antibody
  • B-LCL were retrovirally transduced with P501S.
  • B-LCL transduced with an irrelevant antigen (P703P) or nontransduced were stained in parallel.
  • Lncap, PC-3 and DU-145 were utilized.
  • Prostate tumor cell lines were dissociated from tissue culture plates using cell dissociation medium and stained as above. All samples were treated with propidium iodide (PI) prior to FACS analysis, and data was obtained from PI-excluding ( i.e., intact and non-permeabilized) cells.
  • PI propidium iodide
  • the rabbit polyclonal serum generated against the peptide of SEQ ID NO: 519 was shown to specifically recognize the surface of cells transduced to express P501 S, demonstrating that the epitope recognized by the polyclonal serum is extracellular.
  • peripheral membranes from Lncap cells were isolated and subjected to Western blot analysis. Specifically, Lncap cells were lysed using a dounce homogenizer in 5 ml of homogenization buffer (250 mM sucrose, 10 mM HEPES, 1mM EDTA, pH 8.0, 1 complete protease inhibitor tablet (Boehringer Mannheim)). Lysate samples were spun at 1000 g for 5 min at 4°C. The supernatant was then spun at 8000g for 10 min at 4°C. Supernatant from the 8000g spin was recovered and subjected to a 100,000g spin for 30 min at 4°C to recover peripheral membrane.
  • homogenization buffer 250 mM sucrose, 10 mM HEPES, 1mM EDTA, pH 8.0, 1 complete protease inhibitor tablet (Boehringer Mannheim)
  • rabbits were immunized with peptides derived from the P501 S sequence and predicted to be either extracellular or intracellular, as shown in Fig. 9 .
  • Polyclonal rabbit sera were isolated and polyclonal antibodies in the serum were purified, as described above.
  • FACS analysis was employed, utilizing either B-LCL transduced with P501 S or the irrelevant antigen P703P, of B-LCL infected with vaccinia virus-expressing P501 S.
  • For surface expression dead and non-intact cells were excluded from the analysis as described above.
  • intracellular staining cells were fixed and permeabilized as described above.
  • sequences of SEQ ID NO: 541-547, 549 and 550 which correspond to amino acids 109-122, 539-553, 509-520, 37-54, 342-359, 295-323, 217-274, 143-160 and 75-88, respectively, of P501 S, can be considered to be potential surface epitopes of P501S recognized by antibodies.
  • mice were immunized with P501 S/adenovirus, followed by subsequent boosts with an E. coli recombinant protein, referred to as P501 N, that contains amino acids 296 to 322 of P501 S, and with peptide 296-322 (SEQ ID NO: 898) coupled with KLH. The mice were subsequently used for splenic B cell fusions to generate anti-peptide hybridomas.
  • the resulting 3 clones referred to as 4F4 (IgG1,kappa), 4G5 (IgG2a,kappa) and 9B9 (IgG1 ,kappa), were grown for antibody production.
  • the 4G5 mAb was purified by passing the supernatant over a Protein A-sepharose column, followed by antibody elution using 0.2M glycine, pH 2.3. Purified antibody was neutralized by the addition of 1 M Tris, pH 8, and buffer exchanged into PBS.
  • P501 S peptide 296-322 (referred to as P501-long), an irrelevant P775 peptide, P501S-N, P501 TR2, P501 S-long-KLH, P501 S peptide 306-319 (referred to as P501-short)-KLH, or the irrelevant peptide 2073-KLH, all at a concentration of 2 ug/ml and allowed to incubate for 60 minutes at 37°C.
  • plates were washed 5X with PBS + 0.1% Tween and then blocked with PBS, 0.5% BSA, 0.4% Tween20 for 2 hours at room temperature.
  • HEK293 cells were transiently transfected with a P501S/VR1012 expression constructs using Fugene 6 reagent. After 2 days of culture, cells were harvested and washed, then incubated with purified 4G5 mAb for 30 minutes on ice. After several washes in PBS, 0.5% BSA, 0.01% azide, goat anti-mouse Ig-FITC was added to the cells and incubated for 30 minutes on ice. Cells were washed and resuspended in wash buffer including 1% propidium iodide and subjected to FACS analysis. The FACS analysis confirmed that amino acids 296-322 of P501S are in an extracellular domain and are cell surface expressed.
  • the chromosomal location of P501 S was determined using the GeneBridge 4 Radiation Hybrid panel (Research Genetics).
  • the PCR primers of SEQ ID NO: 528 and 529 were employed in PCR with DNA pools from the hybrid panel according to the manufacturer's directions. After 38 cycles of amplification, the reaction products were separated on a 1.2% agarose gel, and the results were analyzed through the Whitehead Institute/MIT Center for Genome Research web server (http://www-genome.wi.mit.edu/cgi-bin/contig/rhmapper.pl) to determine the probable chromosomal location.
  • P501 S was mapped to the long arm of chromosome 1 at WI-9641 between q32 and q42.
  • Steroid (androgen) hormone modulation is a common treatment modality in prostate cancer.
  • the expression of a number of prostate tissue-specific antigens have previously been demonstrated to respond to androgen.
  • the responsiveness of the prostate-specific antigen P501 S to androgen treatment was examined in a tissue culture system as follows.
  • Cells from the prostate tumor cell line LNCaP were plated at 1.5 x 10 6 cells/T75 flask (for RNA isolation) or 3 x 10 5 cells/well of a 6-well plate (for FACS analysis) and grown overnight in RPMI 1640 media containing 10% charcoal-stripped fetal calf serum (BRL Life Technologies, Gaithersburg, MD). Cell culture was continued for an additional 72 hours in RPMI 1640 media containing 10% charcoal-stripped fetal calf serum, with 1 nM of the synthetic androgen Methyltrienolone (R1881; New England Nuclear) added at various time points. Cells were then harvested for RNA isolation and FACS analysis at 0, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 24, 28 and 72-hours post androgen addition. FACS analysis was performed using the anti-P501 S antibody 10E3-G4-D3 and permeabilized cells.
  • RNA was run on a formaldehyde denaturing gel, transferred to Hybond-N nylon membrane (Amersham Pharmacia Biotech, Piscataway, NJ), cross-linked and stained with methylene blue. The filter was then prehybridized with Church's Buffer (250 mM Na 2 HPO 4 , 70 mM H 3 PO 4 , 1 mM EDTA, 1% SDS, 1% BSA in pH 7.2) at 65°C for 1 hour. P501S DNA was labeled with 32P using High Prime random-primed DNA labeling kit (Boehringer Mannheim). Unincorporated label was removed using MicroSpin S300-HR columns (Amersham Pharmacia Biotech).
  • Church's Buffer 250 mM Na 2 HPO 4 , 70 mM H 3 PO 4 , 1 mM EDTA, 1% SDS, 1% BSA in pH 7.2
  • RNA filter was then hybridized with fresh Church's Buffer containing labeled cDNA overnight, washed with 1X SCP (0.1 M NaCl, 0.03 M Na 2 HPO 4 .7H 2 O, 0.001 M Na 2 EDTA), 1 % sarkosyl (n-lauroylsarcosine) and exposed to X-ray film.
  • 1X SCP 0.1 M NaCl, 0.03 M Na 2 HPO 4 .7H 2 O, 0.001 M Na 2 EDTA
  • 1 sarkosyl n-lauroylsarcosine
  • the example describes the preparation of a fusion protein of the prostate-specific antigen P703P and a truncated form of the known prostate antigen PSA.
  • the truncated form of PSA has a 21 amino acid deletion around the active serine site.
  • the expression construct for the fusion protein also has a restriction site at 3' end, immediately prior to the termination codon, to aid in adding cDNA for additional antigens.
  • the full-length cDNA for PSA was obtained by RT-PCR from a pool of RNA from human prostate tumor tissues using the primers of SEQ ID NO: 607 and 608, and cloned in the vector pCR-Blunt II-TOPO.
  • the resulting cDNA was employed as a template to make two different fragments of PSA by PCR with two sets of primers (SEQ ID NO: 609 and 610; and SEQ ID NO: 611 and 612).
  • the PCR products having the expected size were used as templates to make truncated forms of PSA by PCR with the primers of SEQ ID NO: 611 and 613, which generated PSA (delta 208-218 in amino acids).
  • the cDNA for the mature form of P703P with a 6X histidine tag at the 5' end was prepared by PCR with P703P and the primers of SEQ ID NO: 614 and 615.
  • the cDNA for the fusion of P703P with the truncated form of PSA (referred to as FOPP) was then obtained by PCR using the modified P703P cDNA and the truncated form of PSA cDNA as templates and the primers of SEQ ID NO: 614 and 615.
  • the FOPP cDNA was cloned into the Ndel site and Xhol site of the expression vector pCRX1, and confirmed by DNA sequencing.
  • the determined cDNA sequence for the fusion construct FOPP is provided in SEQ ID NO: 616, with the amino acid sequence being provided in SEQ ID NO: 617.
  • the fusion FOPP was expressed as a single recombinant protein in E. coli as follows.
  • the expression plasmid pCRX1 FOPP was transformed into the E . coli strain BL21-CodonPlus RIL.
  • the transformant was shown to express FOPP protein upon induction with 1 mM IPTG.
  • the culture of the corresponding expression clone was inoculated into 25 ml LB broth containing 50 ug/ml kanamycin and 34 ug/ml chloramphenicol, grown at 37°C to OD600 of about 1, and stored at 4°C overnight.
  • the culture was diluted into 1 liter of TB LB containing 50 ug/ml kanamycin and 34 ug/ml chloramphenicol, and grown at 37°C to OD600 of 0.4. IPTG was added to a final concentration of 1 mM, and the culture was incubated at 30°C for 3 hours.
  • the cells were pelleted by centrifugation at 5,000 RPM for 8 min. To purify the protein, the cell pellet was suspended in 25 ml of 10 mM Tris-Cl pH 8.0, 2mM PMSF, complete protease inhibitor and 15 ug lysozyme.
  • the cells were lysed at 4°C for 30 minutes, sonicated several times and the lysate centrifuged for 30 minutes at 10,000 x g.
  • the precipitate which contained the inclusion body, was washed twice with 10 mM Tris-Cl pH 8.0 and 1% CHAPS.
  • the inclusion body was dissolved in 40 ml of 10 mM Tris-Cl pH 8.0, 100 mM sodium phosphate and 8 M urea.
  • the solution was bound to 8 ml Ni-NTA (Qiagen) for one hour at room temperature.
  • the mixture was poured into a 25 ml column and washed with 50 ml of 10 mM Tris-Cl pH 6.3, 100 mM sodium phosphate, 0.5% DOC and 8M urea.
  • the bound protein was eluted with 350 mM imidazole, 10 mM Tris-Cl pH 8.0, 100 mM sodium phosphate and 8 M urea.
  • the fractions containing FOPP proteins were combined and dialyzed extensively against 10 mM Tris-CI pH 4.6, aliquoted and stored at - 70°C.
  • Circulating epithelial cells were isolated from fresh blood of normal individuals and metastatic prostate cancer patients, mRNA isolated and cDNA prepared using real-time PCR procedures. Real-time PCR was performed with the Taqman TM procedure using both gene specific primers and probes to determine the levels of gene expression.
  • Epithelial cells were enriched from blood samples using an immunomagnetic bead separation method (Dynal A.S., Oslo, Norway). Isolated cells were lysed and the magnetic beads removed. The lysate was then processed for poly A+ mRNA isolation using magnetic beads coated with Oligo(dT)25. After washing the beads in buffer, bead/poly A+ RNA samples were suspended in 10 mM Tris HCl pH 8.0 and subjected to reversed transcription. The resulting cDNA was subjected to real-time PCR using gene specific primers. Beta-actin content was also determined and used for normalization. Samples with P501 S copies greater than the mean of the normal samples + 3 standard deviations were considered positive.
  • the continued presence of the antigens in tumors during androgen ablation therapy is important.
  • the presence of the prostate-specific antigens P703P and P501S in prostate tumor samples grown in SCID mice in the presence of testosterone was evaluated as follows.
  • Two prostate tumors that had metastasized to the bone were removed from patients, implanted into SCID mice and grown in the presence of testosterone. Tumors were evaluated for mRNA expression of P703P, P501S and PSA using quantitative real time PCR with the SYBR green assay method. Expression of P703P and P501 S in a prostate tumor was used as a positive control and the absence in normal intestine and normal heart as negative controls. In both cases, the specific mRNA was present in late passage tumors. Since the bone metastases were grown in the presence of testosterone, this implies that the presence of these genes would not be lost during androgen ablation therapy.
  • the ability of the anti-P503S monoclonal antibody 20D4 to suppress tumor formation in mice was examined as follows.
  • mice Ten SCID mice were injected subcutaneously with HEK293 cells that expressed P503S.
  • day 0 time of tumor cell injection
  • day 5 day 9
  • Tumor size was measured for 50 days.
  • no 20D4 three formed detectable tumors after about 2 weeks which continued to enlarge throughout the study.
  • none of the five mice that received 20D4 formed tumors.
  • T cells have a limited lifespan.
  • cloning of T cell receptor (TCR) chains and subsequent transfer essentially enables infinite propagation of the T cell specificity.
  • Cloning of tumor-antigen TCR chains allows the transfer of the specificity into T cells isolated from patients that share the TCR MHC-restricting allele. Such T cells could then be expanded and used in adoptive transfer settings to introduce the tumor antigen specificity into patients carrying tumors that express the antigen.
  • T cell receptor alpha and beta chains from a CD8 T cell clone specific for the prostate-specific antigen P501 S were isolated and sequenced as follows.
  • Total mRNA from 2 x 10 6 cells from CTL clone 4E5 (described above in Example 12) was isolated using Trizol reagent and cDNA was synthesized.
  • a panel of Va and Vb subtype-specific primers was synthesized and used in RT-PCR reactions with cDNA generated from each of the clones.
  • the RT-PCR reactions demonstrated that each of the clones expressed a common Vb sequence that corresponded to the Vb7 subfamily.
  • the Va sequence expressed was determined to be Va6.
  • primers were designed that spanned the initiator and terminator-coding TCR nucleotides.
  • the primers were as follows: TCR Valpha-6 5'(sense): GGATCC---GCCGCCACC-ATGTCACTTTCTAGCCTGCT (SEQ ID NO: 899) BamHI site Kozak TCR alpha sequence TCR alpha 3' (antisense): GTCGAC-TCAGCTGGACCACAGCCGCAG (SEQ ID NO: 900) Sall site TCR alpha constant sequence TCR Vbeta-7.
  • the resultant specific bands (approx. 850 bp for alpha and approx. 950 for beta) were ligated into the PCR blunt vector (Invitrogen) and transformed into E. coli.
  • E .coli transformed with plasmids containing full-length alpha and beta chains were identified, and large scale preparations of the corresponding plasmids were generated.
  • Plasmids containing full-length TCR alpha and beta chains were submitted for sequencing.
  • the sequencing reactions demonstrated the cloning of full-length TCR alpha and beta chains with the determined cDNA sequences for the Vb and Va chains being shown in SEQ ID NO: 903 and 904, respectively.
  • the corresponding amino acid sequences are shown in SEQ ID NO: 905 and 906, respectively.
  • the Va sequence was shown by nucleotide sequence alignment to be 99% identical (347/348) to Va6.2, and the Vb to be 99% identical to Vb7 (336/338).
  • P503S is found on the surface of prostate cells. Secondary coated microsphere beads specific for mouse IgG were coupled with the purified P503S-specific monoclonal antibody 1 D12. The bound P503S antibody was then used to capture HEK cells expressing recombinant P503S. This provides a model system for prostate-specific cell capture which may be usefully employed in the detection of prostate cells in blood, and therefore in the detection of prostate cancer.
  • P503S-transfected HEK cells were harvested and redissolved in wash buffer (PBS, 0.1% BSA, 0.6% sodium citrate) at an appropriate volume to give at least 5 4 cells per sample. Round bottom Eppendorf tubes were used for all procedures involving beads. The stock concentrations were as shown below in Table IX. TABLE IX Stock concentrations Sample concentration Amount needed Epithelial enrich beads 4 beads/ml (Dynal Biotech Inc.
  • Blocked immunomagnetic beads were pre-washed as follows: all beads needed were pooled and washed once with 1 ml wash buffer. The beads were resuspended in a 3X volume of 1% BSA (v/v) in wash buffer and incubated for 15 min rotating at 4°C. The beads were then washed three times with 2X volume of wash buffer and resuspended to original volume. Non-blocked beads were pooled, washed three times with 2X volume of wash buffer and resuspended to original volume.
  • Epithelial cell enrichment was placed in a magnet and supernant was removed.
  • the epithelial enrichment beads were then resuspended in 100 ul lysis/binding buffer fortified with Rnasin (2 U/ul per sample), and stored at - 70°C until use.
  • Oligo (dT 25 ) Dynabeads were pre-washed as follows: all beads needed were pooled (23 ul/sample), washed three times with an excess volume of lysis/binding buffer, and resuspended to original volume. The lysis supernant was separated with a magnet and transferred to a fresh Eppendorf. 20 ul oligo(dT25) Dynabeads were added per sample and rolled for 5 min at room temperature. Supernant was separated using a magnet and discarded, leaving the mRNA annealed to the beads. The bead/mRNA complex was washed with buffer and resuspended in cold Tris-HCl.
  • the Tris-HCl supernatant was separated and discarded using MPS.
  • the following was added to give a total volume of 30 ul: 14.25 ul H 2 O; 1.5 ul BSA; 6 ul first strand buffer; 0.75 mL 10 mM dNTP mix; 3 ul Rnasin; 3 ul 0.1M dTT; and 1.5 ul Superscript II.
  • the resulting solution was incubated for 1 hour at 42°C, diluted 1:5 in H2O, heated at 80°C for 2 min to detach cDNA from the beads, and immediately placed on MPS.
  • the supernatant containing cDNA was transferred to a new tube and stored at -20°C.
  • Table X shows the percentage of capture of P503S-transfected HEK cells as determined by RT-PCR. TABLE X % capture P503S-transfected HEK cells % capture LnCAP cells 0.1 ug/ml P503S Mab 36.90 0.00 0.5 ug/ml P503S Mab 67.40 2.93 1 ug/ml P503S Mab 40.22 0.00 5 ug/ml P503S Mab 13.11 0.00 Anti-Mu beads only, non-blocked 1.42 0.00 Anti-Mu beads only, blocked 15.65 20.21 Absolute control, non-capture cells 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00 100.00
  • Each protein immunization was done in four sites: subcutaneously (sq) in both footpads and intramuscularly (im) in the leg. Each immunization was done 3 weeks apart, with sera plus spleen and lymph node (LN) cells being harvested 10 days following the last immunization.
  • sq subcutaneously
  • im intramuscularly
  • LN lymph node
  • T cell proliferation and interferon-gamma assays were performed as follows. 250,000 spleen or 100,000 LN cells were plated in 96 well plates and stimulated with 1-10 ug/ml of antigen. Antigens tested include the five proteins listed above, P703P expressed in baculovirus, NS1 control protein, PSA (for FOPP groups only), and P703P peptide pools. Peptide pools consisted of 20-mer peptides overlapping by 15 amino acids with each pool containing 6-8 peptides. Con A was used as a positive control. Cultures were pulsed with H3-thymidine on day 4 after initiation of culture for assaying proliferation. For assaying IFN ⁇ levels by ELISA, supernatants were also pulled on day 4. In addition, sera were pooled and assayed by ELISA for IgG antibodies against the recombinant proteins listed above.
  • Protein expression of the prostate cancer antigen P703P was analyzed in prostate cancer and normal tissue by IHC analysis using an array of anti-P703P polyclonal and monoclonal antibodies (see Table XII). P703P protein expression was also analyzed in HEK293/P703P transfectants by flow cytometry and by Western blot analysis using the same anti-P703P antibodies. The P703-R087 and P703P-2059 antibodies stained HEK293/P703P transfectants by flow cytometric analysis. P703P-2594 was used for Western blot analysis.
  • IHC immunohistochemistry
  • Tissue samples were fixed in formalin solution for 12-24 hrs and embedded in paraffin before being sliced into 8 micron sections.
  • SHIER Steam heat induced epitope retrieval
  • the avidin biotin complex/horse radish peroxidase (ABC/HRP) system was used along with DAB chromogen to visualize antigen expression. Slides were counterstained with hematoxylin to visualize cell nuclei.
  • whole cell lysates were generated by incubating the cells in Triton-X 100 containing lysis buffer for 30 minutes on ice. Lysates were then cleared by centrifugation at 10,000 rpm for 5 minutes at 4° C. Samples were diluted with SDS-PAGE loading buffer containing beta-mercaptoethanol, then boiled for 10 minutes prior to loading the SDS-PAGE gel.
  • Protein was transferred to nitrocellulose and probed using 1 ug/ml purified anti-P703P rabbit polyclonal sera 2594 (lot # 370-84) or rabbit monoclonal P703P-R087. Blots were revealed using goat anti-rabbit lg coupled to HRP followed by incubation in ECL substrate. For FACS analysis, single cell suspensions of P703P/HEK293 transfectants were generated and cells were incubated in permeabilization buffer (PBS+ saponin + BSA) at room temp. The cells were then incubated for 30 minutes with 10ug/ml of purified anti-P703P polyclonal sera or monoclonal antibodies.
  • permeabilization buffer PBS+ saponin + BSA
  • Optimal IHC results were obtained using the heat retrieval and affinity purified AP-P703P-9245 antibody against full-length P703.
  • IHC analysis using the above procedures with this antibody showed weak staining in 6/23 metastatic prostate cancer sections. 24/33 primary prostate cancer sections stained positive with this antibody. Additionally, staining was observed in malignant ducts, benign (normal ducts) in various prostate tumors, basal, myoepithelial cells in various prostate tumors, mast cells, and in association with lipofuchsin granules.
  • P501S also referred to herein as L1-12, e.g., SEQ ID NO: 110
  • P703P e.g., SEQ ID NO:524
  • P503S also referred to herein as N1-1862, e.g., SEQ ID NO:111
  • P504S also referred to herein as FI-12, e.g., SEQ ID NO:107
  • P510S e.g., SEQ ID NO:535 and 536
  • P1020C also referred to as 22553, e.g., SEQ ID NO:591
  • DC Dendritic cells
  • CD4 T cells were generated from the same donor as the DC using MACS beads and negative selection.
  • DC were pulsed overnight with pools containing 10 of the 15 mer peptides, with each peptide at 0.25 microgram/ml final concentration. Pulsed DC were washed and plated at 1x10e4 cells /well of 96-well round bottom plates, and purified CD4 T cells were added at 1x10e5/well.
  • Cultures were supplemented with 60 ng/ml IL-6 and 10 ng/ml IL-12 and incubated at 37°C. Cultures were re-stimulated as above on a weekly basis and were tested for specific proliferation using as APC, DC generated and pulsed as above, supplemented with 5 ng/ml IL-7 and 10 u/ml IL-2. Following 5 in-vitro stimulation cycles, lines (each line corresponds to one well) were assayed for proliferation and cytokine production in response to the stimulating pools vs an irrelevant pool of peptides derived from the P703P sequence.
  • the peptide corresponds to amino acids 145-159 of the P703P protein sequence of SEQ ID NO: 525, and has the sequence GNSCLVSGWGLLANG (SEQ ID NO:992).
  • the cDNA sequence encoding this epitope is set forth in SEQ ID NO:991.
  • Example 1 Related clones were identified above in Example 1 (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 46, 212, 213, 214, 215, 288 and 415) as having prostate-specific expression patterns. Upon further analysis, an extended sequence for these clones was identified as follows. Sequence specific primers were used to amplify products from a prostate tumor library, resulting in the identification of clones 8B6-P3 (SEQ ID NO: 993) and 8B6-P4 (SEQ ID NO: 994). Both clones were transformed into appropriate cells, isolated, sequenced, and the resulting sequences were used as queries to search against the Genbank sequence database.
  • SEQ ID NO: 146 also referred to as P219.
  • P219 The identification of SEQ ID NO: 146, also referred to as P219, was described above.
  • This example describes the identification of an extended sequence for this clone, as well as the bioinformatic identification of the full length cDNA and protein sequences containing the same.
  • Full length laboratory cloning efforts were initiated with an EST search and alignment.
  • the sequence identified by this approach was confirmed with a 5' RACE assay (Clonetech; see also Chenchik et al., 1995, 1996) in which a library of adaptor ligated prostate tumor cDNAs are used as a template to amplify the desired 5' end of a gene using the 5' adaptor primer and a gene specific 3' primer.
  • Additional sequence was identified using a nucleic acid-based screen in which a phagemid prostate tumor library was screened by growing plaques, transferring and immobilizing DNA onto nylon filters, and hybridizing with a radioactive gene-specific probe. The filters were then exposed to film and plaques corresponding to radioactively exposed positive hits were picked and prepped for DNA isolation.
  • the DNA sequence identified using the above approach both confirmed the original clone sequence and further yielded additional 5' sequence.
  • This extended cDNA sequence also referred to as P713P, is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 998.
  • P713P corresponds to a protein referred to as Prostatic Secretory Protein (PSP), the full length cDNA sequence of which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 999, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1000.
  • PSP Prostatic Secretory Protein
  • the filters were blocked in PBS 1% tween, and then incubated with the patient sera for 12 hours at 4 degrees Celsius.
  • the washed filters were incubated in I-125 conjugated protein A for 1 hour at room temperature, washed again and exposed to film overnight. Exposed spots on the film indicating expressed protein recognized by the autologous sera were picked, purified, the plasmid excised, and prepped for DNA isolation and subsequent sequencing. This procedure resulted in the identification of clone PT44A22.
  • Primers were designed from the PT44A22 sequence in order to further screen the same expression library.
  • PCR amplification of the original PT4A22 DNA fragment was performed in the presence of radioactive nucleotides.
  • the probe was incubated with nylon filters onto which the DNA of 10000-15000 clones of the expression library were immobilized. After a few hours of hybridization at 65 degrees in Church's hybridization buffer, the filters were washed in a solution of 1XSCP, 1% sarkosyl. Film was exposed to the washed filters overnight and positive signals were used to pick the appropriate colonies.
  • P510S protein expression was detected in 31/32 primary prostate tumor samples and in 8/17 bone metastasis samples. Some expression was also detected in 4/5 normal prostate samples and 3/5 testis samples. No expression was detected in thyroid, spleen, uterus, ovary, pancreas, lung, liver, kidney, heart, stomach, large intestine, small intestine, brain and adrenal gland.
  • This example evaluates the immunoreactivity of P504 is in normal colon and invasive colon carcinomas, and also evaluates the correlation between P504 expression and tumor grade, stage, and patient survival.
  • Invasive carcinomas were from 18 males and 26 females, ages 45-87, from right colon (23), transverse (6), left (14), and unknown (1).
  • Tumor stage was I(4), II (17), III (18), and IV (5).
  • Tumor grade was Grade 1 (23), 2 (9), and 3 (12).
  • Remnant polyp was present in 7 carcinomas. Immunostaining for p504S was weakly positive in surface epithelium of normal colon. In carcinomas, P504 was graded 0 (16), 1+ (6), 2+ (8), and 3+ (14). There was no difference between superficial and deep regions of the tumors. Remnant polyp was 2+ or 3+ in 4 cases, 0 in 3 cases.
  • P504S was highly expressed in adenomas and well-differentiated colon carcinomas, and weak or absent in normal colon mucosa and poorly differentiated carcinomas. P504S expression correlated inversely with patient survival. In view of these results, immunostaining for P504S represents a useful adjunct with prognostic significance in the diagnostic evaluation of colon carcinomas.
  • Atypical Adenomatous Hyperplasia also known as adenosis, is characterized by the abnormal architectural patterns but without significant cytologic atypia in prostatic glandular epithelium.
  • AAH may represent a precursor lesion of prostatic adenocarcinoma.
  • P504S has been found to be highly expressed in prostatic adenocarcinoma, but not in benign prostatic epithelium. In this example, the expression of P504S was evaluated in AAH.
  • P504S showed strong cytoplasmic granular staining in all (10 of 10) low-grade carcinomas and in 4 of 26 cases of AAH (15 %). No BPHs or benign glands adjacent to carcinomas and AAH were positive for P504S. Diffuse P504S staining pattern was found in low-grade carcinomas, while focal P504s positivity was seen in AAH.
  • AAH is a lesion different from low-grade cancer or BPH, at least with respect to P504S expression.
  • AAH may be considered as a premalignant or potentially premalignant lesion.
  • PC minimal prostatic cancer
  • P504S immunopositivity was found in 51/52 cases (98%) of minimal PC but not in any benign prostates (0/58) or benign glands adjacent to malignant glands. Atrophy, basal cell hyperplasia and transitional cell metaplasia were all negative for P504S. The only case of PC with negative staining of P504S showed features of foamy carcinoma in a biopsy obtained from the transition zone. High molecular weight cytokeratin (34 ⁇ E12) immunostaining confirmed the absence of basal cells in the focus of carcinoma in all 52 cases.
  • P504S for detecting limited prostatic adenocarcinoma illustrates its diagnostic value in a clinical setting.
  • Using P504S as a immunohistochemical marker can thus increase the accuracy in pathology diagnosis of minimal prostatic adenocarcinoma on needle biopsy.
  • IHC immunohistochemistry
  • Tissue samples were fixed in formalin solution for 12-24 hours and embedded in paraffin before being sliced into 8 micron sections.
  • SHIER Steam heat induced epitope retrieval
  • the avidin biotin complex/horse radish peroxidase (ABC/HRP) system was used along with DAB chromogen to visualize antigen expression. Slides were counterstained with hematoxylin to visualize cell nuclei. Using this approach, P767S protein expression was detected in 7/7 prostate cancers, 5/5 normal prostates, 1/1 normal kidney, 1/1 cerebellum, 0/1 normal liver, 0/1 normal heart, 1/1 normal lung, 1/1 normal colon, 1/1 normal tonsil, and 1/1 normal cortex.
  • prostate sequence P510S has been identified above (e.g., Example 1). Plasmid DNA containing P510S was used as template in a PCR reaction to amplify the open reading frame of P510S using P510S-AW186 sense primers with Hind III sites and a Kozak sequence, and P510S-AW187 antisense primers with Nhe I sites and a stop codon. PCR product was purified from agarose gel, digested with Hind III and Nhe I, and ligated to JA4304 vector that had been linearized with the same two restriction enzymes. The ligation mixture was transformed into E. coli and several clones were randomly selected for restriction enzyme analysis and DNA sequencing. P510S/JA4304#2 and # 3 clones were confirmed to have the desired P510S sequence. The determined DNA sequence for this construct is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1006, encoding the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 1009.
  • pCRX4 is a MAPS fusion vector based on JA4304 that was made to facilitate the cloning of MAPS fusion constructs.
  • MAPS was cloned down stream of Kozak sequence and was followed by a multiple cloning site.
  • a PCR reaction was used to amplify the P510S coding region using MAPS-P510S-AW184 sense primers with EcoR I sites, and P510S-AW185 antisense primers for MAPS-P510S with Kpn I sites and a stop codon.
  • PCR product was purified from agarose gel, digested with EcoR I and Kpn I, and ligated to pCRX4 vector that had been linearized with the same two restriction enzymes.
  • the ligation mixture was transformed into E. coli and several clones were randomly selected for restriction enzyme analysis and DNA sequencing. MAPS-P510S/pCRX4 #1 and #3 clones were confirmed.
  • the determined DNA sequence for this construct is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1007, encoding the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 1008.
  • prostate specific antigens P501 S and P703P are described above, illustrative forms of which are set forth in SEQ ID NO: 113 (encoded by SEQ ID NO: 110) and SEQ ID NO: 525 (encoded by SEQ ID NO: 524), respectively.
  • SEQ ID NO: 113 encoded by SEQ ID NO: 110
  • SEQ ID NO: 525 encoded by SEQ ID NO: 524
  • This example describes the detection of antibodies specific for these proteins in the sera of prostate cancer patients. Effective protein-based screening for prostate antigen-specific antibodies in patient sera has been problematic due to protein instability and/or contamination of small amounts of E. coli-derived proteins.
  • the carboxyamidation of recombinant P501 S and P703P has provided improved stability for these proteins, as confirmed by SDS-PAGE.
  • carboxyamidated P501 S and P703P proteins were used to screen for P501 Sand P703P-specific antibodies in the sera of 55 prostate cancer patients and 13 normal male donors, as follows.
  • TMB-substrate solution After washing at least 6 times with 0.05% Tween-containing PBS and once with PBS, 80-100 ul of the TMB-substrate solution was added and incubated at room temperature. After obtaining suitable colors on the standard of IgG between 10-30 min, 40-50 ul (a half volume of substrate) of 0.1 N sulfuric acid solution was added to stop the enzyme reaction. Absorbances were then determined with a microplate reader (Biotec Instruments).
  • P501 S-specific antibodies were detected in 32/55 prostate cancer patients and 5/13 normal donors.
  • P703-specific antibodies were detected in 24/55 prostate cancer patients and 0/13 normal donors.
  • P711 P (SEQ ID NO: 382, encoding the protein of SEQ ID NO: 383) is described above (e.g., Example 3).
  • E. coli expressing recombinant P711 P protein were grown overnight in LB Broth with the appropriate antibiotics at 37°C in a shaking incubator. The next morning, 10 ml of the overnight culture was added to 500 ml of 2x YT plus appropriate antibiotics in a 2L-baffled Erlenmeyer flask. When the optical density (at 560 nanometers) of the culture reached 0.4-0.6, the cells were induced with IPTG (1 mM).
  • the pellet was resuspended in 10 mM Tris pH 8.0, 1% CHAPS and the inclusion body pellet was washed and centrifuged again. This procedure was repeated twice more.
  • the washed inclusion body pellet was solubilized with either 8 M urea or 6 M guanidine HCI containing 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 plus 10 mM imidazole.
  • the solubilized protein was added to 5 ml of nickel-chelate resin (Qiagen) and incubated for 45 minutes to 1 hour at room temperature with continuous agitation. After incubation, the resin and protein mixture were poured through a disposable column and the flow through was collected.
  • the column was then washed with 10-20 column volumes of the solubilization buffer.
  • the antigen was then eluted from the column using 8M urea, 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 and 300 mM imidazole and collected in 3 ml fractions. A SDS-PAGE gel was run to determine which fractions to pool for further purification.
  • a strong anion exchange resin e.g., Hi-Prep Q (Biorad) was equilibrated with the appropriate buffer and the pooled fractions from above were loaded onto the column. Each antigen was eluted off of the column with an increasing salt gradient. Fractions were collected as the column was run and another SDS-PAGE gel was run to determine which fractions from the column to pool. The pooled fractions were dialyzed against 10 mM Tris pH 8.0. This material was then evaluated for purity as determined by SDS-PAGE or HPLC, concentration as determined by Lowry assay or amino acid analysis, identity as determined by amino terminal protein sequence, and endotoxin level was determined by the Limulus (LAL) assay. The proteins were then vialed after filtration through a 0.22-micron filter and the antigens were frozen until needed for immunization.
  • Hi-Prep Q Biorad
  • mice were immunized intraperitoneally (IP) with 50 micrograms of recombinant P711P protein that had been mixed to form an emulsion with an equal volume of Complete Freund's Adjuvant (CFA). Every three weeks animals were injected i.p. with 50 micrograms of recombinant P711P protein that had been mixed with an equal volume of IFA to form an emulsion. After the fourth injection, spleens were isolated and standard hybridoma fusion procedures were used to generate anti-P711P mouse monoclonal antibodies.
  • IP Intradi.p. with 50 micrograms of recombinant P711P protein that had been mixed to form an emulsion with an equal volume of IFA to form an emulsion.
  • IFA Complete Freund's Adjuvant
  • Anti-P711 P monoclonal antibodies were screened by ELISA analysis using the bacterially expressed recombinant P711 P protein.
  • 96 well plates were coated with P711 P antigen by incubating with 50 microliters (typically about 1 microgram) at 4 degrees C for 20 hours. 250 microliters of BSA blocking buffer was added to the wells and incubated at room temperature for 2 hours. Plates were washed 6 times with PBS/0.01 % TWEEN. Fifty microliters of each undiluted monoclonal supernatant were added per well and incubated at room temperature for 30 minutes.
  • Protein was transferred to nitrocellulose and probed with each of the anti-P711 P hybridoma supernatants.
  • Anti-mouse-HRP was used to visualize the anti-P711P reactive bands by incubation in ECL substrate.
  • at least seven anti-P711 P monoclonal antibodies were generated and demonstrated to be reactive with recombinant P711 protein by ELISA and/or Western analysis.
  • prostate specific antigen P501S has been described above, a representative full length DNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 110, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • CTL specific for a peptide of P501 S (peptide 370-378, amino acid sequence CLSHSVAVV) were previously demonstrated to recognize naturally processed P501 S as demonstrated by recognition of P501 S transduced target cells.
  • mice were immunized with P501S DNA followed by a second immunization using a P501 S-containing adenovirus delivery vector 14 days later. On day 35, spleen cells were harvested and stimulated in vitro weekly using irradiated Jurkat A2kb-P501 cells.
  • CTL lines were assayed for lytic activity against parental Jurkat A2Kb cells, Jurkat A2Kb cells transduced with P501 S, Jurkat A2Kb cells pulsed with p370-378, or Jurkat A2KbT cells pulsed with the carboxy amidated p370-378 peptide.
  • p370-378 specific T cells not only recognize the synthetic unmodified 370-378 peptide, but also recognize a carbamidomethylated form of 370-378.
  • prostate specific antigen P501S has been described above, a representative full length DNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 110, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • illustrative P501S fusion constructs were made and the encoded fusion proteins produced.
  • the C-terminal truncated region of P501S was PCR amplified using the following conditions: 10 ⁇ l 10X Pfu buffer 1 ⁇ l 10mM dNTPs 2 ⁇ l 10 ⁇ M each oligo 83 ⁇ l sterile water 1.5 ⁇ l Pfu DNA polymerase (Stratagene, La Jolla, CA) 50 ⁇ g DNA 96°C 2 minutes 96°C 30 seconds 72°C 1 minute 30 seconds X 40 cycles 72°C 4 minutes
  • the resulting PCR product was digested with Ncol and NotI and cloned into the commercially available vector pET32 (Novagen, Madison Wl) that was also digested with Ncol and Notl.
  • the pET32 vector incorporates an N - terminal fusion with the Trx antigen, which is Thioredoxin, an E. coli protein that can enhance expression for difficult to express antigens, and can further enhance solubility of the resulting fusion protein.
  • the resulting cDNA sequence for the coding region of this Trx-P501 S fusion construct is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1010, encoding the fusion amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 1011.
  • prostate specific antigen P501S has been described above, a representative full length DNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 110, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • This example describes the results of a preclinical in vivo immunogenicity study evaluating vaccination with P501S protein (either unmodified or carboxy amidated), in combination with various adjuvants, compared with DNA/adenovirus P501 S immunization.
  • prostate specific antigen P501 S has been described above, a representative full length DNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 110, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • a naturally processed, murine A2Kb CTL epitope has been identified for P501 S. This epitope was mapped using a series of C-terminal deletion constructs, C-terminal subclones containing the last 92 amino acids of P501 S, and sets of peptides spanning P501 S regions of interest.
  • T cell clones used to map the epitope were derived from limiting dilutions of splenocytes from P501 S DNA immunized and P501 S-adenovirus immunized C57BL/6 A2Kb transgenic mice. Thirty-seven T cell clones were identified as reactive to P501 S-transduced Jurkat A2Kb targets in CTL assays. The lines, however, were not reactive to Jurkat A2Kb cells pulsed with a previously identified naturally processed P501 S epitope corresponding to amino acid residues 370-378 of SEQ ID NO: 113. This observation pointed to the existence of a second epitope other than the 9-mer epitope of amino acid residues 370-378.
  • T cell clones were thus tested with Jurkat A2Kb cells transduced with C-terminal deletion constructs denoted FragA-FragE. None of the T cell clones generated CTL responses to these deletion constructs, indicating that the epitope likely mapped within the C-terminal 92 amino acids of P501 S (461-553). Six T cell clones were demonstrated to be responsive to Jurkat A2Kb clones expressing P501 S amino acid residues 462-553 or 462-517.
  • these transduced targets and Jurkat A2Kb targets pulsed with various 20-mer, 15-mer, 10-mer and 9-mer peptides, allowed for the identification of a naturally processed epitope for P501S, having the sequence SACDVSVRV, and corresponding to amino acid residues 464-472 of SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • prostate antigen P790P has been described above, the full length cDNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 526, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 527.
  • P790P was subcloned into pCEP4 and VR1013 (a polylinker modified VR1012 vector) mammalian expression vectors.
  • the constructs were transfected into HEK293 cells (ATCC) using Lipofectamine 2000 (Gibco).
  • the HEK293 cells were plated in a 6 well dish at a density of 300,000 cells/ml in DMEM (Gibco) containing 10% FBS (Hyclone) and allowed to incubate for 6-8 hours.
  • DMEM Gibco
  • FBS Hyclone
  • One ug of DNA was then added to 100 ul of DMEM containing no FBS and 3 ul of Lipofectamine 2000 was added to 100 ul of DMEM containing no FBS. Both were incubated for 5 minutes at room temperature.
  • the lipofectamine/DMEM mixture was added to the DNA/DMEM mixture and incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature.
  • the lipofectamine 2000/DNA mix was then added to the HEK293 cells and incubated for 48-72 hrs at 37 degrees C with 7% CO2. Cells were collected and pelleted by centrifugation and washed twice with PBS.
  • AAH atypical adenomatous hyperplasia
  • AAH of the prostate also known as adenosis, is characterized by abnormal architectural patterns, but without significant cytologic atypia, in prostatic glandular epithelium. It is often difficult to distinguish AAH from prostatic carcinoma.
  • AAH is a precursor lesion of theprotatic adenocarcinoma.
  • P504S (the DNA and amino acid sequences for which were disclosed in SEQ ID NOs: 107 and 108), is a protein that we have previously shown to be highly over-expressed in prostatice adenocarcinoma, and therefore represents an excellent marker for prostate cancer.
  • the 34 ⁇ E12 stain confirmed the presence of patchy basal cells in all 40 cases of AAH.
  • P504S staining showed strong cytoplasmic granular staining in 20/20 prostatic carcinomas and in 6 of 40 cases of AAH (15%).
  • No BPH or benign prostate glands adjacent to carcinomas or adjacent to AAH were positive for P504S.
  • a diffuse staining pattern of P504S was found in prostate carcinoma samples, while focal positivity was seen in the positive cases of AAH.
  • prostate specific antigen P703P has been described above, one representative DNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 171, encoding an amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 172.
  • an illustrative P703P fusion construct was made and the encoded fusion protein produced.
  • This recombinant fusion protein can be used, for example, in diagnostic methods for the detection of prostate cancer and/or to elicit an immune response in a subject for the prevention and/or treatment of prostate cancer.
  • hPAPF1 5'CGGCGGATCCGCCGCCACCATGAGAGCTGCACCCCTCCTCCT-3' (SEQ ID NO: 1014) and hPAPRV1 5'CGGCCTCGAGCTAATCTGTACTGTCTTCAGTACCTTGATGGCTG-3' (SEQ ID NO: 1015).
  • PCR product was then cloned into the PCR BluntII TOPO vector.
  • PCR BluntII TOPO vector.
  • a second PCR was performed with primers FOPP2F1 5'GAGAAAACCGTCCAGGCCAGTAAGGAGTTGAAGTTTGTGACTTTGGTG-3' (SEQ ID NO: 1016) and HPAPRV1 (SEQ ID NO: 1015), using hPAP/TOPO BluntII as a template.
  • FOPP/PCRX1 (P703P containing DNA) was also modified using primers FOPPF1 5'CGGCGGGCATATGCATCACCATCACCATCACATCATAAACGGCGAGGAC TGCAG-3' (SEQ ID NO: 1017) and FOPP2RV1 5'CACCAAAGTCACAAACTTCAACTCCTTACTGGCCTGGACGGTTTTCTC-3' (SEQ ID NO: 1018).
  • the expression clone culture was inoculated into 20 ml of STB containing 50 ⁇ g/ml kanamycin and 34 ⁇ g/ml chloamphenicol, and grown at 37°C until the OD600 read approximately 1.
  • the culture was then diluted into 1 liter of STB containing 50 ⁇ g/ml kanamycin and 34 ⁇ g/ml chloamphenicol, and grown at 37°C until the OD600 read approximately 0.4.
  • IPTG was then added to a final concentration of 1mM, and the culture was incubated at 37°C for 2 hours.
  • the cells were centrifuged at 5000 RPM for 8 minutes, washed in PBS, re-centrifuged, and stored at -70°C.
  • the cell pellet was re-suspended in 25 ml of 10mM Tris-Cl (pH 8.0) containing 2 mM PMSF and protease inhibitors.
  • the cells were sonicated several times and the lysate was centrifuged for 60 minutes at 4000 RPM.
  • the precipitate, containing the inclusion bodies was washed twice with 10 mM Tris-HCl (pH 8.0) containing 1% CHAPS.
  • the inclusion body was dissolved in 40 ml of binding buffer (10 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0, 100 mM sodium phosphate, and 8M urea).
  • the solution was mixed with 10 ml of Ni-NTA resin (Qiagen) for 30 minutes at room temperature.
  • the mixture was then poured into a 25 ml column, and washed with 50 ml of wash buffer (10mM Tris-Cl pH 6.3, 100 mM sodium phosphate, 0.5% DOC and 8M urea).
  • wash buffer 10mM Tris-Cl pH 6.3, 100 mM sodium phosphate, 0.5% DOC and 8M urea.
  • the bound protein was then eluted using elution buffer (10 mM Tris-Cl, pH 8.0, 350 mM Imidazole, 100 mM sodiumphosphate, and 8M urea).
  • the fractions containing FOPP2 were combined and dialyzed extensively using a large volume of Tris-Cl, pH 8.0, aliquoted, and stored at -70°C.
  • the FOPP2 sequence was confirmed, and the DNA and amino acid sequence disclosed in SEQ ID NOs: 1019 and 1020, respectively.
  • This example describes the recombinant production of P501S polypeptides that are useful, for example, in immunodiagnostic and immunotherapeutic applications.
  • the identification and characterization of prostate specific antigen P501 S has been described above, a representative full length DNA sequence for which is set forth in SEQ ID NO: 110, encoding the amino acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 113.
  • This example describes the expression of recombinant P501S C (corresponding to amino acids 257-553) and P501S D (corresponding to amino acids 316-553) antigens using an E. coli expression system combined with an N-terminal histadine tag and a TAT (twin arginine translocator) signal peptide fusion.
  • the P501S C coding region was PCR amplified with the following primers:
  • the P501 S D coding region was PCR amplified with the following primers:
  • the PCR was performed with the following reaction components:
  • PCR products were digested with EcoRI and cloned into pPDM and pTAT (pPDM using a TAT signal peptide leader) at the Eco721 and EcoRI. Constructs were confirmed to be correct through sequence analysis and transformed into BLR (DE3) pLys S, HMS 174 (DE3) pLys S, Rosetta (DE3), and Rosetta (DE3) pLys S cells to confirm protein expression.
  • BLR BLR
  • pLys S HMS 174
  • pLys S Rosetta
  • Rosetta Rosetta
  • P501S D-His construct The amino acid sequence for the P501S D-His construct was confirmed, and is disclosed in SEQ ID NO:1028, with the corresponding DNA sequence disclosed in SEQ ID NO:1026.
  • These recombinant P501S polypeptides can be used, for example, in immunodiagnostic and/or immunotherapeutic embodiments, such as those described herein.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Cell Biology (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Mycology (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Developmental Biology & Embryology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Toxicology (AREA)
  • Reproductive Health (AREA)
  • Pregnancy & Childbirth (AREA)
  • Gynecology & Obstetrics (AREA)
  • Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)
  • Micro-Organisms Or Cultivation Processes Thereof (AREA)
  • Measuring Or Testing Involving Enzymes Or Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Medicines Containing Material From Animals Or Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Medicines Containing Antibodies Or Antigens For Use As Internal Diagnostic Agents (AREA)
EP08011769A 2001-05-09 2002-05-09 Zusammensetzungen und Verfahren zur Behandlung und Diagnose von Prostatakrebs Withdrawn EP1988097A1 (de)

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US85291101A 2001-05-09 2001-05-09
US09/895,814 US20020193296A1 (en) 1997-02-25 2001-06-29 Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US10/012,896 US6943236B2 (en) 1997-02-25 2001-12-10 Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
EP02725984A EP1515982A4 (de) 2001-05-09 2002-05-09 Zusammensetzungen und verfahren zur therapie und diagnose von prostatakrebs

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP02725984A Division EP1515982A4 (de) 2001-05-09 2002-05-09 Zusammensetzungen und verfahren zur therapie und diagnose von prostatakrebs

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
EP1988097A1 true EP1988097A1 (de) 2008-11-05

Family

ID=27359724

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP08011769A Withdrawn EP1988097A1 (de) 2001-05-09 2002-05-09 Zusammensetzungen und Verfahren zur Behandlung und Diagnose von Prostatakrebs
EP02725984A Withdrawn EP1515982A4 (de) 2001-05-09 2002-05-09 Zusammensetzungen und verfahren zur therapie und diagnose von prostatakrebs

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP02725984A Withdrawn EP1515982A4 (de) 2001-05-09 2002-05-09 Zusammensetzungen und verfahren zur therapie und diagnose von prostatakrebs

Country Status (4)

Country Link
EP (2) EP1988097A1 (de)
JP (1) JP2005504513A (de)
CA (1) CA2446788A1 (de)
WO (1) WO2002089747A2 (de)

Families Citing this family (83)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6833438B1 (en) 1999-06-01 2004-12-21 Agensys, Inc. Serpentine transmembrane antigens expressed in human cancers and uses thereof
US20030149531A1 (en) 2000-12-06 2003-08-07 Hubert Rene S. Serpentine transmembrane antigens expressed in human cancers and uses thereof
US7037667B1 (en) 1998-06-01 2006-05-02 Agensys, Inc. Tumor antigen useful in diagnosis and therapy of prostate and colon cancer
US7244827B2 (en) 2000-04-12 2007-07-17 Agensys, Inc. Nucleic acid and corresponding protein entitled 24P4C12 useful in treatment and detection of cancer
US7361338B2 (en) 1999-10-05 2008-04-22 Agensys, Inc. Methods to inhibit growth of prostate cancer cells
US6790631B1 (en) 1999-10-05 2004-09-14 Agensys, Inc. G protein-coupled receptor up-regulated in prostate cancer and uses thereof
US7208280B2 (en) 1999-10-05 2007-04-24 Agensys, Inc. Nucleic acid and corresponding protein entitled 101P3A41 useful in treatment and detection of cancer
CA2403909A1 (en) * 2000-03-27 2001-10-04 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
CA2464239C (en) 2001-10-23 2016-07-12 Psma Development Company, L.L.C. Psma antibodies and protein multimers
US20050215472A1 (en) 2001-10-23 2005-09-29 Psma Development Company, Llc PSMA formulations and uses thereof
AU2003243151A1 (en) 2002-08-16 2004-03-03 Agensys, Inc. Nucleic acid and corresponding protein entitled 251p5g2 useful in treatment and detection of cancer
BR122018071808B8 (pt) 2003-11-06 2020-06-30 Seattle Genetics Inc conjugado
EP2286844A3 (de) 2004-06-01 2012-08-22 Genentech, Inc. Antikörper-Arzneimittelkonjugate und Verfahren
US20100111856A1 (en) 2004-09-23 2010-05-06 Herman Gill Zirconium-radiolabeled, cysteine engineered antibody conjugates
NZ553500A (en) 2004-09-23 2009-11-27 Genentech Inc Genentech Inc Cysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates withCysteine engineered antibodies and conjugates with a free cysteine amino acid in the heavy chain a free cysteine amino acid in the heavy chain
EP1916298B1 (de) * 2005-06-14 2011-12-28 Dnavec Corporation Verfahren zur herstellung von monoklonalen antikörpern
JP5292550B2 (ja) * 2007-03-23 2013-09-18 静岡県 T細胞レセプターβ鎖遺伝子及びα鎖遺伝子
AU2010292172A1 (en) 2009-09-09 2012-05-03 Centrose, Llc Extracellular targeted drug conjugates
JP5972864B2 (ja) 2010-04-15 2016-08-17 メディミューン リミテッド ピロロベンゾジアゼピン及びそれらのコンジュゲート
EP2579897A1 (de) 2010-06-08 2013-04-17 Genentech, Inc. Cystein-manipulierte antikörper und konjugate
EP2640727B1 (de) 2010-11-17 2015-05-13 Genentech, Inc. Alaninylmaytansinol-antikörperkonjugate
MX2013013054A (es) 2011-05-12 2014-02-20 Genentech Inc Metodo de monitoreo de lc-ms/ms de reaccion multiple para detectar anticuerpos terapeuticos en muestras de animales utilizando peptidos de firma de estructura.
KR101877598B1 (ko) 2011-10-14 2018-07-11 메디뮨 리미티드 피롤로벤조디아제핀 및 그의 컨주게이트
WO2013130093A1 (en) 2012-03-02 2013-09-06 Genentech, Inc. Biomarkers for treatment with anti-tubulin chemotherapeutic compounds
EP2906250B1 (de) 2012-10-12 2018-05-30 ADC Therapeutics SA Pyrrolobenzodiazepin-anti-psma-antikörperkonjugate
SI2906251T1 (en) 2012-10-12 2018-01-31 Adc Therapeutics Sa Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-anti-CD22 antibody conjugates
SI2906298T1 (sl) 2012-10-12 2018-12-31 Adc Therapeutics Sa Konjugati pirolobenzodiazepin-protitelo
PT2906296T (pt) 2012-10-12 2018-06-01 Medimmune Ltd Conjugados de pirrolobenzodiazepina-anticorpo
AU2013328580B2 (en) 2012-10-12 2016-01-21 Medimmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
KR101986404B1 (ko) 2012-10-12 2019-06-07 에이디씨 테라퓨틱스 에스에이 피롤로벤조디아제핀-항체 컨주게이트
WO2014057120A1 (en) 2012-10-12 2014-04-17 Adc Therapeutics Sàrl Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates
CN105246894A (zh) 2012-12-21 2016-01-13 斯皮罗根有限公司 用于治疗增殖性和自身免疫疾病的非对称吡咯并苯并二氮杂卓二聚物
EP2935268B2 (de) 2012-12-21 2021-02-17 MedImmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepine und konjugate davon
AU2014230735B2 (en) 2013-03-13 2018-03-15 Medimmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
US9649390B2 (en) 2013-03-13 2017-05-16 Medimmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
NZ710745A (en) 2013-03-13 2019-03-29 Genentech Inc Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
WO2015023355A1 (en) 2013-08-12 2015-02-19 Genentech, Inc. 1-(chloromethyl)-2,3-dihydro-1h-benzo[e]indole dimer antibody-drug conjugate compounds, and methods of use and treatment
EP3054985B1 (de) 2013-10-11 2018-12-26 Medimmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepin-antikörper-konjugate
GB201317982D0 (en) 2013-10-11 2013-11-27 Spirogen Sarl Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
US9956299B2 (en) 2013-10-11 2018-05-01 Medimmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepine—antibody conjugates
WO2015052532A1 (en) 2013-10-11 2015-04-16 Spirogen Sàrl Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates
BR112016013861A2 (pt) 2013-12-16 2017-10-10 Genentech Inc conjugados de droga e anticorpo, compostos, método de tratamento e composição farmacêutica
JP6671292B2 (ja) 2013-12-16 2020-03-25 ジェネンテック, インコーポレイテッド ペプチド模倣化合物及びその抗体−薬物コンジュゲート
BR112016013258A2 (pt) 2013-12-16 2018-01-16 Genentech Inc composto conjugado anticorpo-droga, composição farmacêutica, método para tratar câncer e kit
EP3193940A1 (de) 2014-09-10 2017-07-26 Medimmune Limited Pyrrolobenzodiazepine und konjugate daraus
WO2016040825A1 (en) 2014-09-12 2016-03-17 Genentech, Inc. Anthracycline disulfide intermediates, antibody-drug conjugates and methods
AR101844A1 (es) 2014-09-12 2017-01-18 Genentech Inc Anticuerpos y conjugados modificados genéticamente con cisteína
GB201416112D0 (en) 2014-09-12 2014-10-29 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
CR20170099A (es) 2014-09-17 2017-07-19 Genentech Inc Pirrolobenzodiazepinas y conjugados de anticuerpos-disulfuro de las mismas
CN107148285B (zh) 2014-11-25 2022-01-04 Adc治疗股份有限公司 吡咯并苯并二氮杂䓬-抗体缀合物
CA2969689A1 (en) 2014-12-03 2016-06-09 Genentech, Inc. Quaternary amine compounds and antibody-drug conjugates thereof
GB201506411D0 (en) 2015-04-15 2015-05-27 Bergenbio As Humanized anti-axl antibodies
GB201506402D0 (en) 2015-04-15 2015-05-27 Berkel Patricius H C Van And Howard Philip W Site-specific antibody-drug conjugates
MA43345A (fr) 2015-10-02 2018-08-08 Hoffmann La Roche Conjugués anticorps-médicaments de pyrrolobenzodiazépine et méthodes d'utilisation
MA43354A (fr) 2015-10-16 2018-08-22 Genentech Inc Conjugués médicamenteux à pont disulfure encombré
MA45326A (fr) 2015-10-20 2018-08-29 Genentech Inc Conjugués calichéamicine-anticorps-médicament et procédés d'utilisation
GB201601431D0 (en) 2016-01-26 2016-03-09 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepines
GB201602356D0 (en) 2016-02-10 2016-03-23 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepine Conjugates
GB201602359D0 (en) 2016-02-10 2016-03-23 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepine Conjugates
WO2017165734A1 (en) 2016-03-25 2017-09-28 Genentech, Inc. Multiplexed total antibody and antibody-conjugated drug quantification assay
GB201607478D0 (en) 2016-04-29 2016-06-15 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepine Conjugates
PL3458101T3 (pl) 2016-05-20 2021-05-31 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Koniugaty PROTAC-przeciwciało i sposoby ich stosowania
EP3465221B1 (de) 2016-05-27 2020-07-22 H. Hoffnabb-La Roche Ag Bioanalytisches verfahren zur charakterisierung von ortsspezifischen antikörper-wirkstoff-konjugaten
US10639378B2 (en) 2016-06-06 2020-05-05 Genentech, Inc. Silvestrol antibody-drug conjugates and methods of use
JP7093767B2 (ja) 2016-08-11 2022-06-30 ジェネンテック, インコーポレイテッド ピロロベンゾジアゼピンプロドラッグ及びその抗体コンジュゲート
CN110139674B (zh) 2016-10-05 2023-05-16 豪夫迈·罗氏有限公司 制备抗体药物缀合物的方法
GB201617466D0 (en) 2016-10-14 2016-11-30 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepine conjugates
CA3047683C (en) 2017-02-08 2020-03-10 Adc Therapeutics Sa Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates
GB201702031D0 (en) 2017-02-08 2017-03-22 Medlmmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepine-antibody conjugates
LT3612537T (lt) 2017-04-18 2022-10-10 Medimmune Limited Pirolobenzodiazepino konjugatai
BR112019021880A2 (pt) 2017-04-20 2020-06-02 Adc Therapeutics Sa Terapia de combinação com conjugado anticorpo anti-axl-droga
US11318211B2 (en) 2017-06-14 2022-05-03 Adc Therapeutics Sa Dosage regimes for the administration of an anti-CD19 ADC
LT3668874T (lt) 2017-08-18 2022-03-25 Medimmune Limited Pirolobenzodiazepino konjugatai
RU2020113749A (ru) 2017-09-20 2021-10-20 пиЭйч ФАРМА Ко., ЛТД. Аналоги таиланстатина
GB201803342D0 (en) 2018-03-01 2018-04-18 Medimmune Ltd Methods
GB201806022D0 (en) 2018-04-12 2018-05-30 Medimmune Ltd Pyrrolobenzodiazepines and conjugates thereof
GB201814281D0 (en) 2018-09-03 2018-10-17 Femtogenix Ltd Cytotoxic agents
AU2019365238A1 (en) 2018-10-24 2021-05-13 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Conjugated chemical inducers of degradation and methods of use
CN113227119A (zh) 2018-12-10 2021-08-06 基因泰克公司 用于与含Fc的蛋白质进行位点特异性缀合的光交联肽
GB201901197D0 (en) 2019-01-29 2019-03-20 Femtogenix Ltd G-A Crosslinking cytotoxic agents
AR128330A1 (es) 2022-01-26 2024-04-17 Genentech Inc Inductores químicos de degradación conjugados con anticuerpo y métodos de estos
AR128331A1 (es) 2022-01-26 2024-04-17 Genentech Inc Inductores químicos de degradación conjugados con anticuerpos y métodos de estos
WO2024138128A2 (en) 2022-12-23 2024-06-27 Genentech, Inc. Cereblon degrader conjugates, and uses thereof

Citations (138)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4237224A (en) 1974-11-04 1980-12-02 Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Jr. University Process for producing biologically functional molecular chimeras
US4429008A (en) 1981-12-10 1984-01-31 The Regents Of The University Of California Thiol reactive liposomes
US4436727A (en) 1982-05-26 1984-03-13 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Refined detoxified endotoxin product
US4489710A (en) 1981-06-23 1984-12-25 Xoma Corporation Composition and method for transplantation therapy
US4507234A (en) 1982-12-24 1985-03-26 Teijin Limited Conjugate having cytotoxicity and process for the preparation thereof
US4554101A (en) 1981-01-09 1985-11-19 New York Blood Center, Inc. Identification and preparation of epitopes on antigens and allergens on the basis of hydrophilicity
US4569789A (en) 1984-08-29 1986-02-11 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Acid-cleavable compound, use in protein conjugates and drug delivery systems
US4603112A (en) 1981-12-24 1986-07-29 Health Research, Incorporated Modified vaccinia virus
US4625014A (en) 1984-07-10 1986-11-25 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Cell-delivery agent
US4638045A (en) 1985-02-19 1987-01-20 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Non-peptide polyamino acid bioerodible polymers
US4671958A (en) 1982-03-09 1987-06-09 Cytogen Corporation Antibody conjugates for the delivery of compounds to target sites
US4673562A (en) 1983-08-19 1987-06-16 The Children's Medical Center Corporation Bisamide bisthiol compounds useful for making technetium radiodiagnostic renal agents
US4683202A (en) 1985-03-28 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying nucleic acid sequences
US4683195A (en) 1986-01-30 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or-cloning nucleic acid sequences
US4699784A (en) 1986-02-25 1987-10-13 Center For Molecular Medicine & Immunology Tumoricidal methotrexate-antibody conjugate
WO1987006270A1 (en) 1986-04-16 1987-10-22 The Salk Institute For Biological Studies Replicative rna reporter systems
US4735792A (en) 1987-04-28 1988-04-05 The United States Of America As Represented By The United States Department Of Energy Radioiodinated maleimides and use as agents for radiolabeling antibodies
US4751180A (en) 1985-03-28 1988-06-14 Chiron Corporation Expression using fused genes providing for protein product
GB2200651A (en) 1987-02-07 1988-08-10 Al Sumidaie Ayad Mohamed Khala A method of obtaining a retrovirus-containing fraction from retrovirus-containing cells
US4769330A (en) 1981-12-24 1988-09-06 Health Research, Incorporated Modified vaccinia virus and methods for making and using the same
GB2202328A (en) 1987-03-11 1988-09-21 Orion Yhtymae Oy An improved method for assaying of nucleic acids, a reagent combination and a kit therefore
US4777127A (en) 1985-09-30 1988-10-11 Labsystems Oy Human retrovirus-related products and methods of diagnosing and treating conditions associated with said retrovirus
US4790824A (en) 1987-06-19 1988-12-13 Bioject, Inc. Non-invasive hypodermic injection device
WO1988010315A1 (en) 1987-06-19 1988-12-29 Siska Diagnostics, Inc. Transcription-based nucleic acid amplification/detection systems
US4800159A (en) 1986-02-07 1989-01-24 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or cloning nucleic acid sequences
WO1989001973A2 (en) 1987-09-02 1989-03-09 Applied Biotechnology, Inc. Recombinant pox virus for immunization against tumor-associated antigens
WO1989003429A1 (en) 1987-08-28 1989-04-20 Health Research Inc. Recombinant avipox virus
EP0320308A2 (de) 1987-12-11 1989-06-14 Abbott Laboratories Verfahren zum Nachweis einer gezielten Nukleinsäure-Sequenz
WO1989006280A1 (en) 1988-01-04 1989-07-13 E.I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Multiple stage affinity process for isolation of specific cells from a cell mixture
WO1989006700A1 (en) 1988-01-21 1989-07-27 Genentech, Inc. Amplification and detection of nucleic acid sequences
US4866034A (en) 1982-05-26 1989-09-12 Ribi Immunochem Research Inc. Refined detoxified endotoxin
WO1989009284A1 (en) 1988-03-24 1989-10-05 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Catalytic hybridization systems for the detection of nucleic acid sequences based on their activity as cofactors in catalytic reactions in which a complementary labeled nucleic acid probe is cleaved
US4873088A (en) 1983-09-06 1989-10-10 Liposome Technology, Inc. Liposome drug delivery method and composition
US4877611A (en) 1986-04-15 1989-10-31 Ribi Immunochem Research Inc. Vaccine containing tumor antigens and adjuvants
US4883750A (en) 1984-12-13 1989-11-28 Applied Biosystems, Inc. Detection of specific sequences in nucleic acids
EP0345242A2 (de) 1988-06-03 1989-12-06 Smithkline Biologicals S.A. Expression von retroviralen GAG-Proteinen in eukaryontischen Zellen
US4897268A (en) 1987-08-03 1990-01-30 Southern Research Institute Drug delivery system and method of making the same
US4912094A (en) 1988-06-29 1990-03-27 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Modified lipopolysaccharides and process of preparation
EP0360257A2 (de) 1988-09-20 1990-03-28 The Board Of Regents For Northern Illinois University RNS-Katalysator zur Spaltung von spezifischen RNS-Sequenzen
US4918164A (en) 1987-09-10 1990-04-17 Oncogen Tumor immunotherapy using anti-idiotypic antibodies
US4935233A (en) 1985-12-02 1990-06-19 G. D. Searle And Company Covalently linked polypeptide cell modulators
US4946778A (en) 1987-09-21 1990-08-07 Genex Corporation Single polypeptide chain binding molecules
US4987071A (en) 1986-12-03 1991-01-22 University Patents, Inc. RNA ribozyme polymerases, dephosphorylases, restriction endoribonucleases and methods
WO1991002805A2 (en) 1989-08-18 1991-03-07 Viagene, Inc. Recombinant retroviruses delivering vector constructs to target cells
WO1991003162A1 (en) 1989-08-31 1991-03-21 City Of Hope Chimeric dna-rna catalytic sequences
US5017487A (en) 1985-04-04 1991-05-21 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Vaccinia DNA
WO1991012882A1 (fr) 1990-02-22 1991-09-05 Medgenix Group S.A. Microspheres pour la liberation controlee des substances hydrosolubles et procede de preparation
WO1991016116A1 (en) 1990-04-23 1991-10-31 Cellpro Incorporated Immunoselection device and method
US5064413A (en) 1989-11-09 1991-11-12 Bioject, Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
WO1991018926A1 (en) 1990-05-31 1991-12-12 Arne Forsgren PROTEIN D - AN IgD-BINDING PROTEIN OF HAEMOPHILUS INFLUENZAE
US5075109A (en) 1986-10-24 1991-12-24 Southern Research Institute Method of potentiating an immune response
WO1992001070A1 (en) 1990-07-09 1992-01-23 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, U.S. Department Of Commerce High efficiency packaging of mutant adeno-associated virus using amber suppressions
US5091513A (en) 1987-05-21 1992-02-25 Creative Biomolecules, Inc. Biosynthetic antibody binding sites
WO1992003545A1 (en) 1990-08-15 1992-03-05 Virogenetics Corporation Flavivirus recombinant poxvirus vaccine
WO1992007065A1 (en) 1990-10-12 1992-04-30 MAX-PLANCK-Gesellschaft zur Förderung der Wissenschaften e.V. Modified ribozymes
WO1992007243A1 (en) 1990-10-18 1992-04-30 Cellpro, Incorporated An apparatus and method for separating particles using a pliable vessel
US5132405A (en) 1987-05-21 1992-07-21 Creative Biomolecules, Inc. Biosynthetic antibody binding sites
US5139941A (en) 1985-10-31 1992-08-18 University Of Florida Research Foundation, Inc. AAV transduction vectors
EP0500799A1 (de) 1989-11-16 1992-09-02 Duke University Transformation von tierischen Hautzellen mit hilfe von Partikeln
US5145684A (en) 1991-01-25 1992-09-08 Sterling Drug Inc. Surface modified drug nanoparticles
US5151254A (en) 1989-08-29 1992-09-29 Suzuki Jidosha Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha Exhaust gas cleaning device for internal combustion engine
US5173414A (en) 1990-10-30 1992-12-22 Applied Immune Sciences, Inc. Production of recombinant adeno-associated virus vectors
EP0519596A1 (de) 1991-05-17 1992-12-23 Merck & Co. Inc. Verfahren zur Verringerung der Immunogenität der variabelen Teile von Antikörpern
EP0519463A1 (de) 1991-06-20 1992-12-23 Europäisches Laboratorium Für Molekularbiologie (Embl) Synthetische katalytische Oligonukleotide
WO1993003769A1 (en) 1991-08-20 1993-03-04 THE UNITED STATES OF AMERICA, represented by THE SECRETARY, DEPARTEMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES Adenovirus mediated transfer of genes to the gastrointestinal tract
US5215926A (en) 1988-06-03 1993-06-01 Cellpro, Inc. Procedure for designing efficient affinity cell separation processes
US5219740A (en) 1987-02-13 1993-06-15 Fred Hutchinson Cancer Research Center Retroviral gene transfer into diploid fibroblasts for gene therapy
WO1993015187A1 (en) 1992-01-31 1993-08-05 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Nucleozymes
US5240856A (en) 1991-10-23 1993-08-31 Cellpro Incorporated Apparatus for cell separation
WO1993023569A1 (en) 1992-05-11 1993-11-25 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method and reagent for inhibiting viral replication
WO1994000153A1 (en) 1992-06-25 1994-01-06 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals (S.A.) Vaccine composition containing adjuvants
WO1994002595A1 (en) 1992-07-17 1994-02-03 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method and reagent for treatment of animal diseases
US5312335A (en) 1989-11-09 1994-05-17 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
WO1994013688A1 (en) 1992-12-08 1994-06-23 Gene Shears Pty. Limited Dna-armed ribozymes and minizymes
WO1994020078A1 (fr) 1993-03-02 1994-09-15 Biovector Therapeutics Sa Vecteurs particulaires synthetiques et procede de preparation
US5359681A (en) 1993-01-11 1994-10-25 University Of Washington Fiber optic sensor and methods and apparatus relating thereto
WO1994023701A1 (fr) 1993-04-21 1994-10-27 Institut Pasteur Vecteur particulaire et composition pharmaceutique le contenant
US5383851A (en) 1992-07-24 1995-01-24 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5399363A (en) 1991-01-25 1995-03-21 Eastman Kodak Company Surface modified anticancer nanoparticles
US5407609A (en) 1989-05-04 1995-04-18 Southern Research Institute Microencapsulation process and products therefrom
WO1995017210A1 (en) 1993-12-23 1995-06-29 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals (S.A.) Vaccines
US5466468A (en) 1990-04-03 1995-11-14 Ciba-Geigy Corporation Parenterally administrable liposome formulation comprising synthetic lipids
WO1996002555A1 (en) 1994-07-15 1996-02-01 The University Of Iowa Research Foundation Immunomodulatory oligonucleotides
WO1996006638A1 (fr) 1994-08-31 1996-03-07 Biovector Therapeutics S.A. Procede pour augmenter l'immunogenicite, produit obtenu et composition pharmaceutique
US5505947A (en) 1994-05-27 1996-04-09 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Attenuating mutations in Venezuelan Equine Encephalitis virus
US5543158A (en) 1993-07-23 1996-08-06 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Biodegradable injectable nanoparticles
US5552157A (en) 1990-08-27 1996-09-03 Kabushiki Kaisha Vitamin Kenkyusya Liposome for entrapping gene, liposomal preparation and process for the manufacture of the preparation
US5565213A (en) 1990-07-26 1996-10-15 Taisho Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Stable liposome aqueous suspension
US5567434A (en) 1989-03-31 1996-10-22 The Regents Of The University Of California Preparation of liposome and lipid complex compositions
WO1996033739A1 (en) 1995-04-25 1996-10-31 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals S.A. Vaccines containing a saponin and a sterol
US5580579A (en) 1995-02-15 1996-12-03 Nano Systems L.L.C. Site-specific adhesion within the GI tract using nanoparticles stabilized by high molecular weight, linear poly (ethylene oxide) polymers
WO1996038591A1 (en) 1995-06-02 1996-12-05 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. IMPROVED METHOD FOR OBTAINING FULL-LENGTH cDNA SEQUENCES
US5584807A (en) 1994-01-21 1996-12-17 Agracetus, Inc. Gas driven gene delivery instrument
US5591317A (en) 1994-02-16 1997-01-07 Pitts, Jr.; M. Michael Electrostatic device for water treatment
US5610288A (en) 1993-01-27 1997-03-11 Hekton Institute For Medical Research Antisense polynucleotide inhibition of epidermal human growth factor receptor expression
US5631359A (en) 1994-10-11 1997-05-20 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Hairpin ribozymes
US5633234A (en) 1993-01-22 1997-05-27 The Johns Hopkins University Lysosomal targeting of immunogens
US5641515A (en) 1995-04-04 1997-06-24 Elan Corporation, Plc Controlled release biodegradable nanoparticles containing insulin
WO1997024447A1 (en) 1996-01-02 1997-07-10 Chiron Corporation Immunostimulation mediated by gene-modified dendritic cells
US5700922A (en) 1991-12-24 1997-12-23 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. PNA-DNA-PNA chimeric macromolecules
US5718709A (en) 1988-09-24 1998-02-17 Considine; John Apparatus for removing tumours from hollow organs of the body
US5725871A (en) 1989-08-18 1998-03-10 Danbiosyst Uk Limited Drug delivery compositions comprising lysophosphoglycerolipid
US5739119A (en) 1996-11-15 1998-04-14 Galli; Rachel L. Antisense oligonucleotides specific for the muscarinic type 2 acetylcholine receptor MRNA
US5738868A (en) 1995-07-18 1998-04-14 Lipogenics Ltd. Liposome compositions and kits therefor
US5747470A (en) 1995-06-07 1998-05-05 Gen-Probe Incorporated Method for inhibiting cellular proliferation using antisense oligonucleotides to gp130 mRNA
US5756353A (en) 1991-12-17 1998-05-26 The Regents Of The University Of California Expression of cloned genes in the lung by aerosol-and liposome-based delivery
US5759829A (en) 1986-03-28 1998-06-02 Calgene, Inc. Antisense regulation of gene expression in plant cells
US5780045A (en) 1992-05-18 1998-07-14 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Transmucosal drug delivery device
US5783683A (en) 1995-01-10 1998-07-21 Genta Inc. Antisense oligonucleotides which reduce expression of the FGFRI gene
US5789573A (en) 1990-08-14 1998-08-04 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Antisense inhibition of ICAM-1, E-selectin, and CMV IE1/IE2
US5792451A (en) 1994-03-02 1998-08-11 Emisphere Technologies, Inc. Oral drug delivery compositions and methods
US5795587A (en) 1995-01-23 1998-08-18 University Of Pittsburgh Stable lipid-comprising drug delivery complexes and methods for their production
US5801154A (en) 1993-10-18 1998-09-01 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Antisense oligonucleotide modulation of multidrug resistance-associated protein
US5804212A (en) 1989-11-04 1998-09-08 Danbiosyst Uk Limited Small particle compositions for intranasal drug delivery
US5811128A (en) 1986-10-24 1998-09-22 Southern Research Institute Method for oral or rectal delivery of microencapsulated vaccines and compositions therefor
WO1998050567A1 (en) * 1997-05-02 1998-11-12 Abbott Laboratories Reagents and methods useful for detecting diseases of the prostate
US5837458A (en) 1994-02-17 1998-11-17 Maxygen, Inc. Methods and compositions for cellular and metabolic engineering
US5843723A (en) 1993-09-15 1998-12-01 Chiron Corporation Alphavirus vector constructs
US5846796A (en) 1993-02-26 1998-12-08 The Picower Institute For Medical Research Blood-borne mesenchymal cells
US5856462A (en) 1996-09-10 1999-01-05 Hybridon Incorporated Oligonucleotides having modified CpG dinucleosides
WO1999033488A2 (en) 1997-12-24 1999-07-08 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals S.A. Adjuvanted vaccine formulation
US5928647A (en) 1993-01-11 1999-07-27 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute Inducing cytotoxic T lymphocyte responses
WO1999040934A1 (en) 1998-02-12 1999-08-19 Immune Complex, Corporation Strategically modified hepatitis b core proteins and their derivatives
WO1999052549A1 (en) 1998-04-09 1999-10-21 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals S.A. Adjuvant compositions
US5993412A (en) 1997-05-19 1999-11-30 Bioject, Inc. Injection apparatus
US6008035A (en) 1997-02-19 1999-12-28 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill System for the in vivo delivery and expression of heterologous genes in the bone marrow
WO1999067384A2 (en) * 1998-06-22 1999-12-29 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Prostate cancer-associated genes
US6010478A (en) 1995-02-14 2000-01-04 Powderject Research Limited Trans-mucosal particle delivery
WO2000004149A2 (en) * 1998-07-14 2000-01-27 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2000009159A1 (en) 1998-08-10 2000-02-24 Aquila Biopharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions of cpg and saponin adjuvants and methods thereof
US6113918A (en) 1997-05-08 2000-09-05 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Aminoalkyl glucosamine phosphate compounds and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors
WO2000061756A2 (en) * 1999-04-09 2000-10-19 Corixa Corporation Compounds for immunotherapy and diagnosis of breast cancer and methods for their use
WO2001025272A2 (en) * 1999-10-04 2001-04-12 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6261562B1 (en) 1997-02-25 2001-07-17 Corixa Corporation Compounds for immunotherapy of prostate cancer and methods for their use
WO2001051633A2 (en) * 2000-01-14 2001-07-19 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2001073032A2 (en) * 2000-03-27 2001-10-04 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2001081577A2 (en) * 2000-04-27 2001-11-01 Schering Aktiengesellschaft Dna encoding the prost 03 polypeptide
US6355257B1 (en) 1997-05-08 2002-03-12 Corixa Corporation Aminoalkyl glucosamine phosphate compounds and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors

Family Cites Families (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6329505B1 (en) * 1997-02-25 2001-12-11 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer

Patent Citations (153)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4237224A (en) 1974-11-04 1980-12-02 Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Jr. University Process for producing biologically functional molecular chimeras
US4554101A (en) 1981-01-09 1985-11-19 New York Blood Center, Inc. Identification and preparation of epitopes on antigens and allergens on the basis of hydrophilicity
US4489710A (en) 1981-06-23 1984-12-25 Xoma Corporation Composition and method for transplantation therapy
US4429008A (en) 1981-12-10 1984-01-31 The Regents Of The University Of California Thiol reactive liposomes
US4429008B1 (en) 1981-12-10 1995-05-16 Univ California Thiol reactive liposomes
US4603112A (en) 1981-12-24 1986-07-29 Health Research, Incorporated Modified vaccinia virus
US4769330A (en) 1981-12-24 1988-09-06 Health Research, Incorporated Modified vaccinia virus and methods for making and using the same
US4671958A (en) 1982-03-09 1987-06-09 Cytogen Corporation Antibody conjugates for the delivery of compounds to target sites
US4866034A (en) 1982-05-26 1989-09-12 Ribi Immunochem Research Inc. Refined detoxified endotoxin
US4436727A (en) 1982-05-26 1984-03-13 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Refined detoxified endotoxin product
US4507234A (en) 1982-12-24 1985-03-26 Teijin Limited Conjugate having cytotoxicity and process for the preparation thereof
US4673562A (en) 1983-08-19 1987-06-16 The Children's Medical Center Corporation Bisamide bisthiol compounds useful for making technetium radiodiagnostic renal agents
US4873088A (en) 1983-09-06 1989-10-10 Liposome Technology, Inc. Liposome drug delivery method and composition
US4625014A (en) 1984-07-10 1986-11-25 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Cell-delivery agent
US4569789A (en) 1984-08-29 1986-02-11 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Acid-cleavable compound, use in protein conjugates and drug delivery systems
US4883750A (en) 1984-12-13 1989-11-28 Applied Biosystems, Inc. Detection of specific sequences in nucleic acids
US4638045A (en) 1985-02-19 1987-01-20 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Non-peptide polyamino acid bioerodible polymers
US4751180A (en) 1985-03-28 1988-06-14 Chiron Corporation Expression using fused genes providing for protein product
US4683202A (en) 1985-03-28 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying nucleic acid sequences
US4683202B1 (de) 1985-03-28 1990-11-27 Cetus Corp
US5017487A (en) 1985-04-04 1991-05-21 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Vaccinia DNA
US4777127A (en) 1985-09-30 1988-10-11 Labsystems Oy Human retrovirus-related products and methods of diagnosing and treating conditions associated with said retrovirus
US5139941A (en) 1985-10-31 1992-08-18 University Of Florida Research Foundation, Inc. AAV transduction vectors
US4935233A (en) 1985-12-02 1990-06-19 G. D. Searle And Company Covalently linked polypeptide cell modulators
US4683195B1 (de) 1986-01-30 1990-11-27 Cetus Corp
US4683195A (en) 1986-01-30 1987-07-28 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or-cloning nucleic acid sequences
US4800159A (en) 1986-02-07 1989-01-24 Cetus Corporation Process for amplifying, detecting, and/or cloning nucleic acid sequences
US4699784A (en) 1986-02-25 1987-10-13 Center For Molecular Medicine & Immunology Tumoricidal methotrexate-antibody conjugate
US5759829A (en) 1986-03-28 1998-06-02 Calgene, Inc. Antisense regulation of gene expression in plant cells
US4877611A (en) 1986-04-15 1989-10-31 Ribi Immunochem Research Inc. Vaccine containing tumor antigens and adjuvants
WO1987006270A1 (en) 1986-04-16 1987-10-22 The Salk Institute For Biological Studies Replicative rna reporter systems
US5942252A (en) 1986-10-24 1999-08-24 Southern Research Institute Method for delivering bioactive agents into and through the mucosally-associated lymphoid tissues and controlling their release
US5853763A (en) 1986-10-24 1998-12-29 Southern Research Institute Method for delivering bioactive agents into and through the mucosally-associated lymphoid tissue and controlling their release
US5820883A (en) 1986-10-24 1998-10-13 Southern Research Institute Method for delivering bioactive agents into and through the mucosally-associated lymphoid tissues and controlling their release
US5075109A (en) 1986-10-24 1991-12-24 Southern Research Institute Method of potentiating an immune response
US5814344A (en) 1986-10-24 1998-09-29 Southern Research Institute Method for delivering bioactive agents into and through the mucosally associated lymphoid tissues and controlling their release
US5811128A (en) 1986-10-24 1998-09-22 Southern Research Institute Method for oral or rectal delivery of microencapsulated vaccines and compositions therefor
US4987071A (en) 1986-12-03 1991-01-22 University Patents, Inc. RNA ribozyme polymerases, dephosphorylases, restriction endoribonucleases and methods
GB2200651A (en) 1987-02-07 1988-08-10 Al Sumidaie Ayad Mohamed Khala A method of obtaining a retrovirus-containing fraction from retrovirus-containing cells
US5219740A (en) 1987-02-13 1993-06-15 Fred Hutchinson Cancer Research Center Retroviral gene transfer into diploid fibroblasts for gene therapy
GB2202328A (en) 1987-03-11 1988-09-21 Orion Yhtymae Oy An improved method for assaying of nucleic acids, a reagent combination and a kit therefore
US4735792A (en) 1987-04-28 1988-04-05 The United States Of America As Represented By The United States Department Of Energy Radioiodinated maleimides and use as agents for radiolabeling antibodies
US5091513A (en) 1987-05-21 1992-02-25 Creative Biomolecules, Inc. Biosynthetic antibody binding sites
US5132405A (en) 1987-05-21 1992-07-21 Creative Biomolecules, Inc. Biosynthetic antibody binding sites
US4790824A (en) 1987-06-19 1988-12-13 Bioject, Inc. Non-invasive hypodermic injection device
WO1988010315A1 (en) 1987-06-19 1988-12-29 Siska Diagnostics, Inc. Transcription-based nucleic acid amplification/detection systems
US4897268A (en) 1987-08-03 1990-01-30 Southern Research Institute Drug delivery system and method of making the same
WO1989003429A1 (en) 1987-08-28 1989-04-20 Health Research Inc. Recombinant avipox virus
WO1989001973A2 (en) 1987-09-02 1989-03-09 Applied Biotechnology, Inc. Recombinant pox virus for immunization against tumor-associated antigens
US4918164A (en) 1987-09-10 1990-04-17 Oncogen Tumor immunotherapy using anti-idiotypic antibodies
US4946778A (en) 1987-09-21 1990-08-07 Genex Corporation Single polypeptide chain binding molecules
EP0320308A2 (de) 1987-12-11 1989-06-14 Abbott Laboratories Verfahren zum Nachweis einer gezielten Nukleinsäure-Sequenz
WO1989006280A1 (en) 1988-01-04 1989-07-13 E.I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Multiple stage affinity process for isolation of specific cells from a cell mixture
WO1989006700A1 (en) 1988-01-21 1989-07-27 Genentech, Inc. Amplification and detection of nucleic acid sequences
WO1989009284A1 (en) 1988-03-24 1989-10-05 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Catalytic hybridization systems for the detection of nucleic acid sequences based on their activity as cofactors in catalytic reactions in which a complementary labeled nucleic acid probe is cleaved
US5215926A (en) 1988-06-03 1993-06-01 Cellpro, Inc. Procedure for designing efficient affinity cell separation processes
EP0345242A2 (de) 1988-06-03 1989-12-06 Smithkline Biologicals S.A. Expression von retroviralen GAG-Proteinen in eukaryontischen Zellen
US4912094B1 (en) 1988-06-29 1994-02-15 Ribi Immunochem Research Inc. Modified lipopolysaccharides and process of preparation
US4912094A (en) 1988-06-29 1990-03-27 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Modified lipopolysaccharides and process of preparation
EP0360257A2 (de) 1988-09-20 1990-03-28 The Board Of Regents For Northern Illinois University RNS-Katalysator zur Spaltung von spezifischen RNS-Sequenzen
US5718709A (en) 1988-09-24 1998-02-17 Considine; John Apparatus for removing tumours from hollow organs of the body
US5567434A (en) 1989-03-31 1996-10-22 The Regents Of The University Of California Preparation of liposome and lipid complex compositions
US5407609A (en) 1989-05-04 1995-04-18 Southern Research Institute Microencapsulation process and products therefrom
US5725871A (en) 1989-08-18 1998-03-10 Danbiosyst Uk Limited Drug delivery compositions comprising lysophosphoglycerolipid
WO1991002805A2 (en) 1989-08-18 1991-03-07 Viagene, Inc. Recombinant retroviruses delivering vector constructs to target cells
US5151254A (en) 1989-08-29 1992-09-29 Suzuki Jidosha Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha Exhaust gas cleaning device for internal combustion engine
WO1991003162A1 (en) 1989-08-31 1991-03-21 City Of Hope Chimeric dna-rna catalytic sequences
US5804212A (en) 1989-11-04 1998-09-08 Danbiosyst Uk Limited Small particle compositions for intranasal drug delivery
US5312335A (en) 1989-11-09 1994-05-17 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5064413A (en) 1989-11-09 1991-11-12 Bioject, Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
EP0500799A1 (de) 1989-11-16 1992-09-02 Duke University Transformation von tierischen Hautzellen mit hilfe von Partikeln
WO1991012882A1 (fr) 1990-02-22 1991-09-05 Medgenix Group S.A. Microspheres pour la liberation controlee des substances hydrosolubles et procede de preparation
US5466468A (en) 1990-04-03 1995-11-14 Ciba-Geigy Corporation Parenterally administrable liposome formulation comprising synthetic lipids
WO1991016116A1 (en) 1990-04-23 1991-10-31 Cellpro Incorporated Immunoselection device and method
WO1991018926A1 (en) 1990-05-31 1991-12-12 Arne Forsgren PROTEIN D - AN IgD-BINDING PROTEIN OF HAEMOPHILUS INFLUENZAE
WO1992001070A1 (en) 1990-07-09 1992-01-23 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, U.S. Department Of Commerce High efficiency packaging of mutant adeno-associated virus using amber suppressions
US5565213A (en) 1990-07-26 1996-10-15 Taisho Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Stable liposome aqueous suspension
US5789573A (en) 1990-08-14 1998-08-04 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Antisense inhibition of ICAM-1, E-selectin, and CMV IE1/IE2
WO1992003545A1 (en) 1990-08-15 1992-03-05 Virogenetics Corporation Flavivirus recombinant poxvirus vaccine
US5552157A (en) 1990-08-27 1996-09-03 Kabushiki Kaisha Vitamin Kenkyusya Liposome for entrapping gene, liposomal preparation and process for the manufacture of the preparation
WO1992007065A1 (en) 1990-10-12 1992-04-30 MAX-PLANCK-Gesellschaft zur Förderung der Wissenschaften e.V. Modified ribozymes
WO1992007243A1 (en) 1990-10-18 1992-04-30 Cellpro, Incorporated An apparatus and method for separating particles using a pliable vessel
US5173414A (en) 1990-10-30 1992-12-22 Applied Immune Sciences, Inc. Production of recombinant adeno-associated virus vectors
US5145684A (en) 1991-01-25 1992-09-08 Sterling Drug Inc. Surface modified drug nanoparticles
US5399363A (en) 1991-01-25 1995-03-21 Eastman Kodak Company Surface modified anticancer nanoparticles
EP0519596A1 (de) 1991-05-17 1992-12-23 Merck & Co. Inc. Verfahren zur Verringerung der Immunogenität der variabelen Teile von Antikörpern
US5334711A (en) 1991-06-20 1994-08-02 Europaisches Laboratorium Fur Molekularbiologie (Embl) Synthetic catalytic oligonucleotide structures
EP0519463A1 (de) 1991-06-20 1992-12-23 Europäisches Laboratorium Für Molekularbiologie (Embl) Synthetische katalytische Oligonukleotide
WO1993003769A1 (en) 1991-08-20 1993-03-04 THE UNITED STATES OF AMERICA, represented by THE SECRETARY, DEPARTEMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES Adenovirus mediated transfer of genes to the gastrointestinal tract
US5240856A (en) 1991-10-23 1993-08-31 Cellpro Incorporated Apparatus for cell separation
US5756353A (en) 1991-12-17 1998-05-26 The Regents Of The University Of California Expression of cloned genes in the lung by aerosol-and liposome-based delivery
US5700922A (en) 1991-12-24 1997-12-23 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. PNA-DNA-PNA chimeric macromolecules
WO1993015187A1 (en) 1992-01-31 1993-08-05 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Nucleozymes
WO1993023569A1 (en) 1992-05-11 1993-11-25 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method and reagent for inhibiting viral replication
US5780045A (en) 1992-05-18 1998-07-14 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Transmucosal drug delivery device
WO1994000153A1 (en) 1992-06-25 1994-01-06 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals (S.A.) Vaccine composition containing adjuvants
WO1994002595A1 (en) 1992-07-17 1994-02-03 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Method and reagent for treatment of animal diseases
US5383851A (en) 1992-07-24 1995-01-24 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection device
US5399163A (en) 1992-07-24 1995-03-21 Bioject Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection methods and device
US5520639A (en) 1992-07-24 1996-05-28 Bioject, Inc. Needleless hypodermic injection methods and device
WO1994013688A1 (en) 1992-12-08 1994-06-23 Gene Shears Pty. Limited Dna-armed ribozymes and minizymes
US5928647A (en) 1993-01-11 1999-07-27 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute Inducing cytotoxic T lymphocyte responses
US5359681A (en) 1993-01-11 1994-10-25 University Of Washington Fiber optic sensor and methods and apparatus relating thereto
US5633234A (en) 1993-01-22 1997-05-27 The Johns Hopkins University Lysosomal targeting of immunogens
US5610288A (en) 1993-01-27 1997-03-11 Hekton Institute For Medical Research Antisense polynucleotide inhibition of epidermal human growth factor receptor expression
US5846796A (en) 1993-02-26 1998-12-08 The Picower Institute For Medical Research Blood-borne mesenchymal cells
WO1994020078A1 (fr) 1993-03-02 1994-09-15 Biovector Therapeutics Sa Vecteurs particulaires synthetiques et procede de preparation
WO1994023701A1 (fr) 1993-04-21 1994-10-27 Institut Pasteur Vecteur particulaire et composition pharmaceutique le contenant
US5543158A (en) 1993-07-23 1996-08-06 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Biodegradable injectable nanoparticles
US6015694A (en) 1993-09-15 2000-01-18 Chiron Corporation Method for stimulating an immune response utilizing recombinant alphavirus particles
US6015686A (en) 1993-09-15 2000-01-18 Chiron Viagene, Inc. Eukaryotic layered vector initiation systems
US5843723A (en) 1993-09-15 1998-12-01 Chiron Corporation Alphavirus vector constructs
US5801154A (en) 1993-10-18 1998-09-01 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Antisense oligonucleotide modulation of multidrug resistance-associated protein
WO1995017210A1 (en) 1993-12-23 1995-06-29 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals (S.A.) Vaccines
US5584807A (en) 1994-01-21 1996-12-17 Agracetus, Inc. Gas driven gene delivery instrument
US5865796A (en) 1994-01-21 1999-02-02 Powderject Vaccines, Inc Gas driven gene delivery instrument
US5591317A (en) 1994-02-16 1997-01-07 Pitts, Jr.; M. Michael Electrostatic device for water treatment
US5837458A (en) 1994-02-17 1998-11-17 Maxygen, Inc. Methods and compositions for cellular and metabolic engineering
US5792451A (en) 1994-03-02 1998-08-11 Emisphere Technologies, Inc. Oral drug delivery compositions and methods
US5505947A (en) 1994-05-27 1996-04-09 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Attenuating mutations in Venezuelan Equine Encephalitis virus
US5643576A (en) 1994-05-27 1997-07-01 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Method of inducing an immune response with a live Venezuelan Equine Encephalitis virus expressing a heterologous immunogen
WO1996002555A1 (en) 1994-07-15 1996-02-01 The University Of Iowa Research Foundation Immunomodulatory oligonucleotides
WO1996006638A1 (fr) 1994-08-31 1996-03-07 Biovector Therapeutics S.A. Procede pour augmenter l'immunogenicite, produit obtenu et composition pharmaceutique
US5631359A (en) 1994-10-11 1997-05-20 Ribozyme Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Hairpin ribozymes
US5783683A (en) 1995-01-10 1998-07-21 Genta Inc. Antisense oligonucleotides which reduce expression of the FGFRI gene
US5795587A (en) 1995-01-23 1998-08-18 University Of Pittsburgh Stable lipid-comprising drug delivery complexes and methods for their production
US6010478A (en) 1995-02-14 2000-01-04 Powderject Research Limited Trans-mucosal particle delivery
US5580579A (en) 1995-02-15 1996-12-03 Nano Systems L.L.C. Site-specific adhesion within the GI tract using nanoparticles stabilized by high molecular weight, linear poly (ethylene oxide) polymers
US5641515A (en) 1995-04-04 1997-06-24 Elan Corporation, Plc Controlled release biodegradable nanoparticles containing insulin
WO1996033739A1 (en) 1995-04-25 1996-10-31 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals S.A. Vaccines containing a saponin and a sterol
WO1996038591A1 (en) 1995-06-02 1996-12-05 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. IMPROVED METHOD FOR OBTAINING FULL-LENGTH cDNA SEQUENCES
US5747470A (en) 1995-06-07 1998-05-05 Gen-Probe Incorporated Method for inhibiting cellular proliferation using antisense oligonucleotides to gp130 mRNA
US5738868A (en) 1995-07-18 1998-04-14 Lipogenics Ltd. Liposome compositions and kits therefor
WO1997024447A1 (en) 1996-01-02 1997-07-10 Chiron Corporation Immunostimulation mediated by gene-modified dendritic cells
US5856462A (en) 1996-09-10 1999-01-05 Hybridon Incorporated Oligonucleotides having modified CpG dinucleosides
US5739119A (en) 1996-11-15 1998-04-14 Galli; Rachel L. Antisense oligonucleotides specific for the muscarinic type 2 acetylcholine receptor MRNA
US6008035A (en) 1997-02-19 1999-12-28 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill System for the in vivo delivery and expression of heterologous genes in the bone marrow
US6261562B1 (en) 1997-02-25 2001-07-17 Corixa Corporation Compounds for immunotherapy of prostate cancer and methods for their use
WO1998050567A1 (en) * 1997-05-02 1998-11-12 Abbott Laboratories Reagents and methods useful for detecting diseases of the prostate
US6355257B1 (en) 1997-05-08 2002-03-12 Corixa Corporation Aminoalkyl glucosamine phosphate compounds and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors
US6113918A (en) 1997-05-08 2000-09-05 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Aminoalkyl glucosamine phosphate compounds and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors
US5993412A (en) 1997-05-19 1999-11-30 Bioject, Inc. Injection apparatus
WO1999033488A2 (en) 1997-12-24 1999-07-08 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals S.A. Adjuvanted vaccine formulation
WO1999040934A1 (en) 1998-02-12 1999-08-19 Immune Complex, Corporation Strategically modified hepatitis b core proteins and their derivatives
WO1999052549A1 (en) 1998-04-09 1999-10-21 Smithkline Beecham Biologicals S.A. Adjuvant compositions
WO1999067384A2 (en) * 1998-06-22 1999-12-29 Incyte Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Prostate cancer-associated genes
WO2000004149A2 (en) * 1998-07-14 2000-01-27 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2000009159A1 (en) 1998-08-10 2000-02-24 Aquila Biopharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions of cpg and saponin adjuvants and methods thereof
WO2000061756A2 (en) * 1999-04-09 2000-10-19 Corixa Corporation Compounds for immunotherapy and diagnosis of breast cancer and methods for their use
WO2001025272A2 (en) * 1999-10-04 2001-04-12 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2001051633A2 (en) * 2000-01-14 2001-07-19 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2001073032A2 (en) * 2000-03-27 2001-10-04 Corixa Corporation Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2001081577A2 (en) * 2000-04-27 2001-11-01 Schering Aktiengesellschaft Dna encoding the prost 03 polypeptide

Non-Patent Citations (195)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
"Animal Cell Culture", 1986
"DNA Cloning: A Practical Approach", vol. I-II
"Methods in Enzymology", vol. 183, ACADEMIC PRESS, INC.
"Nucleic Acid Hybridization", 1985
"Oligonucleotide Synthesis", 1984
"PCR Technology", 1989, STOCKTON PRESS
"Pierce Immunotechnology Catalog and Handbook", 1991, pages: A12 - A13
"Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences", pages: 1035 - 1038
"Transcription and Translation", 1984
"Vaccine Design (the subunit and adjuvant approach", 1995, PLENUM PRESS
ALTSCHUL ET AL., J. MOL. BIOL., vol. 215, 1990, pages 403 - 410
ALTSCHUL ET AL., NUCL. ACIDS RES., vol. 25, 1977, pages 3389 - 3402
ALTSCHUL ET AL., NUCLEIC ACIDS RES., vol. 25, no. 17, 1 September 1997 (1997-09-01), pages 3389 - 402
ARMITAGE ET AL., PROC NAT' ACAD SCI U S A., vol. 94, no. 23, 11 November 1997 (1997-11-11), pages 12320 - 5
AUSUBEL, F. M. ET AL.: "Current Protocols in Molecular Biology", 1989, JOHN WILEY & SONS
BANCHEREAU; STEINMAN, NATURE, vol. 392, 1998, pages 245 - 251
BARR ET AL., GENE THERAPY, vol. 1, 1994, pages 51 - 58
BERKNER, BIOTECHNIQUES, vol. 6, 1988, pages 616 - 627
BERKNER, K. L., BIOTECHNIQUES, vol. 6, 1988, pages 616 - 629
BERTHON ET AL., AM. J. HUM. GENET., vol. 62, 1998, pages 1416 - 1424
BETT ET AL., J. VIROL., vol. 67, 1993, pages 5911 - 5921
BIOTECHNOLOGY, vol. 10, 1992, pages 795 - 798
BOFFA ET AL., PROC NAT'1 ACAD SCI USA., vol. 92, no. 6, 14 March 1995 (1995-03-14), pages 1901 - 5
BORIS-LAWRIE; TEMIN, CUR. OPIN. GENET. DEVELOP., vol. 3, 1993, pages 102 - 109
BROGLIE, R. ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 224, 1984, pages 838 - 843
BROWN ET AL., CANCER RES., vol. 47, 1987, pages 3577 - 3583
BURNS ET AL., PROC. NAT'L ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 90, 1993, pages 8033 - 8037
CARTER, B. J., CURRENT OPINION IN BIOTECHNOLOGY, vol. 3, 1992, pages 533 - 539
CARUTHERS, M. H. ET AL., NUCL. ACIDS RES. SYMP. SER., 1980, pages 215 - 223
CECH ET AL., CELL, vol. 27, December 1981 (1981-12-01), pages 487 - 96
CHANDRAN ET AL., INDIAN J EXP BIOL., vol. 35, no. 8, August 1997 (1997-08-01), pages 801 - 9
CHEEVER ET AL., IMMUNOLOGICAL REVIEWS, vol. 157, 1997, pages 177
CHEN ET AL., CANCER RES., vol. 54, 1994, pages 1065 - 1070
COHEN, SCIENCE, vol. 259, 1993, pages 1691 - 1692
COLBERE-GARAPIN, F. ET AL., J. MOL. BIOI., vol. 150, 1981, pages 1 - 14
COLIGAN ET AL.: "Current Protocols in Immunology", vol. 1, 1998, WILEY INTERSCIENCE
COLLINS; OLIVE, BIOCHEMISTRY, vol. 32, no. 11, 23 March 1993 (1993-03-23), pages 2795 - 9
COREY, TRENDS BIOTECHNOL, vol. 15, no. 6, June 1997 (1997-06-01), pages 224 - 9
CORUZZI, G. ET AL., EMBO J., vol. 3, 1984, pages 1671 - 1680
COUVREUR ET AL., CRIT REV THER DRUG CARRIER SYST., vol. 5, no. 1, 1988, pages 1 - 20
CREIGHTON, T.: "Proteins, Structures and Molecular Principles", 1983, WH FREEMAN AND CO.
DAVIES ET AL., ANN. REV. BIOCHEM., vol. 59, 1990, pages 439 - 473
DAVIES ET AL., ANNUAL REV. BIOCHEM., vol. 59, 1990, pages 439 - 473
DAYHOFF, M.O.: "Atlas of Protein Sequence and Structure", vol. 5, 1978, NATIONAL BIOMEDICAL RESEARCH FOUNDATION, article "A model of evolutionary change in proteins - Matrices for detecting distant relationships", pages: 345 - 358
EHRLICH ET AL., BIOCHEM, vol. 19, 1980, pages 4091 - 4096
ELROY-STEIN; MOSS, PROC. NAT'L ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 87, 1990, pages 6743 - 6747
ENGELHARD, E. K. ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI., vol. 91, 1994, pages 3224 - 3227
FISHER-HOCH ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 86, 1989, pages 317 - 321
FLEXNER ET AL., ANN. N. Y. ACAD. SCI., vol. 569, 1989, pages 86 - 103
FLEXNER ET AL., VACCINE, vol. 8, 1990, pages 17 - 21
FOOTER ET AL., BIOCHEMISTRY, vol. 35, no. 33, 20 August 1996 (1996-08-20), pages 10673 - 9
FORSTER; SYMONS, CELL, vol. 49, no. 2, 24 April 1987 (1987-04-24), pages 211 - 20
FUERST ET AL., PROC. NAT'1 ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 83, 1986, pages 8122 - 8126
GAMBACORTI-PASSERINI ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 88, no. 4, 15 August 1996 (1996-08-15), pages 1411 - 7
GENE, vol. 43, 1986, pages 265 - 292
GOOD; NIELSEN, ANTISENSE NUCLEIC ACID DRUG DEV., vol. 7, no. 4, 1997, pages 431 - 37
GRANT ET AL., METHODS ENZYMOL., vol. 153, 1987, pages 516 - 544
GRIFFITH ET AL., NUCLEIC ACIDS RES., vol. 23, no. 15, 11 August 1995 (1995-08-11), pages 3003 - 8
GUERRIER-TAKADA ET AL., CELL, vol. 35, December 1983 (1983-12-01), pages 849 - 57
GUZMAN ET AL., CIR. RES., vol. 73, 1993, pages 1202 - 1207
GUZMAN ET AL., CIRCULATION, vol. 88, 1993, pages 2838 - 2848
HAJ-AHMAD; GRAHAM, J. VIROL., vol. 57, 1986, pages 267 - 274
HAMPEL ET AL., NUCLEIC ACIDS RES., vol. 18, no. 2, 25 January 1990 (1990-01-25), pages 299 - 304
HAMPEL; TRITZ, BIOCHEMISTRY, vol. 28, no. 12, 13 June 1989 (1989-06-13), pages 4929 - 33
HAMPTON, R. ET AL.: "Serological Methods, a Laboratory Manual", 1990, APS PRESS
HANVEY ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 258, no. 5087, 27 November 1992 (1992-11-27), pages 1481 - 5
HARA ET AL., BLOOD, vol. 84, 1994, pages 189 - 199
HARLOW; LANE: "Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual", 1988, COLD SPRING HARBOR LABORATORY
HARTMAN, S. C.; R. C. MULLIGAN, PROC. NAT'L ACAD. SCI., vol. 85, 1988, pages 8047 - 51
HEIN J., UNIFIED APPROACH TO ALIGNMENT AND PHYLOGENES, 1990, pages 626 - 645
HEIN J.: "Methods in Enzymology", vol. 183, 1990, ACADEMIC PRESS, INC., article "Unified Approach to Alignment and Phylogenes", pages: 626 - 645
HELLER ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 94, 1997, pages 2150 - 2155
HENIKOFF; HENIKOFF, PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 89, 1989, pages 10915
HIGGINS, D.G.; SHARP, P.M., CABIOS, vol. 5, 1989, pages 151 - 153
HOBBS, S.; MURRY, L. E.: "McGraw Hill Yearbook of Science and Technology", 1992, MCGRAW HILL, pages: 191 - 196
HOCHMAN ET AL., BIOCHEM, vol. 15, 1976, pages 2706 - 2710
HORN, T. ET AL., NUCL. ACIDS RES. SYMP. SER., 1980, pages 225 - 232
HUSTON ET AL., PROC. NAT. ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 85, no. 16, 1988, pages 5879 - 5883
HWANG ET AL., CRIT REV THER DRUG CARRIER SYST, vol. 15, no. 3, 1998, pages 243 - 84
HYRUP; NIELSEN, BIOORG MED CHEM., vol. 4, no. 1, January 1996 (1996-01-01), pages 5 - 23
INBAR ET AL., PROC. NAT. ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 69, 1972, pages 2659 - 2662
JASKULSKI ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 240, no. 4858, 10 June 1988 (1988-06-10), pages 1544 - 6
JENSEN ET AL., BIOCHEMISTRY, vol. 36, no. 16, 22 April 1997 (1997-04-22), pages 5072 - 7
JONES ET AL., NATURE, vol. 321, 1986, pages 522 - 525
KABAT ET AL.: "Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest", 1987, U.S. DEPT. OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES
KASS-EISLER ET AL., PROC. NAT'L ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 90, 1993, pages 11498 - 11502
KIM; CECH, PROC NAT'1 ACAD SCI USA., vol. 84, no. 24, December 1987 (1987-12-01), pages 8788 - 92
KOHLER; MILSTEIN, EUR. J. IMMUNOL., vol. 6, 1976, pages 511 - 519
KOLLS ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 91, 1994, pages 215 - 219
KOTIN, R. M., HUMAN GENE THERAPY, vol. 5, 1994, pages 793 - 801
KROLL, D. J. ET AL., DNA CELL BIOL., vol. 12, 1993, pages 441 - 453
LAGERSTROM ET AL., PCR METHODS APPLIC., vol. 1, 1991, pages 111 - 19
LALVANI ET AL., J. EXP. MED., vol. 186, 1997, pages 859 - 865
LASIC, TRENDS BIOTECHNOL, vol. 16, no. 7, July 1998 (1998-07-01), pages 307 - 21
LEBKOWSKI ET AL., MOLEC. CELL. BIOL., vol. 8, 1988, pages 3988 - 3996
LOBUGLIO ET AL., PROC. NAT. ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 86, 1989, pages 4220 - 4224
LOGAN, J.; SHENK, T., PROC. NAT'L ACAD. SCI., vol. 81, 1984, pages 3655 - 3659
LOWY, . ET AL., CELL, vol. 22, 1990, pages 817 - 23
MADDOX, D. E. ET AL., J. EXP. MED., vol. 158, 1983, pages 1211 - 1216
MAHVI ET AL., IMMUNOLOGY AND CELL BIOLOGY, vol. 75, 1997, pages 456 - 460
MANIATIS ET AL.: "Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual", 1982
MARATEA ET AL., GENE, vol. 40, 1985, pages 39 - 46
MARGALIT, CRIT REV THER DRUG CARRIER SYST., vol. 12, no. 2-3, 1995, pages 233 - 61
MATHIOWITZ ET AL., NATURE, vol. 386, no. 6623, 27 March 1997 (1997-03-27), pages 410 - 4
MERRIFIELD J., J. AM. CHEM. SOC., vol. 85, 1963, pages 2149 - 2154
MERRIFIELD, J. AM. CHEM. SOC., vol. 85, 1963, pages 2149 - 2146
MICHAEL ET AL., J. BIOL. CHEM., vol. 268, 1993, pages 6866 - 6869
MICHEL; WESTHOF, J MOL BIOL., vol. 216, no. 3, 5 December 1990 (1990-12-05), pages 585 - 610
MILLER, A. D., HUMAN GENE THERAPY, vol. 1, 1990, pages 5 - 14
MILLER; ROSMAN, BIOTECHNIQUES, vol. 7, 1989, pages 980 - 990
MITTEREDER ET AL., HUMAN GENE THERAPY, vol. 5, 1994, pages 717 - 729
MORRIS ET AL., NUCLEIC ACIDS RES., vol. 25, no. 14, 15 July 1997 (1997-07-15), pages 2730 - 6
MOSMANN; COFFMAN, ANN. REV. IMMUNOL., vol. 7, 1989, pages 145 - 173
MUHLEN ET AL., EUR J PHARM BIOPHARM., vol. 45, no. 2, March 1998 (1998-03-01), pages 149 - 55
MULLER ET AL., DNA CELL BIOL., vol. 9, no. 3, April 1990 (1990-04-01), pages 221 - 9
MULLIS ET AL., COLD SPRING HARBOR SYMP. QUANT. BIOL., vol. 51, 1987, pages 263
MURPHY ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 83, 1986, pages 8258 - 8262
MUZYCZKA, N., CURRENT TOPICS IN MICROBIOL. AND IMMUNOL., vol. 158, 1992, pages 97 - 129
MYERS, E.W.; MULLER W., CABIOS, vol. 4, 1988, pages 11 - 17
NEEDLEMAN; WUNSCH, J. MOL. BIOL., vol. 48, 1970, pages 443
NIELSEN ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 254, no. 5037, 6 December 1991 (1991-12-06), pages 1497 - 500
NORTON ET AL., BIOORG MED CHEM., vol. 3, no. 4, April 1995 (1995-04-01), pages 437 - 45
ORUM ET AL., BIOTECHNIQUES, vol. 19, no. 3, September 1995 (1995-09-01), pages 472 - 80
PARDRIDGE ET AL., PROC NAT'1 ACAD SCI USA., vol. 92, no. 12, 6 June 1995 (1995-06-06), pages 5592 - 6
PARKER ET AL., NUCL. ACIDS. RES., vol. 19, 1991, pages 3055 - 60
PARKER, KC ET AL., J. IMMUNOL., vol. 152, 1994, pages 163
PAUL: "Fundamental Immunology", 1993, RAVEN PRESS, pages: 243 - 247
PEARSON; LIPMAN, PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 85, 1988, pages 2444
PERBAL, A PRACTICAL GUIDE TO MOLECULAR CLONING, 1984
PERIS ET AL., BRAIN RES MOL BRAIN RES., vol. 57, no. 2, 15 June 1998 (1998-06-15), pages 310 - 20
PERROTTA; BEEN, BIOCHEMISTRY, vol. 31, no. 47, 1 December 1992 (1992-12-01), pages 11843 - 52
PETERSEN ET AL., J PEPT SCI., vol. 1, no. 3, May 1995 (1995-05-01), pages 175 - 83
PORATH, J. ET AL., PROTO EXP. PURIF., vol. 3, 1992, pages 263 - 281
QUINTANAR-GUERRERO ET AL., DRUG DEV IND PHARM., vol. 24, no. 12, December 1998 (1998-12-01), pages 1113 - 28
REINHOLD-HUREK; SHUB, NATURE, vol. 357, no. 6374, 14 May 1992 (1992-05-14), pages 173 - 6
RENNEISEN ET AL., J BIOL CHEM., vol. 265, no. 27, 25 September 1990 (1990-09-25), pages 16337 - 42
RHODES, C. A. ET AL., METHODS MOL. BIOL., vol. 55, 1995, pages 121 - 131
RICH ET AL., HUMAN GENE THERAPY, vol. 4, 1993, pages 461 - 476
RIECHMANN ET AL., NATURE, vol. 332, 1988, pages 323 - 327
ROBERGE, J. Y. ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 269, 1995, pages 202 - 204
ROBINSON, E.D., COMB. THEOR, vol. 11, 1971, pages 105
ROLLAND, CRIT. REV. THERAP. DRUG CARRIER SYSTEMS, vol. 15, 1998, pages 143 - 198
ROSE, ANAL CHEM., vol. 65, no. 24, 15 December 1993 (1993-12-15), pages 3545 - 9
ROSENFELD ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 252, 1991, pages 431 - 434
ROSSI ET AL., NUCLEIC ACIDS RES., vol. 20, no. 17, 11 September 1992 (1992-09-11), pages 4559 - 65
SACKETT ET AL.: "Clinical Epidemiology: A Basic Science for Clinical Medicine", 1985, LITTLE BROWN AND CO., pages: 106 - 7
SAMBROOK ET AL.: "Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual", 1989
SAMBROOK ET AL.: "Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual", 1989, COLD SPRING HARBOR LABORATORIES
SAMBROOK, J. ET AL.: "Molecular Cloning, A Laboratory Manual", 1989, COLD SPRING HARBOR PRESS
SANTOU, N.; NES, M., MOL. BIOL. EVOL., vol. 4, 1987, pages 406 - 425
SATO ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 273, 1996, pages 352
SAVILLE; COLLINS, CELL, vol. 61, no. 4, 18 May 1990 (1990-05-18), pages 685 - 96
SAVILLE; COLLINS, PROC NAT'1 ACAD SCI USA., vol. 88, no. 19, 1 October 1991 (1991-10-01), pages 8826 - 30
SCARPA ET AL., VIROLOGY, vol. 180, 1991, pages 849 - 852
SCHARF, D. ET AL., RESULTS PROBL. CELL DIFFER., vol. 20, 1994, pages 125 - 162
SCHENA ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 93, 1996, pages 10614 - 10619
SEEGER ET AL., BIOTECHNIQUES, vol. 23, no. 3, September 1997 (1997-09-01), pages 512 - 7
SETH ET AL., J. VIROL., vol. 68, 1994, pages 933 - 940
SHAW ET AL., J IMMUNOL., vol. 138, 1987, pages 4534 - 4538
SHELLING; SMITH, GENE THERAPY, vol. 1, 1994, pages 165 - 169
SHERMAN ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 258, 1992, pages 815 - 818
SKEIKY ET AL., INFECTION AND IMMUN., vol. 67, 1999, pages 3998 - 4007
SMITH ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 274, 1996, pages 1371 - 1374
SMITH; WATERMAN, ADD. APL. MATH, vol. 2, 1981, pages 482
SNEATH, P.H.A.; SOKAL, R.R.: "Numerical Taxonomy - the Principles and Practice of Numerical Taxonomy", 1973, FREEMAN PRESS
STOUTE ET AL., NEW ENGL. J. MED., vol. 336, 1997, pages 86 - 91
TAKAKURA, NIPPON RINSHO, vol. 56, no. 3, March 1998 (1998-03-01), pages 691 - 5
TAKAMATSU, N., EMBO J., vol. 6, 1987, pages 307 - 311
TAKENAGA ET AL., J CONTROLLED RELEASE, vol. 52, no. 1-2, 2 March 1998 (1998-03-02), pages 81 - 7
THEOBALD ET AL., PROC. NAT'L ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 92, 1995, pages 11993 - 11997
THEOBALD ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 92, 1995, pages 11993 - 11997
TIMMERMAN; LEVY, ANN. REV. MED., vol. 50, 1999, pages 507 - 529
TRIGLIA ET AL., NUCL. ACIDS RES., vol. 16, 1988, pages 8186
TUSNADY; SIMON: "Principles Governing Amino Acid Composition of Integral Membrane Proteins: Applications to Topology Prediction", J. MOL. BIOL., vol. 283, 1998, pages 489 - 506
ULMER ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 259, 1993, pages 1745 - 1749
VAN HEEKE, G.; S. M. SCHUSTER, J. BIOL. CHEM., vol. 264, 1989, pages 5503 - 5509
VAN TSAI ET AL., CRITICAL REVIEWS IN IMMUNOLOGY, vol. 18, 1998, pages 65 - 75
VASANTHAKUMAR; AHMED, CANCER COMMUN., vol. 1, no. 4, 1989, pages 225 - 32
VASMATIZIS ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 95, 1998, pages 300 - 304
VASMATZIS ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 95, 1998, pages 300 - 304
VERHOEYEN ET AL., SCIENCE, vol. 239, 1988, pages 1534 - 1536
VINCENT ET AL.: "Vaccines", 1990, COLD SPRING HARBOR LABORATORY PRESS, pages: 90
WAGNER ET AL., PROC. NAT'1 ACAD. SCI. USA, vol. 89, 1992, pages 6099 - 6103
WIGLER, M. ET AL., CELL, vol. 11, 1977, pages 223 - 32
WIGLER, M. ET AL., PROC. NATL ACAD. SCI., vol. 77, 1980, pages 3567 - 70
WILBUR, W.J.; LIPMAN, D.J., PROC. NAT/ ACAD., SCI. USA, vol. 80, 1983, pages 726 - 730
WILBUR, W.J.; LIPMAN, D.J., PROC. NAT'L ACAD., SCI. USA, vol. 80, 1983, pages 726 - 730
WINTER ET AL., NATURE, vol. 349, 1991, pages 293 - 299
WINTER, J. ET AL., RESULTS PROBL. CELL DIFFER., vol. 17, 1991, pages 85 - 105
WOOLF ET AL., PROC NAT'1 ACAD SCI USA., vol. 89, no. 16, 15 August 1992 (1992-08-15), pages 7305 - 9
XU JIANGCHUN ET AL: "Identification and characterization of prostein, a novel prostate-specific protein", CANCER RESEARCH, vol. 61, no. 4, 15 February 2001 (2001-02-15), pages 1563 - 1568, XP002496610, ISSN: 0008-5472 *
YEE ET AL., THE JOURNAL OF IMMUNOLOGY, vol. 157, no. 9, 1996, pages 4079 - 86
ZAMBAUX ET AL., J CONTROLLED RELEASE, vol. 50, no. 1-3, 2 January 1998 (1998-01-02), pages 31 - 40
ZHOU ET AL., J. EXP. MED., vol. 179, 1994, pages 1867 - 1875
ZITVOGEL ET AL., NATURE MED., vol. 4, 1998, pages 594 - 600

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CA2446788A1 (en) 2002-11-14
WO2002089747A2 (en) 2002-11-14
EP1515982A2 (de) 2005-03-23
WO2002089747A3 (en) 2004-12-29
JP2005504513A (ja) 2005-02-17
EP1515982A4 (de) 2005-10-26

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US7939646B2 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6800746B2 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US7033827B2 (en) Prostate-specific polynucleotide compositions
EP1988097A1 (de) Zusammensetzungen und Verfahren zur Behandlung und Diagnose von Prostatakrebs
US6943236B2 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
AU3447401A (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
WO2001073032A2 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
JP2004537252A (ja) 前立腺癌の治療及び診断のための組成物及び方法
US20020192763A1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6620922B1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6630305B1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6759515B1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6818751B1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US20020193296A1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US20020081680A1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US20060269532A1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US6894146B1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US20020051977A1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
US7517952B1 (en) Compositions and methods for the therapy and diagnosis of prostate cancer
JP2008271978A (ja) 前立腺癌の治療及び診断のための組成物及び方法

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
PUAI Public reference made under article 153(3) epc to a published international application that has entered the european phase

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009012

STAA Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent

Free format text: STATUS: THE APPLICATION HAS BEEN PUBLISHED

AC Divisional application: reference to earlier application

Ref document number: 1515982

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: P

AK Designated contracting states

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): AT BE CH CY DE DK ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LI LU MC NL PT SE TR

RIN1 Information on inventor provided before grant (corrected)

Inventor name: HOUGHTON, RAYMOND L.

Inventor name: WATANABE, YOSHIHIRO

Inventor name: HENDERSON, ROBERT A.

Inventor name: DAY, CRAIG H.

Inventor name: VINALS Y DE BASSOLS, CARLOTA

Inventor name: XU, JIANGCHUN

Inventor name: MITCHAM, JENNIFER L.

Inventor name: KALOS, MICHAEL D.

Inventor name: RETTER, MARC W.

Inventor name: HARLOCKER, SUSAN L.

Inventor name: WANG, AIJUN

Inventor name: DENG, TA

Inventor name: VEDVICK, THOMAS S.

Inventor name: DILLON, DAVIN C.

Inventor name: JIANG, YUQIU

Inventor name: CARTER, DARRICK

Inventor name: STOLK, JOHN A.

Inventor name: FOY, TERESA M.

Inventor name: LI, SAMUEL X.

Inventor name: SKEIKY, YASIR A.W.

Inventor name: HEPLER, WILLIAM T.

Inventor name: FANGER, GARY R.

Inventor name: HURAL, JOHN

Inventor name: MCNEILL, PATRICIA D.

AKX Designation fees paid
REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: DE

Ref legal event code: 8566

STAA Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent

Free format text: STATUS: THE APPLICATION IS DEEMED TO BE WITHDRAWN

18D Application deemed to be withdrawn

Effective date: 20090507